PioneerBDP LX55 PDF
PioneerBDP LX55 PDF
PioneerBDP LX55 PDF
Pour la clientle en Europe : Dcouvrez les nombreux avantages offerts en enregistrant votre produit en
ligne maintenant sur http://www.pioneer.fr (ou http://www.pioneer.eu).
Tlcharger une version lectronique de cette notice depuis notre site Internet
Fr Kunden in Europa: Bitte nutzen Sie die Mglichkeit zur Registrierung Ihres Produktes unter
http://www.pioneer.de (oder http://www.pioneer.eu)
Laden Sie eine elektronische Version dieser Anleitung von unserer Website.
Per i clienti in Europa: Registra il tuo prodotto su http://www.pioneer.it
(o http://www.pioneer.eu) e scopri subito quali vantaggi puoi ottenere!
Scarica la versone elettronica di questo manuale dal nostro sito internet.
Voor klanten in Europa: Ontdek nu de voordelen van online registratie! Registreer uw Pioneer product via
http://www.pioneer.nl - http://www.pioneer.be (of http://www.pioneer.eu)
Download een elektronische versie van de handleiding via de website.
Para clientes en Europa: Registre su producto en http://www.pioneer.es (o en
http://www.pioneer.eu) Descubra los beneficios de registrarse on-line:
Descarguese una versin electrnica de este manual desde nuestra web.
1RXVYRXVUHPHUFLRQVGDYRLUDFTXLVXQSURGXLW3LRQHHU
9HXLOOH]OLUHDWWHQWLYHPHQWFHPRGHGHPSORLDILQGHFRQQDvWUHODPDQLqUHGXWLOLVHUODSSDUHLOFRPPHLOFRQYLHQW&HOD
IDLWFRQVHUYH]OHPRGHGHPSORLGHIDoRQjSRXYRLUYRXV\UpIpUHUHQFDVGHQpFHVVLWp
IMPORTANT
ATTENTION
DANGER DELECTROCUTION
NE PAS OUVRIR
Exemples de marquage En respectant les circuits de collecte slective mis en place pour ces produits, vous
pour les batteries contribuerez conomiser des ressources prcieuses et prvenir les impacts
ngatifs ventuels sur la sant humaine et lenvironnement qui pourraient rsulter
dune mauvaise gestion des dchets.
Pour plus dinformation sur la collecte et le traitement des produits et batteries
usags, veuillez contacter votre municipalit, votre service de gestion des dchets
ou le point de vente chez qui vous avez achet ces produits.
Ces symboles ne sont valables que dans les pays de lUnion Europenne.
Pour les pays nappartenant pas lUnion Europenne :
Pb Si vous souhaitez jeter ces articles, veuillez contacter les autorits ou revendeurs
locaux pour connatre les mthodes dlimination appropries.
K058a_A1_Fr
0RCAUTIONSCONCERNANTLEVISIONNAGEEN$
p 3IVOUSRESSENTEZUNEFATIGUEOUUNEGNEPENDANTLEVISIONNAGEDmIMAGESEN$CESSEZDELESREGARDER
p ,ESENFANTSENPARTICULIERCEUXDEMOINSDEANSSONTPLUSSENSIBLESLAFATIGUEETLESPERSONNESENCHARGEDOIVENT
SURVEILLERTOUTSIGNEDEFATIGUEOUDEGNE
p 0ENDANTLEVISIONNAGEDmIMAGESEN$FAITESRGULIREMENTDESPAUSES
,EVISIONNAGEPROLONGDmIMAGESEN$SANSPAUSEPEUTCAUSERDELAFATIGUEETUNINCONFORT
3
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 4 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Sommaire
01 Avant de commencer Utilisation du menu FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Contenu de lemballage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Lecture partir dun temps prcis
Mise en place des piles dans la tlcommande . . . . . 5 (Recherche temporelle) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Mise jour du logiciel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Lecture dun titre, dun chapitre ou dune plage
propos du fonctionnement de ce lecteur avec particulier (Recherche). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
un dispositif mobile (iPod, iPhone, iPad, etc.) . . . . . . . . 6 Lecture dune plage particulire de disques,
Types de disques/fichiers lisibles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 de titres ou dun chapitre (morceau/fichier) dans
Disques lisibles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 un ordre alatoire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Fichiers lisibles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Continuation de la lecture partir de la position
Noms et fonctions des lments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 spcifie (Poursuite du visionnage) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Tlcommande . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 05 Lecture avec Home Media Gallery
Face avant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 propos de Home Media Gallery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Panneau arrire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 propos de la lecture en rseau . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
02 Raccordements DLNA Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Quand un cble HDMI est utilis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Lecture de disque/USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
propos de lHDMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Lecture de fichiers photo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
propos du Contrle par lHDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Lecture dans lordre souhait (Playlist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Raccordement dun tlviseur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Ajout de plages ou de fichiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Raccordement dun rcepteur ou Lecture de la Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
amplificateur AV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Suppression de plages ou fichiers de la Playlist. . . . . 37
Raccordement des cbles vido et audio . . . . . . . . . . . 20 06 Lecture de contenus web
Raccordement dun tlviseur avec un cble Contenus web disponibles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
vido/audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Lecture de contenus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Raccordement dun rcepteur ou amplificateur AV
avec un cble audio numrique optique. . . . . . . . . . . 20
07 Rglages dtaills
Changement des rglages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Raccordement dun appareil au port USB . . . . . . . . . . 20
Utilisation de la page Initial Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
propos des cls USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Mise jour du logiciel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Raccordement de la cl USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Rtablissement des rglages par dfaut
Raccordement au rseau par linterface LAN. . . . . . . . 21
du lecteur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Connexion un rseau LAN sans fil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Tableau des codes de langues et Tableau des
Raccordement du cordon dalimentation . . . . . . . . . . . 22
codes de pays et rgions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
03 Pour commencer 08 Informations supplmentaires
Paramtrage laide du menu Setup Navigator. . . . . . 23
Avis relatif la licence du logiciel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Commande du tlviseur avec la tlcommande
Prcautions demploi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
du lecteur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Dplacement du lecteur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Liste des codes de tlviseurs prrgls. . . . . . . . . . . 24 Emplacement du lecteur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
04 Lecture teignez le lecteur lorsque vous ne lutilisez pas . . . . 58
Lecture de disques ou de fichiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Recherche avant et arrire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Nettoyage du lecteur. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Lecture de chapitres ou de plages particuliers . . . . . 27 Attention si lecteur est install dans un meuble
Saut de contenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 avec une porte en verre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Lecture au ralenti . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Nettoyage de la lentille du capteur . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Lecture avant et arrire pas pas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Manipulation des disques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Lecture rpte dun passage prcis dun titre En cas de panne . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
ou dune plage (Rptition A-B). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Lecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Rptition de la lecture (Lecture rpte). . . . . . . . . . 27 Contrle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Lecture dans lordre souhait (Lecture Rseau . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
programme) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Divers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Pose de signets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Glossaire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Zoom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Spcifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Affichage de miniatures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Changement de langle de prise de vues . . . . . . . . . . 28
Changement des sous-titres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Affichage des informations du disque . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Commutation du son et du second son . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Commutation sur la seconde image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Utilisation de BONUSVIEW ou BD-LIVE . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Fonctions de lecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
4
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 5 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Chapitre 1 01
Avant de commencer
Contenu de AVERTISSEMENT
Carte de garantie
Attention
Cordon dalimentation
Nutilisez que les piles spcifies lexclusion de
Mode demploi (ce manuel)
toute autre. Nutilisez pas non plus une pile neuve
Mise en place des piles dans avec une pile use.
Insrez les piles dans la tlcommande en les
la tlcommande orientant correctement, comme indiqu par les
symboles de polarit ( et ).
1 Ouvrez le couvercle arrire. Nexposez pas les piles la chaleur, ne les ouvrez pas
ou ne les jetez pas au feu ou dans leau.
La tension des piles peut tre diffrente, mme si les
piles semblent identiques. Nutilisez pas diffrents
types de piles.
Appuyez lgrement
sur cette partie et Pour viter toute fuite dlectrolyte, retirez les piles si
faites glisser dans le vous prvoyez de ne pas utiliser la tlcommande
sens de la flche. pendant un certain temps (1 mois ou plus). Si une pile
devait fuir, essuyez soigneusement lintrieur du
2 Insrez les piles (AAA/R03 x 2). logement puis insrez des piles neuves. Si le liquide
Insrez les piles en tenant compte des repres / dans dune pile devait fuir et se rpandre sur votre peau,
le logement de piles. lavez-le immdiatement avec une grande quantit
deau.
Lorsque vous mettez des piles uses au rebut, veuillez
vous conformer la rglementation
Insrez dabord le gouvernementale ou environnementale en vigueur
ct ngatif (). dans votre pays ou rgion.
5
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 6 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
propos du
fonctionnement de ce
lecteur avec un
dispositif mobile
(iPod, iPhone, iPad,
etc.)
Linstallation de lapplication approprie sur un dispositif
mobile permet dagir sur le lecteur depuis le dispositif
mobile.
Pour le dtail, reportez-vous aux informations produit sur
le site Pioneer.
Cette application spciale peut tre change ou arrte
sans avis pralable.
6
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 7 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Disques lisibles
Les disques portant les logos suivants sur ltiquette, le carton ou la jaquette peuvent tre lus.
Attention
Attention seuls les disques finaliss peuvent tre lus.
Format de lapplication
Type de disque Logo DVD- DVD- CD-DA DATA-
BDMV BDAV DVD VR
Vido Audio DTS-CD DISC1
BD-ROM
BD-R
BD2
BD-RE
DVD-ROM 3
DVD
DVD-R2,4,5 6 7
DVD-RW4,8 6 7
DVD+R2,4
DVD+RW4
CD-DA
(CD audio)9
CD
CD-R4
CD-RW4
CD-ROM
1. Disques sur lesquels des fichiers vido, photo ou audio sont enregistrs. Ce lecteur ne permet pas les enregistrements multi-border ou de
disques multi-session.
2. Disques double couche compris.
3. BDP-LX55 et BDP-440 seulement.
4. Les finaliser avant de les lire sur ce lecteur.
5. Les disques DVD-R pour cration (3,95 et 4,7 Go) ne peuvent pas tre lus.
6. Format AVCHD compris.
7. Format AVCREC compris.
8. Les disques DVD-RW Version 1.0 ne peuvent pas tre lus.
9. CD vido compris.
7
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 8 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Les noms de socits et de produits mentionns ici Disque Blu-ray Enregistrable (R) Format Version 2
sont des marques commerciales ou des marques Disque Blu-ray Renregistrable (RE) Format
dposes de ces socits respectives. Version 3
Ce lecteur prend en charge les BD-ROM Profil 5.
Disques illisibles
HD DVD
Disques DVD-RAM
Il est possible que certains disques ne figurant pas dans
la liste ci-dessus ne puissent pas non plus tre lus.
Le logo Blu-ray 3D et Blu-ray 3D sont des marques
commerciales de Blu-ray Disc Association.
Remarque
Certains disques ne pourront pas tre lus bien quils Les fonctions BONUSVIEW, comme la lecture dune
portent un des logos de la page prcdente. seconde image (Image dans limage) et dun second
Pour lire un disque de 8 cm, posez le disque dans le son, peuvent tre utilises. Les donnes utilises avec
renfoncement destin aux disques de 8 cm au centre les fonctions BONUSVIEW (les donnes de la
du tiroir disque. Aucun adaptateur nest ncessaire. seconde image (Image dans limage) et du second
Les BD-ROM de 8 cm ne peuvent pas tre lus. son) peuvent tre sauvegardes dans la mmoire.
Pour le dtail sur la lecture dune seconde image et
propos des formats audio dun second son, reportez-vous la notice du disque.
Les formats audio suivants sont pris en charge par ce
lecteur :
Dolby TrueHD BONUSVIEW est une marque commerciale de Blu-ray
Disc Association.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Vous pouvez utiliser les fonctions BD-LIVE, qui
DTS-HD Master Audio permettent de tlcharger des bandes-annonces ou
dautres langues pour les dialogues et les sous-titres,
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio et de jouer des jeux vido en ligne, via Internet. Les
DTS Digital Surround donnes tlcharges grce la fonction BD-LIVE
MPEG audio (AAC) (bandes-annonces, etc.) sont sauvegardes dans la
mmoire. Reportez-vous aux instructions du disque
PCM linaire
pour le dtail sur les fonctions BD-LIVE.
Pour bnficier du son ambiophonique de formats Dolby
TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio et DTS-
HD High Resolution Audio, il est conseill de raccorder le
lecteur un rcepteur ou un amplificateur AV
compatible avec ces formats audio laide dun cble
HDMI. Aprs avoir insr un BD contenant des pistes son
Le logo BD-LIVE est une marque commerciale de
dans un de ces formats audio, slectionnez le format
Blu-ray Disc Association
audio sur le menu.
Fabriqu sous licence de Dolby Laboratories. Le terme
Dolby et le sigle double D sont des marques
commerciales de Dolby Laboratories.
Fabriqu sous licence sous couvert des brevets U.S. N :
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,392,195;
7,272,567; 7,333,929; 7,212,872 et dautres brevets U.S. et
mondiaux, mis et en cours denregistrement. DTS-HD, le
Symbole et DTS-HD et le Symbole sont ensemble des
marques dposes et DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential est
une marque commerciale de DTS, Inc. Logiciel inclus dans
ce produit. DTS, Inc. Tous droits rservs.
8
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 9 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Avec les BD-ROM, il est possible dutiliser les propos des codes rgionaux
applications BD-J (Java) pour crer des titres 01
Des codes rgionaux sont attribus aux Lecteur Blu-ray
hautement interactifs, jeux compris.
Disc et aux disques BD-ROM ou DVD-Vido en fonction
de la rgion o ils sont commercialiss.
Les codes rgionaux de ce lecteur sont les suivants :
BD-ROM : B
DVD-Vido : 2
Les disques ne contenant pas ces codes ne peuvent pas
tre lus. Les disques suivants peuvent tre lus sur ce
lecteur.
BD : B (B compris) et ALL
DVD : 2 (2 compris) et ALL
Oracle et Java sont des marques dposes d'Oracle
Corporation et/ou de ses affilis. Tout autre nom Lecture de CD
mentionn peut correspondre des marques Au sujet de la copie de CD protgs : Ce lecteur se
appartenant d'autres propritaires qu'Oracle. conforme aux spcifications du format CD audio. Il ne
Les BD (BDAV) compatibles avec les formats suivants prend pas en charge la lecture ou les fonctions des
peuvent tre lus. disques non conformes ces spcifications.
Disque Blu-ray Enregistrable (R) Format Version 1
Lecture de DualDisc
Disque Blu-ray Renregistrable (RE) Format
Version 2 Un DualDisc est un disque deux faces dont une face
renferme les donnes du DVD donnes vido, donnes
Lecture de DVD audio, etc. et lautre face les donnes non DVD, par
exemple les matriaux audionumriques.
La face DVD dun DualDisc peut tre lue sur ce lecteur.
La face audio, non DVD du disque ne peut pas tre lue par
ce lecteur.
Cette tiquette indique que les disques DVD-RW Il est possible que lors du chargement ou de ljection
enregistrs dans le format VR (format denregistrement dun DualDisc, la face oppose la face de lecture soit
vido) peuvent tre lus. Toutefois, dans le cas de disques raye. La lecture dun disque ray nest pas possible.
enregistrs avec un programme crypt pour un
enregistrement unique, la lecture nest possible qu laide Pour tout complment dinformations sur les
dun dispositif compatible avec le CPRM. spcifications du DualDisc, consultez le fabricant du
disque ou le magasin dachat.
LAVCHD est un format haute dfinition (HD) pour
camscope numrique permettant denregistrer sur
certains supports en haute dfinition grce des
technologies de compression extrmement
performantes.
9
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 10 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Dossier principal
001.jpg/001.mp3 *
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
* DivX, DivX Certified, DivX PlusTM HD et les logos
Dossier 01 Dossier 001.jpg/001.mp3 affrents sont des marques commerciales de DivX, Inc.
utilises sous licence.
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
001.jpg/001.mp3
Remarque
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3 *
Cet appareil DivX Certified doit tre immatricul
Dossier XX 001.jpg/001.mp3 * pour pouvoir lire des vidos la demande DivX (VOD).
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
Obtenez dabord le numro dimmatriculation VOD
DivX de votre appareil et spcifiez-le lors de
* Le nombre de dossiers et de fichiers dans un seul limmatriculation. Important : Les vidos VOD DivX
dossier (dossier principal compris) se limite 256. Ne sont protges par un systme DivX DRM (Gestion
crez pas plus de 5 niveaux de dossiers. numrique des droits) qui restreint la lecture aux
appareils certifis DivX immatriculs. Si vous essayez
de lire une vido VOD DivX non autorise pour votre
Remarque appareil, le message Authorization Error apparatra
Les noms de fichiers et dossiers saffichant sur ce et la vido ne pourra pas tre vue. Consultez le site
lecteur peuvent tre diffrents de ceux qui saffichent www.divx.com/vod pour plus dinformations.
sur lordinateur. Le numro dimmatriculation VOD DivX de ce
lecteur peut tre vrifi dans HOME MENU
Fichiers lisibles Initial Setup Playback DivX(R) VOD DRM
Registration Code (page 42).
Les fichiers vido, photo et audio enregistrs sur les DVD
et les CD peuvent tre lus. Le nombre de visionnages est limit pour certains
fichiers VOD DivX. Lorsque vous regardez ces
fichiers sur votre lecteur, le nombre restant de
Attention visionnages est indiqu. Les fichiers pour lesquels
Parmi les DVD, seuls ceux qui sont enregistrs avec le nombre de visionnage indiquent 0 ne peuvent
le systme de fichiers ISO 9660 peuvent tre lus. pas tre lus (This DivX rental has expired
saffiche). Les fichiers pour lesquels le nombre de
Certains fichiers ne pourront pas tre lus.
visionnage nest pas limit peuvent tre visionns
Avec certains fichiers, il peut tre impossible volont (le nombre restant de visionnages
dutiliser certaines fonctions lors de la lecture. napparat pas).
Certains fichiers ne pourront pas tre lus bien quils
aient lextension dun fichier lisible sur ce lecteur.
Les fichiers protgs par le DRM (Gestion numrique
10 des droits) ne peuvent pas tre lus (fichiers VOD DivX
Fr non compris).
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 11 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
MKV
Les fichiers MKV peuvent tre lus.
Noms et fonctions des 01
MKV est un format de fichier permettant de runir lments
plusieurs fichiers audio et vido en un seul fichier.
Les fichiers suivants peuvent tre lus :
Rsolution : Jusqu 1 280 x 720 Tlcommande
Extension : .mkv ou .MKV
19
Windows Media Video (WMV)
Les fichiers Windows Media Video (WMV) peuvent 1 20
tre lus. 2
charge
10 27
JPEG
JPEG progressif 28
Format de fichier : JFIF Ver. 1.02/Exif Ver. 2.2
11 29
Rsolution : Jusqu 4 096 x 4 096 pixels 12
30
13
Formats de fichiers audio pris en 14 31
32
charge
15 33
Windows Media Audio 9 (WMA9)
34
Dbits binaires : Jusqu 192 kbps
35
Frquences dchantillonnage : 22,05 kHz, 32 kHz,
16 36
44,1 kHz et 48 kHz
17 37
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3)
18 38
Dbits binaires : Jusqu 320 kbps
Frquences dchantillonnage : 8 kHz, 11,025 kHz,
12 kHz, 16 kHz, 22,05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz et
48 kHz
Codec libre de compression audio sans perte
(FLAC) (Seulement pour le BDP-LX55) 1 STANDBY/ON Sert mettre le lecteur en ou hors
Frquence dchantillonnage : 96 kHz 192 kHz service.
Dbit binaire aprs quantification : 16 bits, 24 bits
Canaux : 2 2 CONTINUED Pour continuer la lecture partir dun
point prcis. (page 33)
Extensions des fichiers lisibles 3 TV CONTROL (page 24)
Fichiers vido
.divx, .mkv, .wmv et .avi 4 AUDIO (page 29)
Fichiers photo
.jpg et .jpeg
Fichiers audio
.wma et .mp3
.flac (BDP-LX55 seulement)
11
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 12 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
5 FL DIMMER 24 HDMI
01 BDP-LX55, BDP-440 chaque pression de cette BDP-LX55 Sert commuter le HDMI Mode
touche, la luminosit de lafficheur de la face avant (pages 16 et 41).
change et/ou ltat des tmoins sur la face avant BDP-440/BDP-140 Sert changer la rsolution des
change de la faon indique dans le tableau suivant. signaux vido sortant de la prise HDMI OUT
Tmoins (page 41).
Afficheur de Blu-ray PQLS FL OFF 25 EXIT (page 38)
la face avant (BDP-LX55
seulement) 26 POP UP MENU/MENU Sert afficher les menus
Lumineux Allum Allum teint dun BD-ROM ou DVD-Vido.
Moyen Allum Allum teint 27 RETURN Sert revenir la page prcdente.
Sombre Allum Allum teint
28 Touches de couleur Servent naviguer sur les
teint teint teint Allum
menus du BD-ROM.
BDP-140 chaque pression sur cette touche, la PROGRAM (page 28)
luminosit de la face avant change (4 niveaux). BOOK MARK (page 28)
CD/SACD ZOOM (page 28)
Pour les disques hybrides, sert basculer entre les
INDEX (page 28)
couches CD et SACD.
29 FWD (page 27)
6 TOP MENU Sert afficher la premire page du
menu dun BD-ROM ou DVD-Vido. 30 // (page 27)
7 FUNCTION (page 32) 31 STOP (page 26)
8 HOME MEDIA GALLERY (page 34) 32 2nd VIDEO (page 30)
9 /// Sert slectionner des lments, 33 2nd AUDIO (page 29)
changer des rglages et dplacer le curseur.
ENTER Sert excuter llment slectionn ou 34 A-B (page 27)
valider un rglage qui a t chang, etc. 35 ENTER Sert excuter llment slectionn ou
valider un rglage qui a t chang, etc.
10 HOME MENU (page 39)
36 REPEAT (page 27)
11 REV (page 27)
37 SKIP SEARCH Sert avancer de 30 secondes
12 PLAY (page 26) lorsque SKIP SEARCH est press pendant la
13 // (page 27) lecture.
Face avant 01
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-140
1 3 4 6 8 9 10 11
13
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 14 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
01 Panneau arrire
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 5 6 8
BDP-140
3 4 2 1 5 6 8
1 Prise(s) HDMI OUT (ci-dessous et page 15) 5 Prise LAN (10/100) (page 21)
2 Prises VIDEO OUTPUT (page 20) 6 Port USB (page 20)
3 Prise DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL) (page 20) 7 Prise RS-232C (BDP-LX55 seulement) Cette prise
nest pas utilise.
4 Prises AUDIO OUTPUT (page 20)
8 AC IN (page 22)
Remarque
Aucun signal vido ne peut tre transmis par la prise SUB. Veillez relier votre tlviseur la prise MAIN.
14
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 15 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Chapitre 2 02
Raccordements
Veillez toujours teindre les appareils et dbrancher le Ce produit est compatible avec le x.v.Color qui donne un
cordon dalimentation de la prise secteur avant de spectre de couleurs plus tendu rpondant aux
raccorder un appareil ou de changer les liaisons. spcifications xvYCC.
Aprs le raccordement, effectuez les rglages dans le Le spectre des couleurs tendu permet de restituer des
menu Setup Navigator ou Initial Setup selon le type de couleurs naturelles et plus fidles que jamais lors de la
cble raccord (page 23). lecture de signaux vido conformes aux normes xvYCC,
quand le lecteur est raccord un tlviseur x.v.Color,
Reportez-vous aussi au mode demploi de lappareil etc.
raccord. x.v.Color est le nom promotionnel donn aux produits
capables de restituer un spectre de couleurs plus tendu,
Remarque rpondant aux spcifications des standards
internationaux dfinis comme xvYCC.
Les illustrations suivantes proviennent
essentiellement du BDP-LX55.
16
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 17 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Lecture de contenus PC enregistrs sur des disques La fonction PQLS peut cesser doprer lorsque la
ou dispositifs USB. rsolution de la sortie vido est commute. La
fonction PQLS sactive de nouveau si la lecture est
Le rcepteur AV Pioneer compatible avec la fonction arrte puis redmarre.
Stream Smoother Link est raccord ce lecteur par
un cble HDMI et le lecteur est rgl de la faon Lorsque la fonction PQLS 2ch est active, le signal
suivante (page 41). provenant des prises VIDEO OUTPUT du lecteur
Control : On peuvent ne pas avoir les bonnes couleurs. Dans ce
cas, reliez les prises HDMI du tlviseur et du
Reportez-vous aussi aux instructions du rcepteur rcepteur AV pour voir limage.
AV.
Allumez le rcepteur AV raccord la prise HDMI
Consultez le site Pioneer pour les rcepteurs AV OUT, puis dmarrez la lecture du disque.
compatibles avec la fonction Stream Smoother Link.
Attention Remarque
Raccordez directement le lecteur au rcepteur AV Le tmoin PQLS sclaire sur la face avant du lecteur
Pioneer compatible avec la fonction Stream lorsque la fonction PQLS est active (page 13).
Smoother Link. Linterruption dune liaison directe
avec un amplificateur ou un convertisseur AV (par
exemple une coupure de lHDMI) peut causer un
dysfonctionnement.
17
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 18 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Attention
Pour brancher et dbrancher le cble, saisissez-le par
le commerce)
(en vente dans
Cble HDMI
la fiche. Orientez correctement
la fiche par rapport la
Nexercez pas de force sur la fiche qui puisse crer de la prise prise et insrez-la tout
faux contacts ou empcher la sortie des signaux dentre droit.
vido. HDMI Un rcepteur ou un amplificateur AV
peut aussi tre raccord laide dun
cble HDMI (ci-dessous).
BDP-LX55
Raccordez le tlviseur la prise HDMI OUT (MAIN).
Tlviseur Sens du signal
Panneau arrire du BDP-LX55
Raccordement dun
rcepteur ou amplificateur
AV
Raccordez ce lecteur un rcepteur ou amplificateur AV
pour bnficier du son ambiophonique des formats Dolby
TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby Digital, DTS-HD Master
le commerce)
(en vente dans
Cble HDMI
Attention
Veillez bien raccorder le tlviseur la prise HDMI
OUT (MAIN), les signaux vido ne peuvent pas tre
transmis par la prise HDMI OUT (SUB).
Veillez rgler HDMI Mode sur Single (page 41).
18
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 19 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
BDP-LX55
Attention 02
Panneau arrire du BDP-LX55
Veillez bien raccorder le tlviseur la prise HDMI
OUT (MAIN), les signaux vido ne peuvent pas tre
transmis par la prise HDMI OUT (SUB).
Rglez bien HDMI Mode sur Separate (page 41).
Si lamplificateur AV raccord la prise HDMI OUT
(SUB) est galement raccord un tlviseur,
lentre du tlviseur peut changer
Cble HDMI automatiquement. Si cest le cas, dsactivez la
(en vente dans fonction de Contrle par lHDMI du tlviseur.
le commerce)
BDP-440/BDP-140
dentre HDMI
la prise
Rcepteur ou
Orientez amplificateur AV
correctement la Panneau arrire du BDP-440
fiche par rapport
la prise et insrez-
la tout droit.
Rcepteur ou
amplificateur AV
Cble HDMI
De la prise de sortie HDMI
(en vente dans
la prise dentre HDMI
le commerce)
le commerce)
(en vente dans
Cble HDMI
Orientez
correctement la fiche
par rapport la prise
Sens du signal la prise et insrez-la tout droit.
dentre HDMI
Tlviseur Rcepteur ou
amplificateur AV
Pour obtenir une image et un son de meilleure
le commerce)
(en vente dans
Cble HDMI
qualit
De la prise la prise
Lorsquun tlviseur (ou un projecteur) et un de sortie dentre HDMI Tlviseur
amplificateur AV sont raccords au lecteur, il faut les HDMI
Sens du signal
raccorder de sorte que les signaux vido et audio soient
transmis sparment pour obtenir une image et un son
de meilleure qualit.
Panneau arrire du BDP-LX55
Cble HDMI
(en vente dans
le commerce)
dentre HDMI
la prise
Rcepteur ou
Orientez amplificateur AV
correctement la
fiche par rapport
la prise et insrez-
la tout droit.
Sens du signal
Tlviseur
19
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 20 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Raccordement dun
un tlviseur combin un magntoscope. Pour le
dtail, contactez le fabricant du tlviseur.
Panneau arrire du BDP-LX55
appareil au port USB
Les donnes tlcharges avec la fonction BD-LIVE et les
Jaune Rouge donnes utilises avec la fonction BONUSVIEW lors de la
lecture de BD-ROM peuvent tre sauvegardes sur un
dispositif raccord au port USB (Cl USB).
Blanc
propos des cls USB
Les cls USB suivantes peuvent tre raccordes au
Un rcepteur ou un
amplificateur AV peut aussi tre
lecteur.
audio (inclus)
Cble vido/
20
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 21 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Routeur
Cl USB LAN
3 2 1 WAN
Ordinateur
21
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 22 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Internet
Cordon dalimentation
(fourni)
la prise murale
Modem
WAN
Convertisseur LAN
sans fil
(AS-WL300) DC 5V Ethernet WPS
22
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 23 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Chapitre 3 03
Pour commencer
Paramtrage laide 3 Lancez le Setup Navigator.
Appuyez sur ENTER.
du menu Setup Le Setup Navigator souvre.
23
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 24 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
PHILCO 32, 42
PHILIPS 31, 07, 34, 56, 68
SONOLOR 31, 35
SONTEC 07
03
PHOENIX 32 SONY 04
PHONOLA 07 SOUNDWAVE 07
PROFEX 42, 44 STANDARD 41, 44
PROTECH 07, 42, 44, 46, 49 STERN 31
QUELLE 31, 32, 07, 42, 45, 53 SUSUMU 41
R-LINE 07 SYSLINE 07
RADIOLA 07 TANDY 31, 41, 48
RADIOSHACK 10, 23, 21, 02 TASHIKO 34
RBM 53 TATUNG 07, 48
RCA 01, 10, 15, 16, 17, 18, 61, 62, TEC 42
09 TELEAVIA 36
REDIFFUSION 32, 42 TELEFUNKEN 36, 37, 52
REX 31, 46 TELETECH 44
ROADSTAR 41, 44, 46 TENSAI 40, 41
SABA 31, 36, 42, 51 THOMSON 36, 51, 52, 63
SAISHO 39, 44, 46 THORN 31, 07, 42, 45, 48
SALORA 31, 32, 42, 43 TOMASHI 18
SAMBERS 49 TOSHIBA 05, 02, 26, 21, 53
SAMSUNG 07, 38, 44, 46, 69, 70 TOWADA 42
SANYO 35, 45, 48, 21, 14, 91 ULTRAVOX 32, 42, 49
SBR 07, 34 UNIDEN 92
SCHAUB LORENZ 42 UNIVERSUM 31, 07, 38, 42, 45,
SCHNEIDER 07, 41, 47 46, 54
SEG 42, 46 VESTEL 07
SEI 32, 40, 49 VICTOR 13
SELECO 31, 42 VOXSON 31
SHARP 02, 19, 27, 67, 90 WALTHAM 43
SIAREM 32, 49 WATSON 07
SIEMENS 31 WATT RADIO 32, 42, 49
SINUDYNE 32, 39, 40, 49 WHITE WESTINGHOUSE 07
SKANTIC 43 YOKO 07, 42, 46
SOLAVOX 31 ZENITH 03, 20
SONOKO 07, 44
25
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 26 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
04 Chapitre 4
Lecture
Si des restrictions demploi ont t poses par un
enregistreur BD sur le BD insr, lcran de saisie du
code PIN apparat. Dans ce cas, saisissez votre code
PIN.
3 Appuyez sur PLAY pour lire le disque.
Pour mettre en pause, appuyez sur PAUSE pendant
la lecture.
Pour arrter la lecture, appuyez sur STOP.
Remarque
La lecture commence automatiquement pour
certains disques lorsque le tiroir disque est ferm.
Certains disques DVD-Vido disposent des fonctions
de contrle parental. Saisissez le mot de passe
enregistr dans les paramtres du lecteur pour
annuler le contrle parental. Pour le dtail, reportez-
vous page 46.
1 Appuyez sur STANDBY/ON pour allumer le Lorsque vous changez de liste de fichiers.
lecteur. Lorsque vous mettez le lecteur hors service. (La
Allumez le tlviseur et slectionnez tout dabord lentre. reprise de la lecture nest pas annule dans le cas
des BD et des DVD.)
2 Appuyez sur OPEN/CLOSE pour ouvrir le tiroir
disque et insrez le disque. Si vous voulez continuer la lecture une position
spcifie au pralable, reportez-vous Continuation
de la lecture partir de la position spcifie (Poursuite
Remarque du visionnage) la page 33.
Insrez le disque en orientant sa face La reprise de la lecture ne peut pas tre utilise pour
imprime vers le haut. certains disques.
Il faut plusieurs douzaines de secondes au
lecteur pour lire les informations du disque.
Lorsque les informations ont t lues, le
type du disque est indiqu sur lafficheur de la face
avant du lecteur.
26
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 27 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
28
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 29 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Remarque
Le fonctionnement des cls USB nest pas garanti.
Son/image primaire Son/image secondaire La lecture des donnes de la fonction BD-LIVE varie
selon le disque utilis. Pour le dtail, consultez la
La seconde image peut aussi tre commute en
notice fournie avec le disque.
slectionnant Secondary Video sur le menu
FUNCTION. Pour bnficier de la fonction BD-LIVE, une
connexion rseau et des rglages sont ncessaires
Si 2nd VIDEO ne permet pas de commuter la (pages 21 et 44).
seconde image, commutez-la par le menu du disque.
BD-LIVE est une fonction fournissant une connexion
Mise hors service de la seconde Internet. Les disques disposant de la fonction BD-
LIVE peuvent envoyer les codes didentification de ce
image lecteur et du disque au fournisseur de contenus par
Internet.
Appuyez plusieurs fois sur 2nd VIDEO ou
slectionnez Secondary Video dans le menu
FUNCTION pour rgler ce paramtre sur Off.
Utilisation de BONUSVIEW ou
BD-LIVE
Ce lecteur est compatible avec les BD-Vido
BONUSVIEW et BD-LIVE.
Lorsque vous utilisez des BD-Vido compatibles avec
BONUSVIEW, vous bnficiez de certaines fonctions
comme la seconde image (image dans limage) (ci-
dessus) et le second son (page 29). Avec les BD-Vido
offrant BD-LIVE, des images vido spciales ainsi que
dautres donnes peuvent tre tlcharges dInternet.
Les donnes enregistres sur un BD-Vido et
tlcharges de BD-LIVE se stockent sur une cl USB
(mmoire externe). Pour bnficier de ces fonctions,
raccordez une cl USB (capacit minimale de 1 Go, 2 Go
ou plus est recommand) de type USB 2.0 High Speed
(480 Mbit/s) au port USB.
Veillez teindre le lecteur avant dinsrer ou de
retirer la cl USB.
Pour rappeler les donnes sauvegardes sur la cl
USB, insrez dabord le disque utilis lors du
tlchargement des donnes (si un autre disque est
insr, les donnes enregistres sur la cl USB ne
seront pas lues).
30
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 31 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Fonctions de lecture 04
Les fonctions pouvant tre utilises dpendent du type de disque et de fichier. Dans certains cas, certaines fonctions
ne peuvent pas tre utilises. Les fonctions disponibles sont indiques dans le tableau suivant.
Type de disque/fichier
DVD-R
1
Fonction BD- BD-R DVD- DVD- /-RW Fichier Fichier Fichier CD
AVCREC AVCHD
ROM /-RE Vido Audio2 (Format vido photo audio audio
VR)
Recherche avant et
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5
arrire3
Lecture de titres, de
chapitres ou de
plages particuliers
Saut de contenu
Lecture au ralenti3,6 7
Lecture avant et
8
arrire pas pas3
Angle9
Sous-titres10
Son11
Second son12 13
Seconde image14 15
Informations du
disque
1. Certaines fonctions peuvent ne pas tre disponibles pour certains disques ou fichiers, mme si [] est indiqu dans le tableau.
2. Sauf BDP-140.
3. Pour certains disques, la lecture redevient delle-mme normale au changement de chapitre.
4. Pendant la recherche avant et arrire, le son nest pas audible.
5. Pendant la recherche avant et arrire, le son est audible.
6. Pendant la lecture au ralenti le son nest pas audible.
Il nest pas possible de changer de vitesse pendant la lecture arrire au ralenti.
7. La lecture arrire au ralenti nest pas disponible.
8. La lecture arrire pas pas nest pas disponible.
9. La marque dangle apparat pour les scnes enregistres sous divers angles si Angle Mark est rgl sur On (page 42).
10. Les types de sous-titres enregistrs dpendent du disque et du fichier.
Dans certains cas, les sous-titres peuvent changer ou lcran de commutation du disque peut safficher immdiatement, sans que les
sous-titres actuel ou le nombre total de sous-titres enregistrs sur le disque napparaissent.
11. Les types de flux audio enregistrs dpendent du disque et du fichier.
12. Les types de flux audio secondaires enregistrs dpendent du disque et du fichier.
Dans certains cas, le second son peut tre commut ou lcran de commutation du disque peut safficher immdiatement, sans que le
second son actuel ou le nombre total de flux du second son enregistrs sur le disque napparaisse.
La marque de second son apparat pour les scnes enregistres avec un second son si Secondary Audio Mark est rgl sur On (page 42).
13. Certains disques nont pas de second son.
14. Dans certains cas, la seconde image son peut tre commute ou lcran de commutation du disque peut safficher immdiatement, sans
que la seconde image actuelle ou le nombre total de flux de seconde image enregistrs sur le disque napparaisse.
La marque de seconde image apparat pour les scnes enregistres avec une second image si PIP Mark est rgl sur On (page 42).
15. Certains disques nont pas de seconde image.
31
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 32 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Les fonctions pouvant tre rappeles dpendent du mode Replay Saut arrire de 10 secondes.
de fonctionnement du lecteur. Slide Show Changement de vitesse du diaporama
pendant un diaporama.
1 Affichez le menu FUNCTION.
Appuyez sur FUNCTION pendant la lecture. Transition Changement de style du diaporama
pendant un diaporama.
2 Slectionnez et rglez le paramtre.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur * Les paramtres indiqus sur le menu FUNCTION
ENTER. dpendent du type de disque.
Remarque Remarque
Les paramtres ne pouvant pas tre changs Les paramtres pouvant tre slectionns dpendent
apparaissent en gris. Les paramtres pouvant tre du type de disque.
slectionns dpendent de ltat du lecteur.
Lecture partir dun temps
Pour changer le rglage du prcis (Recherche
paramtre slectionn temporelle)
Utilisez / pour le changer.
1 Slectionnez Time.
Pour fermer le menu FUNCTION Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
Appuyez sur FUNCTION. ENTER.
Random Play
La plage de disques, de titres ou dun chapitre (morceau/
fichier) spcifie est lue dans un ordre alatoire. Le mme
lment peut tre lu de manire conscutive.
Shuffle Play
La plage de disques, de titres ou dun chapitre (morceau/
fichier) spcifie est lue dans un ordre alatoire. Chaque
lment nest lu quune seule fois.
Continuation de la lecture
partir de la position spcifie
(Poursuite du visionnage)
Cette fonction permet de poursuivre la lecture une
position spcifie au pralable, mme aprs lextinction
du lecteur.
Rglage
Pendant la lecture, appuyez sur CONTINUED la
position o vous voulez poursuivre le visionnage.
Le temps coul jusqu la position spcifie est indique
lcran du tlviseur.
Lecture
1 Appuyez sur PLAY pour lire le titre pour lequel
vous avez spcifi une position.
Le menu FUNCTION apparat automatiquement pour
indiquer le point (temps) spcifi par une pression sur
CONTINUED.
Lcran de cette fonction peut aussi tre affich par
une pression sur FUNCTION pendant la lecture.
2 Appuyez sur ENTER, puis slectionnez le temps
spcifi pour la poursuite de la lecture.
Dmarrez la lecture au temps prcis.
Remarque
Le temps spcifi pour la poursuite de la lecture est
annul lorsque OPEN/CLOSE est press.
La poursuite de la lecture un temps spcifi peut ne
pas fonctionner correctement avec certains disques.
33
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 34 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
05 Chapitre 5
Lecture avec Home Media Gallery
Les fichiers suivants peuvent tre lus avec Home
Media Gallery :
Les ordinateurs fonctionnant sous Microsoft
Windows Vista ou XP avec Windows Media Player
11 install
Ordinateurs fonctionnant sous Microsoft Windows
7 avec Windows Media Player 12 install
Les serveurs multimdia numriques compatibles
avec la norme DLNA (sur les ordinateurs ou
dautres appareils)
Les fichiers enregistrs sur un ordinateur ou un
DMS (Serveur multimdia numrique), comme
propos de Home
mentionn ci-dessus, peuvent tre lus par le
lecteur multimdia numrique (DMP).
35
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 36 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Remarque
Ce lecteur ne prend pas en charge le DTCP-IP.
Lecture dans lordre
Les fichiers et contenus enregistrs et protgs par
un systme anticopie numrique ne peuvent pas tre
souhait (Playlist)
lus par linterface LAN.
Les disques permettant dajouter des plages et des fichiers
la Playlist sont les suivants.
Lecture de disque/USB DVD/CD/Cl USB sur lesquels des fichiers audio sont
enregistrs
1 Appuyez sur HOME MEDIA GALLERY pour
afficher la page Home Media Gallery. Ajout de plages ou de fichiers
La page Home Media Gallery peut aussi tre affiche en Procdez de la faon suivante pour ajouter des plages et
slectionnant Home Media Gallery sur la page Home des fichiers, et crer la Playlist.
Menu puis en appuyant sur ENTER.
1 Appuyez sur HOME MEDIA GALLERY pour
2 Slectionnez Disc ou USB. afficher la page Home Media Gallery.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur La page Home Media Gallery peut aussi tre affiche en
ENTER. slectionnant Home Media Gallery sur la page Home
3 Slectionnez Photo/Music/Video/AVCHD. Menu puis en appuyant sur ENTER.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur 2 Slectionnez Disc ou USB.
ENTER. Insrez dabord le disque.
Ce point nest pas pour les disques enregistrs dans Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
le format VR. ENTER.
4 Slectionnez le titre/la plage ou le fichier que 3 Slectionnez la plage ou le fichier devant tre
vous voulez lire. ajout.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur Utilisez pour effectuer un choix.
ENTER.
Dmarrez la lecture partir du titre/de la plage ou fichier 4 Appuyez sur POP UP MENU pour afficher le menu
slectionn. POP UP MENU.
Si le fichier que vous voulez lire se trouve dans un 5 Slectionnez Add to Playlist pour ajouter la
dossier, slectionnez dabord le dossier contenant le Playlist.
fichier. Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
ENTER.
La plage ou le fichier slectionn au point 3 est ajout
la Playlist.
Pour ajouter dautres plages ou fichiers, rptez les
points 3 5.
36
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 37 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Lecture de la Playlist 05
1 Appuyez sur HOME MEDIA GALLERY pour
afficher la page Home Media Gallery.
La page Home Media Gallery peut aussi tre affiche en
slectionnant Home Media Gallery sur la page Home
Menu puis en appuyant sur ENTER.
2 Slectionnez la Playlist.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
ENTER.
3 Slectionnez la plage ou le fichier devant tre lu.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
ENTER.
La lecture commence par la plage ou le fichier
slectionn et se poursuit jusquau dernier de la liste.
Utilisez / pour lire la plage ou le fichier prcdent
ou suivant. La page Now Playing saffiche.
Suppression de plages ou
fichiers de la Playlist.
1 Slectionnez la plage ou le fichier devant tre
supprim, puis appuyez sur POP UP MENU pour
afficher le menu POP UP MENU.
2 Utilisez / pour slectionner Delete from
Playlist, puis appuyez sur ENTER.
37
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 38 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
06 Chapitre 6
Lecture de contenus web
Vous pouvez lire des contenus obtenus dInternet via le L'accs du contenu Web requiert un accs internet
lecteur. haut dbit et peut aussi ncessiter l'enregistrement
de vos coordonnes et le paiement d'un abonnement
38
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 39 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Chapitre 7 07
Rglages dtaills
Changement des Utilisation de la page Initial
rglages Setup
1 Lorsque la lecture est arrte, affichez la page
Home Menu.
Appuyez sur HOME MENU.
2 Slectionnez et validez Initial Setup.
Utilisez / pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez sur
ENTER.
3 Slectionnez le paramtre et changez son
rglage.
Utilisez /// pour effectuer un choix, puis appuyez
sur ENTER.
Remarque
Les paramtres pouvant tre slectionns dpendent de ltat du lecteur.
Dans Options, les rglages usine des paramtres sont indiqus en caractres gras.
Rglage Options Explication
Display Setting
TV Screen 16:9 Full Slectionnez cette option si un tlviseur grand cran (16:9) est raccord.
16:9 Normal Slectionnez cette option si un tlviseur grand cran (16:9) est raccord. Les images
de format 4:3 apparaissent avec des bandes noires verticales sur les cts.
4:3 Pan&Scan Slectionnez cette option si un tlviseur 4:3 est raccord et les vidos lues sont en
16:9. Les cts gauche et droit de limage seront tronqus pour que la vido puisse
tre vue sur lcran 4:3. (Cette fonction agit si le disque porte la marque 4:3PS.)
4:3 Letterbox Slectionnez cette option si un tlviseur 4:3 est raccord et les vidos lues sont en
16:9. Des bandes noires apparatront au haut et bas de limage.
Video Adjust La qualit de l'image reproduite peut tre ajuste en fonction du tlviseur utilis (page 44).
Sharpness High Choisissez le niveau de nettet.
(Sauf BDP-LX55) Middle
Low
Video Mode Standard Choisissez le mode de sortie vido.
(Sauf BDP-LX55) Vivid
Cinema
Custom
Noise Reduction 0 Choisissez le niveau de rduction du bruit.
(Sauf BDP-LX55) 1
2
3
39
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 40 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Digital Output Bitstream Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre directement les signaux audio numriques.
PCM Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre des signaux audio numriques convertis
en signaux audio PCM.
Re-encode Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre des signaux audio numriques convertis
en signaux DTS Digital Surround.
Off Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre des signaux audio qui ne sont pas des
signaux audio numriques.
DTS Downmix (BDP- Stereo Les signaux DTS-HD Master Audio, les signaux DTS-HD High Resolution Audio ou les
LX55) signaux audio DTS Digital Surround convertis en signaux audio PCM linaires sont
convertis en signaux (stro) 2 canaux avant leur sortie.
Lt/Rt Les signaux DTS-HD Master Audio, les signaux DTS-HD High Resolution Audio ou les
signaux audio DTS Digital Surround convertis en signaux audio PCM linaires sont
convertis en signaux 2 canaux compatibles avec le Dolby Surround avant leur sortie
(si le rcepteur ou lamplificateur AV, etc. raccord est compatible avec le Dolby Pro
Logic, il transmettra des signaux audio PCM linaires sous forme de signaux audio
surround).
Downsampling 48k Slectionnez cette option pour lire un disque enregistr avec une frquence
dchantillonnage de 48 kHz.
96k Slectionnez cette option pour lire un disque enregistr avec une frquence
dchantillonnage de 96 kHz.
192k Slectionnez cette option pour lire un disque enregistr avec une frquence
dchantillonnage de 192 kHz.
DRC (Dynamic Range Off Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre des signaux audio sans utiliser le contrle
Control) de la plage dynamique.
* Seuls les signaux On Slectionnez cette option pour rgler la plage entre sons forts et sons faibles (plage
dynamique) lors de la lecture volume modr. Cette option permet de faire ressortir
audio numriques et les dialogues et de regarder des films faible volume la nuit.
analogiques Dolby sont
Auto Slectionnez cette option pour que le DRC sactive/dsactive automatiquement en
pris en charge. fonction du signal audio du disque.
40
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 41 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
HDMI Mode (BDP-LX55) Single Slectionnez cette option lorsquun cble HDMI est raccord la prise HDMI OUT
(MAIN) seulement.
Separate Slectionnez cette option lorsque des cbles HDMI sont raccords aux deux prises HDMI OUT.
Pure Audio Slectionnez cette option seulement pour bnficier dune musique de meilleure qualit
lorsque des appareils sont raccords aux deux prises HDMI OUT. Avec ce rglage, la
musique provient de la prise HDMI OUT (SUB) seulement et les signaux vido proviennent
de la prise HDMI OUT (MAIN) seulement lorsque vous appuyez sur DISPLAY.
Reportez-vous aussi Rglage de HDMI Mode (Seulement pour le BDP-LX55) la page 16.
Color Space RGB Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux vido sous forme de signaux
RVB. Choisissez cette option si les couleurs semblent faibles et le noir trop puissant.
YCbCr Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux sous forme de signaux YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 422 Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux sous forme de signaux YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux vido sous forme de signaux
RVB. Choisissez cette option si les couleurs semblent trop denses et tous les
dgrads de noir sont dun noir uniforme.
Resolution Auto Slectionnez cette option pour que la rsolution des signaux vido la sortie de la
prise HDMI OUT soit automatiquement slectionne.
480I/576I Les signaux vido la sortie de la prise HDMI OUT ont la rsolution slectionne.
480P/576P La rsolution peut tre change en appuyant sur HDMI, mais Auto ne peut pas tre
slectionn.
720P
1080I
1080P
Sur le BDP-LX55, aucun signal vido nest transmis par la prise HDMI OUT (MAIN) quand la rsolution est rgle sur 480I/576I.
HDMI Audio Out Bitstream Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre directement les signaux audio HDMI.
PCM Slectionnez cette option pour transmettre des signaux audio HDMI convertis en
signaux audio 2 voies.
Re-encode Slectionnez cette option pour que le type de signaux audio soient automatiquement slectionn.
Off Slectionnez cette option si vous ne voulez pas que les signaux audio soient transmis
par la prise de sortie HDMI.
Control On Slectionnez cette option pour activer la commande du lecteur via la tlcommande
de lappareil AV raccord laide dun cble HDMI. Reportez-vous aussi page 16.
Off Slectionnez cette option pour dsactiver la commande du lecteur via la
tlcommande de lappareil AV raccord laide dun cble HDMI.
Pour utiliser les Sound Retriever Link, Stream Smoother Link et PQLS (pages 16 et 17), Control doit tre rgl sur On.
HDMI Deep color 30bits Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux vido en couleur 30 bits.
36bits Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux vido en couleur 36 bits.
Off Slectionnez cette option pour restituer les signaux vido en couleur normale 24 bits.
HDMI 1080P 24Hz On Slectionnez cette option lorsque la Resolution est rgle sur Auto ou 1080P et des
signaux vido 1080p/24 sont transmis un tlviseur compatible avec le 1080p/24.
Off Slectionnez cette option lorsque la Resolution est rgle sur 1080P et des signaux
vido 1080p/60 sont transmis un tlviseur compatible avec le 1080p/60.
HDMI 3D Auto Les disques 3D sont lus avec des images en 3D.
Off Les disques 3D sont lus avec des images en 2D.
3D notice Yes Prcise si lavis 3D doit tre affich ou non lors de la lecture dimages 3D.
No
Network
IP setting Slectionnez cette option pour spcifier ladresse IP du lecteur et du serveur DNS (page 44).
Proxy Server Ne rglez le serveur proxy que si votre fournisseur de service Internet vous le demande (page 44).
Information Affiche les valeurs de ladresse MAC, de ladresse IP, du masque de sous-rseau, de la passerelle par
dfaut, du serveur DNS (primaire) et du serveur DNS (secondaire).
Connection Test Slectionnez cette option pour tester la connexion au rseau (page 45).
Internet Connection Enable Slectionnez cette option lorsque vous vous connectez Internet.
Disable Slectionnez cette option lorsque vous ne vous connectez pas Internet.
BD-Live connection Permitted Tous les disques peuvent se connecter BD-LIVE.
Partial Permitted Seuls les disques dont la scurit a t confirme peuvent se connecter BD-LIVE.
Prohibited Aucun disque ne peut se connecter BD-LIVE.
DLNA Enable Slectionnez cette option lorsque vous vous connectez un serveur DLNA.
41
Disable Slectionnez cette option lorsque vous ne vous connectez pas un serveur DLNA. Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 42 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
OSD langues Choisissez une des langues indiques pour laffichage des pages.
disponibles
Audio langues Choisissez une des langues indiques pour prciser la langue par dfaut des
* Pour certains disques, disponibles dialogues lors de la lecture de BD-ROM et de DVD-Vido.
il peut tre impossible de
passer la langue
slectionne.
Si vous prcisez une langue non enregistre sur le BD ou le DVD, une des langues enregistres sera automatiquement slectionne et utilise.
Subtitle langues Choisissez une des langues indiques pour prciser la langue par dfaut des sous-
* Pour certains disques, disponibles titres lors de la lecture de BD-ROM et de DVD-Vido.
il peut tre impossible de
passer la langue
slectionne.
Si vous prcisez une langue non enregistre sur le BD ou le DVD, une des langues enregistres sera automatiquement
slectionne et utilise.
Menu langues Choisissez une des langues indiques pour prciser la langue par dfaut des menus
* Pour certains disques, disponibles des BD-ROM et DVD-Vido.
il peut tre impossible de
passer la langue
slectionne.
Si vous prcisez une langue non enregistre sur le BD ou le DVD, une des langues enregistres sera automatiquement slectionne et utilise.
Playback
Angle Mark On Slectionnez cette option pour afficher la marque dangle sur lcran du tlviseur
(page 28). Cest le rglage usine du BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Slectionnez cette option si la marque dangle ne doit pas apparatre sur lcran du
tlviseur. Cest le rglage usine du BDP-LX55.
PIP Mark On Slectionnez cette option pour afficher la marque PIP sur lcran du tlviseur. Cest
le rglage usine du BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Slectionnez cette option si la marque PIP ne doit pas apparatre sur lcran du
tlviseur. Cest le rglage usine du BDP-LX55.
Secondary Audio Mark On Slectionnez cette option pour afficher la marque de son secondaire sur lcran du
tlviseur (page 29). Cest le rglage usine du BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Slectionnez cette option si la marque de son secondaire ne doit pas apparatre sur
lcran du tlviseur. Cest le rglage usine du BDP-LX55.
DivX(R) VOD DRM Registration Indique le code denregistrement du lecteur requis pour la lecture de fichiers VOD
Code DivX (page 10).
DVD Playback DVD AUDIO Slectionnez cette option pour lire seulement la partie audio dun DVD-Audio.
* Ce rglage est rserv DVD VIDEO Slectionnez cette option pour lire seulement la partie vido dun DVD-Audio.
la lecture de DVD-
Audio. (Sauf BDP-140)
Internet Setting Permitted Les contenus web peuvent tre regards sans avoir saisir un mot de passe.
Partial Permitted Le mot de passe doit tre saisi pour pouvoir regarder des contenus web.
Prohibited Aucun contenu web ne peut tre regard.
Disc Auto Playback On Les disques sont lus automatiquement aprs avoir t insrs.
Off Les disques insrs ne sont pas automatiquement lus.
Last Memory On Slectionnez cette option pour sauvegarder le point o la lecture a t arrte, mme
aprs louverture du tiroir disque ou la mise en attente.
Off Slectionnez cette option si vous voulez utiliser la poursuite du visionnage (page 33).
PBC (Play Back Control) On Slectionnez cette option pour lire les CD-vido (version 2.0) compatibles avec la
fonction PBC en utilisant le menu du disque.
Off Slectionnez cette option pour lire les CD-vido (version 2.0) compatibles avec la
fonction PBC sans utiliser le menu du disque.
Setup Navigator Pour effectuer le paramtrage partir du menu Setup Navigator. Pour le dtail, reportez-vous page 23.
Security
Change Password Enregistrez (changez) le mot de passe pour utiliser le contrle parental ou lannuler lors de la lecture
de DVD-Vido pourvus dun contrle parental (page 45).
Parental Control Changez le niveau du contrle parental du lecteur (page 46).
Country Code Changez le code de pays/rgion (page 46).
42
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 43 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
30 min
Quick Start On Slectionnez cette option pour rduire le temps de mise en route.
Off Slectionnez cette option pour une mise en route normale.
Update Disc Slectionnez cette option pour choisir la mthode de mise jour du logiciel. (page 46)
USB Storage
Network
Load Default Pour rtablir les rglages usine.
System Information Pour vrifier le numro de version du systme.
Disc Auto Update On Pour afficher lcran de mise jour du logiciel quand le disque contenant le fichier
de mise jour du lecteur est insr.
Off Lcran de mise jour doit tre affich manuellement. (page 46)
BUDA BUDA Pour afficher et configurer les donnes BUDA sur la cl USB insre.
Information
BUDA Setup
43
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 44 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
44
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 45 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Remarque
Si vous prcisez une langue non enregistre sur le BD
ou le DVD, une des langues enregistres sera
automatiquement slectionne et utilise.
45
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 46 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
46
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 47 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
47
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 48 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
48
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 49 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Chapitre 8 08
Informations supplmentaires
Avis relatif la INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms
except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright
logiciel
ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES form of a textual message at program startup or in
WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA documentation (online or textual) provided with the
OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, package.
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or
Le logiciel libre utilis dans ce lecteur OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR without modification, are permitted provided that the
est distribu sous les licences PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. following conditions are met:
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
suivantes. Pour des raisons de holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
prcision, nous avons inclus les textes promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software disclaimer.
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
originaux (en anglais). above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
jpeg following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
curl This software is based in part on the work of the materials provided with the distribution.
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE independent JPEG Group. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
Copyright 1996 - 2007, Daniel Stenberg, this software must display the following
<[email protected]>. All rights reserved. openssl acknowledgement:
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the "This product includes cryptographic software written
software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby conditions of the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word
granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this license apply to the toolkit. 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the
permission notice appear in all copies. See below for the actual license texts. Actually both library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
THE SOF TWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" , WI THOUT licenses are BSD-style Open Source licenses. In case of any 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, license issues related to OpenSSL please contact openssl- derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF [email protected]. code) you must include an acknowledgement:
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL License "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights ([email protected])"
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR reserved. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS''
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN without modification, are permitted provided that the INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING following conditions are met: WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
SOFTWARE. disclaimer. LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. materials provided with the distribution. OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
expat this software must display the following IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software acknowledgment: NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
Center Ltd "This product includes software developed by the OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:/ THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
obtaining a copy of this software and associated /www.openssl.org/)" The licence and distribution terms for any publically
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" available version or derivative of this code cannot be
without restriction, including without limitation the rights must not be used to endorse or promote products changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, derived from this software without prior written under another distribution licence [including the GNU
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to permission. For written permission, please contact Public Licence.]
[email protected].
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the
following conditions: 5. Products derived from this software may not be called zlib
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names This software is based in part on zlib see http://www.zlib.net
be included in all copies or substantial portions of the without prior written permission of the OpenSSL for information.
Software. Project.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the GNU General Public License and
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, following acknowledgment: GNU Lesser General Public License
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF "This product includes software developed by the
This product includes the following software licensed for
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://
use under the terms of GNU General
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. www.openssl.org/)"
Public License v2, GNU Lesser General Public License v2.1.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL
linux kernel 2.6. Copyright (C) 1991 Linus Torvalds.
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED
Licensed under GPLv2.0
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
BusyBox v1.17.1 multi-call binary. Copyright (C) 1998-
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
2009 Erik Andersen, Rob Landley, Denys Vlasenko and
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
others. Licensed under GPLv2.0
USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL
SquashFS Copyright: (C) 2002-2009 Phillip Lougher
PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
freetype DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
Licensed under GPL v2.0
Das U-Boot Copyright: (C) 2000-2005 Wolfang Denk,
This software is based in part on freetype see http:// OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
DENX Software Engineering, [email protected]. Licensed
www.freetype.org for information. LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
under GPL v2.0
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
LIRC 0.8.5 Copyright (C) 1996 Ralph Metzler
International Components for BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
<[email protected]> Copyright (C) 1998-2008
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
Unicode STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
Christoph Bartelmus <[email protected]> Licensed
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later under GPL v2.0
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE glibc 2.9 Copyright (C) 1992-2006, 2007 Free Software
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
Copyright (c) 1995-2010 International Business Machines Foundation, Inc. Licensed under LGPL v2.1.
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Corporation and others You can get corresponding open source code from the
This product includes cryptographic software written by
All rights reserved. following URL.
Eric Young ([email protected]). This product includes
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person http://www.oss-pioneer.com/homeav/blu-ray
software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
obtaining a copy of this software and associated Please refer to the following URL for further information of
Original SSLeay License
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software GNU General Public License Version 2.
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected])
without restriction, including without limitation the rights http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl-2.0.html
All rights reserved.
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell Please refer to the following URL for further information of
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the GNU Library General Public License Version 2.1.
Young ([email protected]).
Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
The implementation was written so as to conform with
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all Netscapes SSL.
copies of the Software and that both the above copyright GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting Version 2, June 1991
as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
following conditions apply to all code found in this
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA 49
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 50 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim ordinary way, to print or display an announcement (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
08 copies of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
including an appropriate copyright notice and a
notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
Preamble you provide a warranty) and that users may cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your
The licenses for most software are designed to take away redistribute the program under these conditions, and obligations under this License and any other pertinent
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU telling the user how to view a copy of this License. obligations, then as a consequence you may not
General Public License is intended to guarantee your (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure does not normally print such an announcement, your license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of
the software is free for all its users. This General Public work based on the Program is not required to print an the Program by all those who receive copies directly or
License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's announcement.) indirectly through you, then the only way you could
software and to any other program whose authors commit These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the entirely from distribution of the Program.
is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License Program, and can be reasonably considered independent If any portion of this section is held invalid or
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. and separate works in themselves, then this License, and unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
When we speak of free software, we are referring to its terms, do not apply to those sections when you balance of the section is intended to apply and the
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute section as a whole is intended to apply in other
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based circumstances.
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get the terms of this License, whose permissions for other infringe any patents or other property right claims or to
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and contest validity of any such claims; this section has the
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you every part regardless of who wrote it. sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
can do these things. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or software distribution system, which is implemented by
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, public license practices. Many people have made
forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution generous contributions to the wide range of software
surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain of derivative or collective works based on the Program. distributed through that system in reliance on
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on consistent application of that system; it is up to the
software, or if you modify it. the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium distribute software through any other system and a
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all does not bring the other work under the scope of this licensee cannot impose that choice.
the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, License. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what
receive or can get the source code. And you must show 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
them these terms so they know their rights. based on it, under Section 2) in object code or License.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal above provided that you also do one of the following: restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to machine-readable source code, which must be who places the Program under this License may add an
make certain that everyone understands that there is no distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
warranty for this free software. If the software is modified on a medium customarily used for software those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to interchange; or, or among countries not thus excluded. In such case,
know that what they have is not the original, so that any b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least this License incorporates the limitation as if written in
problems introduced by others will not reflect on the three years, to give any third party, for a charge no the body of this License.
original authors' reputations. more than your cost of physically performing source 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of or new versions of the General Public License from time
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that the corresponding source code, to be distributed to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a present version, but may differ in detail to address new
patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. medium customarily used for software interchange; problems or concerns.
To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must or, Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. c) Accompany it with the information you received as to If the Program specifies a version number of this
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution the offer to distribute corresponding source code. License which applies to it and "any later version", you
and modification follow. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial have the option of following the terms and conditions
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE distribution and only if you received the program in either of that version or of any later version published by
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION object code or executable form with such an offer, in the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not
AND MODIFICATION accord with Subsection b above.) specify a version number of this License, you may
0. This License applies to any program or other work The source code for a work means the preferred form of the choose any version ever published by the Free Software
which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder work for making modifications to it. For an executable Foundation.
saying it may be distributed under the terms of this work, complete source code means all the source code for 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to all modules it contains, plus any associated interface other free programs whose distribution conditions are
any such program or work, and a "work based on the definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
Program" means either the Program or any derivative and installation of the executable. However, as a special software which is copyrighted by the Free Software
work under copyright law: that is to say, a work exception, the source code distributed need not include Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we
containing the Program or a portion of it, either anything that is normally distributed (in either source or sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included and so on) of the operating system on which the executable of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting
without limitation in the term "modification".) Each runs, unless that component itself accompanies the the sharing and reuse of software generally.
licensee is addressed as "you". executable. NO WARRANTY
Activities other than copying, distribution and If distribution of executable or object code is made by 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF
modification are not covered by this License; they are offering access to copy from a designated place, then CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
restricted, and the output from the Program is covered same place counts as distribution of the source code, even APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE
only if its contents constitute a work based on the though third parties are not compelled to copy the source STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
Program (independent of having been made by running along with the object code. OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
Program does. Program except as expressly provided under this EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Program's source code as you receive it, in any sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
medium, provided that you conspicuously and automatically terminate your rights under this License. PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate However, parties who have received copies, or rights, QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact from you under this License will not have their licenses WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
all the notices that refer to this License and to the terminated so long as such parties remain in full DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients compliance. NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
of the Program a copy of this License along with the 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
Program. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring permission to modify or distribute the Program or its COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM
protection in exchange for a fee. you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or or distributing the Program (or any work based on the DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that distributing or modifying the Program or works based PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS
you also meet all of these conditions: on it. OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent 6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES
notices stating that you changed the files and the based on the Program), the recipient automatically OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
date of any change. receives a license from the original licensor to copy, ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived and conditions. You may not impose any further POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
terms of this License. compliance by third parties to this License. If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the
50 c) If the modified program normally reads commands
interactively when run, you must cause it, when
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation
of patent infringement or for any other reason (not
greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve
this is to make it free software which everyone can
Fr started running for such interactive use in the most limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you redistribute and change under these terms.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 51 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we depends on what the Library does and what the
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most
effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file
copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license,
which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or
program that uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
08
should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to modify the library. Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any
where the full notice is found. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear medium, provided that you conspicuously and
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
of what it does.> library is modified by someone else and passed on, the copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> recipients should know that what they have is not the all the notices that refer to this License and to the
This program is free software; you can redistribute it original version, so that the original author's reputation will absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General not be affected by problems that might be introduced by License along with the Library.
Public License as published by the Free Software others. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty
option) any later version. existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that protection in exchange for a fee.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library,
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license and copy and distribute such modifications or work
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you
Public License for more details. the full freedom of use specified in this license. also meet all of these conditions:
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
Public License along with this program; if not, write to the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain notices stating that you changed the files and the
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary date of any change.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic General Public License. We use this license for certain c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed
and paper mail. libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non- at no charge to all third parties under the terms of
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice free programs. this License.
like this when it starts in an interactive mode: When a program is linked with a library, whether statically d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of or using a shared library, the combination of the two is or a table of data to be supplied by an application
author legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the program that uses the facility, other than as an
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO original library. The ordinary General Public License argument passed when the facility is invoked, then
WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. therefore permits such linking only if the entire you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in
This is free software, and you are welcome to combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General the event an application does not supply such
redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other function or table, the facility still operates, and
for details. code with the library. performs whatever part of its purpose remains
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License meaningful.
show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the (For example, a function in a library to compute
Of course, the commands you use may be called ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could software developers Less of an advantage over competing defined independent of the application. Therefore,
even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
program. use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. function or table used by this function must be
You should also get your employer (if you work as a However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain optional: if the application does not supply it, the
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright special circumstances. square root function must still compute square
disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special roots.)
alter the names: need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain These requirements apply to the modified work as a
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
the program this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) A more frequent case is that a free library does the same considered independent and separate works in
written by James Hacker. job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989 little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, apply to those sections when you distribute them as
Ty Coon, President of Vice so we use the Lesser General Public License. separate works. But when you distribute the same
This General Public License does not permit incorporating In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non- sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
your program into proprietary programs. If your program is free programs enables a greater number of people to use a Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the
a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to large body of free software. For example, permission to use terms of this License, whose permissions for other
permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each
this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Public License instead of this License. well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLICLICENSE protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
Version 2.1, February 1999 user of a program that is linked with the Library has the distribution of derivative or collective works based on
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a the Library.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA modified version of the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
copies of this license document, but changing it is not and modification follow. Pay close attention to the based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
allowed. difference between a "work based on the library" and a distribution medium does not bring the other work
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also "work that uses the library". The former contains code under the scope of this License.
counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, derived from the library, whereas the latter must be 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU
version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] combined with the library in order to run. General Public License instead of this License to a given
Preamble GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the
The licenses for most software are designed to take away TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU AND MODIFICATION ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure or other program which contains a notice placed by the the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared,
the software is free for all its users. copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may then you can specify that version instead if you wish.)
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Do not make any other change in these notices.
some specially designated software packages--typically Public License (also called "this License"). Each Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other licensee is addressed as "you". irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we A "library" means a collection of software functions and/ Public License applies to all subsequent copies and
suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with derivative works made from that copy.
or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy application programs (which use some of those This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations functions and data) to form executables. code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
below. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
When we speak of free software, we are referring to or work which has been distributed under these terms. derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are A "work based on the Library" means either the Library executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, above provided that you accompany it with the
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either complete corresponding machine-readable source
service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get verbatim or with modifications and/or translated code, which must be distributed under the terms of
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed translation is included without limitation in the term for software interchange.
that you can do these things. "modification".) If distribution of object code is made by offering access
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of to copy from a designated place, then offering
forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to the work for making modifications to it. For a library, equivalent access to copy the source code from the
surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to complete source code means all the source code for all same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the modules it contains, plus any associated interface source code, even though third parties are not
library or if you modify it. definition files, plus the scripts used to control compelled to copy the source along with the object
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether compilation and installation of the library. code.
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights Activities other than copying, distribution and 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of
that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, modification are not covered by this License; they are the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code outside its scope. The act of running a program using being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that
with the library, you must provide complete object files to the Library is not restricted, and output from such a uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library
after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And
program is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Library (independent of the use of the
derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside
the scope of this License.
51
you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 52 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the and explaining where to find the accompanying WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
08 Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the
Library (because it contains portions of the Library),
uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
rather than a "work that uses the library". The distribute the Library except as expressly provided IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
executable is therefore covered by this License. Section under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
6 states terms for distribution of such executables. modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from void, and will automatically terminate your rights under RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
a header file that is part of the Library, the object code this License. However, parties who have received THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even copies, or rights, from you under this License will not PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is have their licenses terminated so long as such parties NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
especially significant if the work can be linked without remain in full compliance. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, permission to modify or distribute the Library or its MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY
data structure layouts and accessors, and small derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, or distributing the Library (or any work based on the INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
(Executables containing this object code plus portions do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) distributing or modifying the Library or works based on DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you it. LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
may distribute the object code for the work under the 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that based on the Library), the recipient automatically OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are receives a license from the original licensor to copy, OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
linked directly with the Library itself. distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also these terms and conditions. You may not impose any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
Library to produce a work containing portions of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making
choice, provided that the terms permit modification of 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation it free software that everyone can redistribute and change.
the work for the customer's own use and reverse of patent infringement or for any other reason (not You can do so by permitting redistribution under these
engineering for debugging such modifications. limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that General Public License).
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library contradict the conditions of this License, they do not To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the
and its use are covered by this License. You must excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
supply a copy of this License. If the work during cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
execution displays copyright notices, you must include obligations under this License and any other pertinent each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well obligations, then as a consequence you may not pointer to where the full notice is found.
as a reference directing the user to the copy of this distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of
License. Also, you must do one of these things: license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of what it does.>
a) Accompany the work with the complete the Library by all those who receive copies directly or Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
corresponding machine-readable source code for the indirectly through you, then the only way you could This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/
Library including whatever changes were used in the satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 entirely from distribution of the Library. Public
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked If any portion of this section is held invalid or License as published by the Free Software Foundation;
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or balance of the section is intended to apply, and the later version.
source code, so that the user can modify the Library section as a whole is intended to apply in other This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
and then relink to produce a modified executable circumstances. useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
containing the modified Library. (It is understood It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS
that the user who changes the contents of definitions infringe any patents or other property right claims or to FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser
files in the Library will not necessarily be able to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the General Public License for more details.
recompile the application to use the modified sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
definitions.) software distribution system which is implemented by General Public License along with this library; if not,
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking public license practices. Many people have made write to the Free Software
with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) generous contributions to the wide range of software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston,
uses at run time a copy of the library already present distributed through that system in reliance on MA 02110-1301 USA
on the user's computer system, rather than copying consistent application of that system; it is up to the Also add information on how to contact you by electronic
library functions into the executable, and (2) will author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to and paper mail.
operate properly with a modified version of the library, distribute software through any other system and a You should also get your employer (if you work as a
if the user installs one, as long as the modified licensee cannot impose that choice. programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright
version is interface-compatible with the version that This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
the work was made with. is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this alter the names:
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in
least three years, to give the same user the materials 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted by James Random Hacker.
more than the cost of performing this distribution. interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access Library under this License may add an explicit Ty Coon, President of Vice
to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent geographical distribution limitation excluding those That's all there is to it!
access to copy the above specified materials from the countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
same place. among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this curl
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of License incorporates the limitation as if written in the AVIS DE COPYRIGHT ET AUTORISATION
these materials or that you have already sent this body of this License. Copyright 1996 - 2007, Daniel Stenberg,
user a copy. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/ <[email protected]>. Tous droits rservs.
For an executable, the required form of the "work that or new versions of the Lesser General Public License Le prsent document autorise utiliser, copier, modifier et
uses the Library" must include any data and utility from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in distribuer ce logiciel sans restriction titre gratuit ou non
programs needed for reproducing the executable from spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to condition que lavis de copyright et autorisation
it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be address new problems or concerns. susmentionn apparaisse sur toutes les copies.
distributed need not include anything that is normally Each version is given a distinguishing version number. LE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI "EN LTAT" SANS GARANTIE
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the If the Library specifies a version number of this License DAUCUNE SORTE, EXPRESSE OU IMPLICITE, Y
major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the which applies to it and "any later version", you have the COMPRIS, MAIS SY LIMITER, LES GARANTIES DE
operating system on which the executable runs, unless option of following the terms and conditions either of QUALIT MARCHANDE, DADQUATION UN USAGE
that component itself accompanies the executable. that version or of any later version published by the Free PARTICULIER ET DE NON-VIOLATION DES DROITS DE
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a TIERCES PARTIES. LES AUTEURS OU DTENTEURS DU
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do license version number, you may choose any version COPYRIGHT NE SAURAIENT EN AUCUN CAS TRE TENUS
not normally accompany the operating system. Such a ever published by the Free Software Foundation. RESPONSABLES DE TOUTE RCLAMATION OU
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other DOMMAGE, QUE CE SOIT DANS LE CADRE DUN
Library together in an executable that you distribute. free programs whose distribution conditions are CONTRAT, DUNE NGLIGENCE OU DUNE AUTRE
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for ACTION PRJUDICIABLE, D OU LI LUTILISATION OU
the Library side-by-side in a single library together with permission. For software which is copyrighted by the AUX PERFORMANCES DE CE LOGICIEL.
other library facilities not covered by this License, and Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Sous rserve des dispositions du prsent avis, le nom dun
distribute such a combined library, provided that the Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. dtenteur du copyright ne doit pas tre utilis pour
separate distribution of the work based on the Library Our decision will be guided by the two goals of annoncer ou promouvoir la vente, lutilisation ou toute
and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free autre activit lie au Logiciel sans lautorisation crite
and provided that you do these two things: software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of pralable dudit dtenteur.
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the software generally.
same work based on the Library, uncombined with NO WARRANTY expat
any other library facilities. This must be distributed 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software
52 under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of
CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
Center Ltd
Le prsent document autorise toute personne obtenant
Fr the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN une copie de ce logiciel et des scripts associs (le
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 53 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
"Logiciel") ngocier le Logiciel sans restriction, et en 4. Lutilisation des noms "OpenSSL Toolkit" et "OpenSSL NGLIGENCE OU AUTRE), EN RELATION AVEC TOUTE
particulier utiliser, copier, modifier, fusionner, publier,
distribuer, accorder sous licence et/ou vendre des copies
Project" des fins de promotion ou de valorisation de
produits drivs de ce logiciel est interdite sans
UTILISATION DU PRSENT LOGICIEL, ET CE,
INDPENDAMMENT DU CARACTRE PRVISIBLE OU
08
de ce Logiciel sans restriction, et permet toute personne autorisation crite pralable. Pour toute autorisation NON DE CES PRJUDICES.
laquelle le Logiciel est fourni de le faire condition que crite, veuillez contacter [email protected]. Les conditions de licence et de distribution pour toutes les
les mentions suivantes soient incluses : 5. Les produits drivs de ce logiciel ne doivent pas tre versions disponibles au public ou pour les drivs de ce
Lavis de copyright et lavis dautorisation susmentionns appels "OpenSSL" et "OpenSSL" ne doit pas figurer code ne peuvent pas tre modifies. En dautres termes, ce
doivent apparatre sur toutes les copies ou parties dans leurs noms sans autorisation pralable de code ne peut pas tre simplement copi et affect une
substantielles du Logiciel. lOpenSSL Project. autre licence de distribution [licence publique GNU
LE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI "EN LTAT" SANS GARANTIE 6. Les redistributions sous quelque forme que ce soit incluse].
DAUCUNE SORTE, EXPRESSE OU IMPLICITE, Y doivent reproduire lavis suivant :
COMPRIS, MAIS SANS QUE CELA NE SOIT LIMITATIF, LES "Ce produit comprend un logiciel dvelopp par le zlib
GARANTIES DE QUALIT MARCHANDE, DADQUATION Projet OpenSSL utiliser dans OpenSSL Toolkit (http:// Ce logiciel est partiellement bas sur la bibliothque zlib.
UN USAGE PARTICULIER ET DE NON-VIOLATION DES www.openssl.org/)". Voir http://www.zlib.net pour plus dinformations.
DROITS DE TIERCES PARTIES. CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI "EN LTAT" PAR OpenSSL
LES AUTEURS OU DTENTEURS DU COPYRIGHT NE PROJECT QUI NE DONNE AUCUNE GARANTIE, EXPLICITE Licence Publique Gnrale GNU et
SAURAIENT EN AUCUN CAS TRE TENUS OU IMPLICITE, NOTAMMENT, MAIS SANS QUE CELA NE Licence Publique Gnrale Limite
RESPONSABLES DE TOUTE RCLAMATION OU SOIT LIMITATIF, QUANT SA QUALITE MARCHANDE OU
DOMMAGE, QUE CE SOIT DANS LE CADRE DUN SON ADEQUATION UN BUT PARTICULIER. GNU
CONTRAT, DUNE NGLIGENCE OU DUNE AUTRE LOpenSSL PROJECT OU SES PARTENAIRES NE Ce produit comprend le logiciel suivant accord sous
ACTION PRJUDICIABLE, D OU LI LUTILISATION OU POURRONT TRE EN AUCUN CAS TENUS POUR licence pour tre utilis selon les termes de la Licence
AUX PERFORMANCES DE CE LOGICIEL. RESPONSABLES DES PRJUDICES DIRECTS, Gnrale Publique GNU v2, la Licence Gnral Publique
INDIRECTS, SPCIAUX, INCIDENTS OU PUNITIFS GNU Limite v2.1.
freetype (NOTAMMENT, MAIS SANS QUE CELA NE SOIT LIMITATIF, linux kernel 2.6. Copyright (C) 1991 Linus Torvalds. Sous
Ce logiciel est partiellement bas sur la bibliothque DES PRJUDICES LIS A LACHAT DE PRODUITS OU DE licence GPLv2.0
Freetype. Voir http://www.freetype.org pour plus SERVICES DE REMPLACEMENT, A UNE PERTE BusyBox v1.17.1 multi-call binary. Copyright (C) 1998-
dinformations. DUTILISATION, UNE PERTE DES DONNES OU AUX 2009 Erik Andersen, Rob Landley, Denys Vlasenko et
INTERRUPTIONS DACTIVIT) QUELLE QUEN SOIT LA autres. Sous licence GPLv2.0
Composants internationaux pour CAUSE ET QUILS SOIENT LIS UNE RESPONSABILITE, SquashFS Copyright : (C) 2002-2009 Phillip Lougher
Unicode UNE ACTION CONTRACTUELLE, DE RESPONSABILIT sous licence GPL v2.0
DIRECTE OU EXTRA-CONTRACTUELLE (Y COMPRIS POUR Das U-Boot Copyright : (C) 2000-2005 Wolfang Denk,
Licence ICU - ICU 1.8.1 et ultrieure NGLIGENCE OU AUTRE), EN RELATION AVEC TOUTE DENX Software Engineering, [email protected]. Sous
AVIS DE COPYRIGHT ET AUTORISATION UTILISATION DU PRSENT LOGICIEL, ET CE, licence GPL v2.0
Copyright (c) 1995-2010 International Business Machines INDPENDAMMENT DU CARACTRE PRVISIBLE OU LIRC 0.8.5 Copyright (C) 1996 Ralph Metzler
Corporation et autres NON DE CES PRJUDICES. <[email protected]> Copyright (C) 1998-2008
Tous droits rservs. Ce produit comprend un logiciel cryptographique crit par Christoph Bartelmus <[email protected]> Sous
Le prsent document autorise toute personne obtenant Eric Young ([email protected]). Ce produit comprend un licence GPL v2.0
une copie de ce logiciel et des scripts associs (le logiciel crit par Tim Hudson ([email protected]). glibc 2.9 Copyright (C) 1992-2006, 2007 Free Software
"Logiciel") ngocier le Logiciel sans restriction, et en Licence SSLeay originale Foundation, Inc. Sous licence LGPL v2.1.
particulier utiliser, copier, modifier, fusionner, publier, Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]) Vous pouvez vous procurer le code source correspondant
distribuer et/ou vendre des copies de ce Logiciel sans Tous droits rservs. ladresse suivante.
restriction, et permet toute personne laquelle le Logiciel Ce prologiciel est une implantation SSL crite par Eric http://www.oss-pioneer.com/homeav/blu-ray
est fourni de le faire condition que l(les) avis de copyright Young ([email protected]). Veuillez vous reporter ladresse suivante pour plus
ci-dessus et que le prsent avis dautorisation figurent dans Lcriture de limplantation se conforme Netscapes SSL. dinformations sur la Version 2 de la Licence Publique
toutes les copies du Logiciel et que l(les) avis de copyright Cette bibliothque est un logiciel libre qui peut tre utilis Gnrale GNU.
susmentionn(s) ainsi que la prsente autorisation titre commercial ou non sous rserve des conditions http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl-2.0.html
apparaissent dans la documentation annexe. suivantes. Les conditions suivantes sappliquent tout Veuillez vous reporter ladresse suivante pour plus
LE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI "EN LTAT" SANS GARANTIE code trouv dans cette distribution, que ce soit le code RC4, dinformations sur la Version 2.1 de la Licence Publique
DAUCUNE SORTE, EXPRESSE OU IMPLICITE, Y RSA, lhash, DES, etc., pas seulement le code SSL. La Gnrale GNU pour les bibliothques.
COMPRIS, MAIS SANS QUE CELA NE SOIT LIMITATIF, LES documentation SSL incluse avec cette distribution est http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
GARANTIES DE QUALIT MARCHANDE, DADQUATION couverte par les mmes termes de copyright mais le
UN USAGE PARTICULIER ET DE NON-VIOLATION DES dtenteur en est Tim Hudson ([email protected]). Licence Publique Gnrale GNU
DROITS DE TIERCES PARTIES. LE OU LES DTENTEURS Le copyright demeure la proprit dEric Young, et par Benjamin Drieu, APRIL ([email protected]), Mlanie
DU COPYRIGHT MENTIONNS DANS CET AVIS NE consquent aucune mention de copyright figurant dans le Clment-Fontaine ([email protected]), Arnaud
SAURAIENT EN AUCUN CAS TRE TENUS code ne doit tre supprime. Si ce progiciel est intgr un Fontaine ([email protected]), Loc Dachary ([email protected]),
RESPONSABLES DE TOUTE RCLAMATION OU produit, les droits dauteur des lments de la bibliothque Frdric Couchet ([email protected]).
DOMMAGE INDIRECT OU CONSCUTIF OU DE TOUT utilise doivent tre attribus Eric Young. Cette This is an unofficial translation of the GNU General Public
AUTRE DOMMAGE LI LA PERTE DUTILISATION, DE reconnaissance peut se faire sous forme de message License into French. It was not published by the Free
DONNES OU DE BNFICES, QUE CE SOIT DANS LE textuel apparaissant au lancement du programme ou dans Software Foundation, and does not legally state the
CADRE DUN CONTRAT, DUNE NGLIGENCE OU DUNE la documentation (en ligne ou textuelle) fournie avec le distribution terms for software that uses the GNU GPL--only
AUTRE ACTION PRJUDICIABLE, DUS OU LIS prologiciel. the original English text of the GNU GPL does that. However,
LUTILISATION OU AUX PERFORMANCES DE CE La redistribution et lemploi sous formes source et binaire, we hope that this translation will help French speakers
LOGICIEL. avec ou sans modification, sont autoriss condition que : understand the GNU GPL better.
Sous rserve des dispositions du prsent avis, le nom dun 1. La redistribution du code source retienne lavis de Ceci est une traduction non officielle de la GNU General
dtenteur du copyright ne doit pas tre utilis pour copyright, la liste des conditions et lavis de non- Public License en franais. Elle n'a pas t publie par la Free
annoncer ou promouvoir la vente, lutilisation ou toute responsabilit suivant. Software Foundation, et ne dtermine pas les termes de
autre activit lie au Logiciel sans lautorisation crite 2. Les redistributions sous forme binaire reproduisent distribution pour les logiciels qui utilisent la GNU GPL, seul
pralable dudit dtenteur. lavis de copyright ci-dessus, la liste des conditions et le texte anglais original de la GNU GPL dterminent ces
jpeg lavis de non-responsabilit suivant dans la
documentation et/ou les matriaux qui accompagnent
termes. Cependant, nous esprons que cette traduction
aidera les francophones mieux comprendre la GNU GPL.
Ce logiciel est partiellement bas sur les travaux de la distribution. Licence Publique Gnrale GNU
lIndependent JPEG Group. 3. Tous les matriaux de promotion mentionnant les Les licences de la plupart des logiciels sont conues pour
openssl caractristiques ou lemploi de ce logiciel doivent
reproduire lavis suivant :
vous enlever toute libert de les partager et de les modifier.
A contrario, la Licence Publique Gnrale est destine
LOpenSSL Toolkit demeure sous double licence, cest-- "Ce produit comprend un logiciel cryptographique crit garantir votre libert de partager et de modifier les logiciels
dire que les conditions de la Licence Open SSL et la licence par Eric Young ([email protected])". Le terme libres, et assurer que ces logiciels soient libres pour tous
originale SSLeay sappliquent au Toolkit. "cryptographique" peut tre omis si les sous- leurs utilisateurs.
Voir ci-dessous les textes de la licence. Les deux licences programmes de la bibliothque utilise ne sont de type La prsente Licence Publique Gnrale s'applique la
sont des licences Open Source de style BSD. Pour tout cryptographique :-). plupart des logiciels de la Free Software Foundation, ainsi
problme de licence li OpenSSL, veuillez contacter 4. Si vous insrez un code spcifique Windows (ou un de qu' tout autre programme pour lequel ses auteurs
[email protected]. ses drivs) partir du rpertoire apps (code s'engagent l'utiliser.
Licence OpenSSL dapplication), vous devez inclure la mention : (Certains autres logiciels de la Free Software Foundation
Copyright (c) 1998-2008 Le Projet OpenSSL. Tous droits "Ce produit comprend un logiciel cr * par Tim Hudson sont couverts par la GNU Lesser General Public License
rservs. ([email protected])". la place.)
La redistribution et lemploi sous formes source et binaire, CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI "EN LTAT" PAR ERIC YOUNG Vous pouvez aussi l'appliquer aux programmes qui sont les
avec ou sans modification, sont autoriss condition que : QUI NE DONNE AUCUNE GARANTIE, EXPLICITE OU vtres.
1. La redistribution du code source retienne lavis de IMPLICITE, NOTAMMENT, MAIS SANS QUE CELA NE SOIT Quand nous parlons de logiciels libres, nous parlons de
copyright ci-dessus, la liste des conditions et lavis de LIMITATIF, QUANT SA QUALITE MARCHANDE OU libert, non de prix.
non-responsabilit suivant. SON ADEQUATION UN BUT PARTICULIER. EN AUCUN Nos licences publiques gnrales sont conues pour vous
2. Les redistributions sous forme binaire reproduisent CAS LAUTEUR OU SES PARTENAIRES NE POURRONT donner l'assurance d'tre libres de distribuer des copies
lavis de copyright ci-dessus, la liste des conditions et TRE EN AUCUN CAS TENUS POUR RESPONSABLES des logiciels libres (et de facturer ce service, si vous le
lavis de non-responsabilit suivant dans la DES PRJUDICES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, SPCIAUX, souhaitez), de recevoir le code source ou de pouvoir
documentation et/ou les matriaux qui accompagnent INCIDENTS OU PUNITIFS (NOTAMMENT, MAIS SANS QUE l'obtenir si vous le souhaitez, de pouvoir modifier les
la distribution. CELA NE SOIT LIMITATIF, DES PRJUDICES LIS A logiciels ou en utiliser des lments dans de nouveaux
3. Tous les matriaux de promotion mentionnant les LACHAT DE PRODUITS OU DE SERVICES DE programmes libres et de savoir que vous pouvez le faire.
caractristiques ou lemploi de ce logiciel doivent REMPLACEMENT, A UNE PERTE DUTILISATION, UNE Pour protger vos droits, il nous est ncessaire d'imposer
reproduire lavis suivant : PERTE DES DONNES OU AUX INTERRUPTIONS des limitations qui interdisent quiconque de vous refuser
"Ce produit comprend un logiciel dvelopp par le DACTIVIT) QUELLE QUEN SOIT LA CAUSE ET QUILS ces droits ou de vous demander d'y renoncer.
Projet OpenSSL utiliser dans OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:/
/www.openssl.org/)"
SOIENT LIS UNE RESPONSABILITE, UNE ACTION
CONTRACTUELLE, DE RESPONSABILIT DIRECTE OU
Certaines responsabilits vous incombent en raison de ces
limitations si vous distribuez des copies de ces logiciels, ou
53
EXTRA-CONTRACTUELLE (Y COMPRIS POUR si vous les modifiez. Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 54 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Par exemple, si vous distribuez des copies d'un tel le programme en respectant les prsentes faisant, et de toutes ses conditions concernant la copie,
08 programme, titre gratuit ou contre une rmunration,
vous devez accorder aux destinataires tous les droits dont
obligations, et expliquant l'utilisateur comment voir
une copie de la prsente Licence.
la distribution ou la modification du Programme ou
d'ouvrages fonds sur lui.
vous disposez. (Exception : si le Programme est lui-mme interactif 6. Chaque fois que vous redistribuez le Programme (ou
Vous devez vous assurer qu'eux aussi reoivent ou puissent mais n'imprime pas habituellement une telle n'importe quel ouvrage fond sur le Programme), une
disposer du code source. annonce, votre ouvrage fond sur le Programme n'est licence est automatiquement concde au destinataire
Et vous devez leur montrer les prsentes conditions afin pas oblig d'imprimer une annonce). par le concdant originel de la licence, l'autorisant
qu'ils aient connaissance de leurs droits. Ces obligations s'appliquent l'ouvrage modifi pris copier, distribuer ou modifier le Programme, sous
Nous protgeons vos droits en deux tapes : (1) nous comme un tout. rserve des prsentes conditions. Vous ne pouvez
sommes titulaires des droits d'auteur du logiciel, et (2) nous Si des lments identifiables de cet ouvrage ne sont pas imposer une quelconque limitation supplmentaire
vous dlivrons cette licence, qui vous donne l'autorisation fonds sur le Programme et peuvent raisonnablement tre l'exercice des droits octroys au titre des prsentes par
lgale de copier, distribuer et/ou modifier le logiciel. considrs comme des ouvrages indpendants distincts le destinataire. Vous n'avez pas la responsabilit
En outre, pour la protection de chaque auteur ainsi que la en eux mmes, alors la prsente Licence et ses conditions d'imposer le respect de la prsente Licence des tiers.
ntre, nous voulons nous assurer que chacun comprenne ne s'appliquent pas ces lments lorsque vous les 7. Si, consquement une dcision de justice ou
que ce logiciel libre ne fait l'objet d'aucune garantie. distribuez en tant qu'ouvrages distincts. l'allgation d'une transgression de brevet ou pour toute
Si le logiciel est modifi par quelqu'un d'autre puis transmis Mais lorsque vous distribuez ces mmes lments comme autre raison (non limite un probleme de brevet), des
des tiers, nous voulons que les destinataires soient mis partie d'un tout, lequel constitue un ouvrage fond sur le obligations vous sont imposes (que ce soit par
au courant que ce qu'ils ont reu n'est pas le logiciel Programme, la distribution de ce tout doit tre soumise aux jugement, conciliation ou autre) qui contredisent les
d'origine, de sorte que tout problme introduit par d'autres conditions de la prsente Licence, et les autorisations conditions de la prsente Licence, elles ne vous
ne puisse entacher la rputation de l'auteur originel. qu'elle octroie aux autres concessionnaires s'tendent excusent pas des conditions de la prsente Licence. Si
En dfinitive, un programme libre restera la merci des l'ensemble de l'ouvrage et par consquent chaque et vous ne pouvez distribuer de manire satisfaire
brevets de logiciels. toute partie indiffrement de qui l'a crite. simultanment vos obligations au titre de la prsente
Nous souhaitons viter le risque que les redistributeurs Par consquent, l'objet du prsent article n'est pas de Licence et toute autre obligation pertinente, alors il en
d'un programme libre fassent des demandes individuelles revendiquer des droits ou de contester vos droits sur un dcoule que vous ne pouvez pas du tout distribuer le
de licence de brevet, ceci ayant pour effet de rendre le ouvrage entirement crit par vous; son objet est plutt Programme. Par exemple, si une licence de brevet ne
programme propritaire. d'exercer le droit de contrler la distribution d'ouvrages permettait pas une redistribution sans redevance du
Pour viter cela, nous tablissons clairement que toute drivs ou d'ouvrages collectifs fonds sur le Programme. Programme par tous ceux qui reoivent une copie
licence de brevet doit tre concde de faon ce que De plus, la simple proximit du Programme avec un autre directement ou indirectement par votre intermdiaire,
l'usage en soit libre pour tous ou bien qu'aucune licence ne ouvrage qui n'est pas fond sur le Programme (ou un alors la seule faon pour vous de satisfaire la fois la
soit concde. ouvrage fond sur le Programme) sur une partition d'un licence du brevet et la prsente Licence serait de vous
Les termes exacts et les conditions de copie, distribution et espace de stockage ou un support de distribution ne place abstenir totalement de toute distribution du
modification sont les suivants: pas cet autre ouvrage dans le champ d'application de la Programme.
Conditions de copie, distribution et modification de la prsente Licence. Si une partie quelconque de cet article est tenue pour
Licence Publique Gnrale GNU. 3. Vous pouvez copier et distribuer le Programme (ou un nulle ou inopposable dans une circonstance
0. La prsente Licence s'applique tout programme ou ouvrage fond sur lui, selon l'Article 2) sous forme de particulire quelconque, l'intention est que le reste de
tout autre ouvrage contenant un avis, appos par le code objet ou d'excutable, selon les termes des l'article s'applique. La totalit de la section s'appliquera
titulaire des droits d'auteur, stipulant qu'il peut tre Articles 1 et 2 ci-dessus, condition que vous dans toutes les autres circonstances.
distribu au titre des conditions de la prsente Licence accomplissiez l'un des points suivants : Cet article n'a pas pour but de vous induire
Publique Gnrale. a) L'accompagner de l'intgralit du code source transgresser un quelconque brevet ou d'autres
Ci-aprs, le "Programme" dsigne l'un quelconque de correspondant, sous une forme lisible par un revendications un droit de proprit ou contester la
ces programmes ou ouvrages, et un "ouvrage fond sur ordinateur, lequel doit tre distribu au titre des validit de la moindre de ces revendications ; cet article
le Programme" dsigne soit le Programme, soit un termes des Articles 1 et 2 ci-dessus, sur un support a pour seul objectif de protger l'intgrit du systme de
ouvrage qui en drive au titre des lois sur le droit habituellement utilis pour l'change de logiciels; ou, distribution du logiciel libre, qui est mis en oeuvre par
d'auteur : en d'autres termes, un ouvrage contenant le b) L'accompagner d'une proposition crite, valable la pratique des licenses publiques. De nombreuses
Programme ou une partie de ce dernier, soit pendant au moins trois ans, de fournir tout tiers, personnes ont fait de gnreuses contributions au
l'identique, soit avec des modifications et/ou traduit un tarif qui ne soit pas suprieur ce que vous cote large spectre de logiciels distribus par ce systme en
dans un autre langage. l'acte physique de raliser une distribution source, se fiant l'application cohrente de ce systme ; il
(Ci-aprs, le terme "modification" implique, sans s'y une copie intgrale du code source correspondant appartient chaque auteur/donateur de dcider si il ou
rduire, le terme traduction) sous une forme lisible par un ordinateur, qui sera elle veut distribuer du logiciel par l'intermdiaire d'un
Chaque concessionaire sera dsign par "vous". distribue au titre des termes des Articles 1 et 2 ci- quelconque autre systme et un concessionaire ne
Les activits autres que la copie, la distribution et la dessus, sur un support habituellement utilis pour peut imposer ce choix.
modification ne sont pas couvertes par la prsente l'change de logiciels; ou, Cet article a pour but de rendre totalement limpide ce
Licence ; elles sont hors de son champ d'application. c) L'accompagner des informations reues par vous que l'on pense tre une consquence du reste de la
L'opration consistant excuter le Programme n'est concernant la proposition de distribution du code prsente Licence.
soumise aucune limitation et les sorties du source correspondant. (Cette solution n'est autorise 8. Si la distribution et/ou l'utilisation du Programme est
programme ne sont couvertes que si leur contenu que dans le cas d'une distribution non commerciale limite dans certains pays que ce soit par des brevets
constitue un ouvrage fond sur le Programme et seulement si vous avez reu le programme sous ou par des interfaces soumises au droit d'auteur, le
(indpendamment du fait qu'il ait t ralis par forme de code objet ou d'excutable accompagn titulaire originel des droits d'auteur qui dcide de
l'excution du Programme). d'une telle proposition - en conformit avec le sous- couvrir le Programme par la prsente Licence peut
La validit de ce qui prcde dpend de ce que fait le Article b ci-dessus.) ajouter une limitation gographique de distribution
Programme. Le code source d'un ouvrage dsigne la forme favorite pour explicite qui exclue ces pays afin que la distribution soit
1. Vous pouvez copier et distribuer des copies l'identique travailler des modifications de cet ouvrage. Pour un permise seulement dans ou entre les pays qui ne sont
du code source du Programme tel que vous l'avez reu, ouvrage excutable, le code source intgral dsigne la pas ainsi exclus. Dans ce cas, la prsente Licence
sur n'importe quel support, du moment que vous totalit du code source de la totalit des modules qu'il incorpore la limitation comme si elle tait crite dans le
apposiez sur chaque copie, de manire ad hoc et contient, ainsi que les ventuels fichiers de dfinition des corps de la prsente Licence.
parfaitement visible, l'avis de droit d'auteur adquat et interfaces qui y sont associs, ainsi que les scripts utiliss 9. La Free Software Foundation peut, de temps autre,
une exonration de garantie ; que vous gardiez intacts pour contrler la compilation et l'installation de publier des versions rvises et/ou nouvelles de la
tous les avis faisant rfrence la prsente Licence et l'excutable. Cependant, par exception spciale, le code Licence Publique Gnrale. De telles nouvelles versions
l'absence de toute garantie ; et que vous fournissiez source distribu n'est pas cens inclure quoi que ce soit de seront similaires la prsente version dans l'esprit mais
tout destinataire du Programme autre que vous-mme normalement distribu (que ce soit sous forme source ou pourront diffrer dans le dtail pour prendre en compte
un exemplaire de la prsente Licence en mme temps binaire) avec les composants principaux (compilateur, de nouvelles problmatiques ou inquitudes.
que le Programme. noyau, et autre) du systme d'exploitation sur lequel Chaque version possde un numro de version la
Vous pouvez faire payer l'acte physique de transmission l'excutable tourne, moins que ce composant lui-mme distinguant. Si le Programme prcise le numro de
d'une copie, et vous pouvez, votre discrtion, proposer n'accompagne l'excutable. version de la prsente Licence qui s'y applique et "une
une garantie contre rmunration. Si distribuer un excutable ou un code objet consiste version ultrieure quelconque", vous avez le choix de
2. Vous pouvez modifier votre copie ou des copies du offrir un accs permettant leur copie depuis un endroit suivre les conditions de la prsente version ou de toute
Programme ou n'importe quelle partie de celui-ci, particulier, alors l'offre d'un accs quivalent pour copier le autre version ultrieure publie par la Free Software
crant ainsi un ouvrage fond sur le Programme, et code source depuis le mme endroit compte comme une Foundation. Si le Programme ne spcifie aucun
copier et distribuer de telles modifications ou ouvrage distribution du code source - mme si les tiers ne sont pas numro de version de la prsente Licence, vous pouvez
selon les termes de l'Article 1 ci-dessus, condition de contraints de copier le source en mme temps que le code choisir une version quelconque publie par la Free
vous conformer galement chacune des obligations objet. Software Foundation quelque moment que ce soit.
suivantes : 4. Vous ne pouvez copier, modifier, concder en sous- 10. Si vous souhaitez incorporer des parties du Programme
a) Vous devez munir les fichiers modifis d'avis bien licence, ou distribuer le Programme, sauf tel dans d'autres programmes libres dont les conditions de
visibles stipulants que vous avez modifi ces fichiers, qu'expressment prvu par la prsente Licence. Toute distribution sont diffrentes, crivez l'auteur pour lui
ainsi que la date de chaque modification ; tentative de copier, modifier, concder en sous-licence, en demander l'autorisation. Pour les logiciels dont la
b) Vous devez prendre les dispositions ncessaires pour ou distribuer le Programme d'une autre manire est Free Software Foundation est titulaire des droits
que tout ouvrage que vous distribuez ou publiez, et rpute non valable, et met immdiatement fin vos d'auteur, crivez la Free Software Foundation ; nous
qui, en totalit ou en partie, contient ou est fond sur droits au titre de la prsente Licence. Toutefois, les tiers faisons parfois des exceptions dans ce sens. Notre
le Programme - ou une partie quelconque de ce ayant reu de vous des copies, ou des droits, au titre de dcision sera guide par le double objectif de prserver
dernier - soit concd comme un tout, titre gratuit, la prsente Licence ne verront pas leurs autorisations le statut libre de tous les drivs de nos logiciels libres
n'importe quel tiers, au titre des conditions de la rsilies aussi longtemps que ledits tiers se conforment et de promouvoir le partage et la rutilisation des
prsente Licence. pleinement elle. logiciels en gnral.
c) Si le programme modifi lit habituellement des 5. Vous n'tes pas oblig d'accepter la prsente Licence ABSENCE DE GARANTIE
instructions de faon interactive lorsqu'on l'excute, tant donn que vous ne l'avez pas signe. Cependant, 11. COMME LA LICENCE DU PROGRAMME EST
vous devez, quand il commence son excution pour rien d'autre ne vous accorde l'autorisation de modifier CONCEDEE A TITRE GRATUIT, AUCUNE GARANTIE NE
ladite utilisation interactive de la manire la plus ou distribuer le Programme ou les ouvrages fonds sur S'APPLIQUE AU PROGRAMME, DANS LES LIMITES
usuelle, faire en sorte qu'il imprime ou affiche une lui. Ces actions sont interdites par la loi si vous AUTORISEES PAR LA LOI APPLICABLE. SAUF
annonce comprenant un avis de droit d'auteur ad n'acceptez pas la prsente Licence. En consquence, MENTION CONTRAIRE ECRITE, LES TITULAIRES DU
54 hoc, et un avis stipulant qu'il n'y a pas de garantie (ou
bien indiquant que c'est vous qui fournissez la
en modifiant ou distribuant le Programme (ou un
ouvrage quelconque fond sur le Programme), vous
DROIT D'AUTEUR ET/OU LES AUTRES PARTIES
FOURNISSENT LE PROGRAMME "EN L'ETAT", SANS
Fr garantie), et que les utilisateurs peuvent redistribuer signifiez votre acceptation de la prsente Licence en le AUCUNE GARANTIE DE QUELQUE NATURE QUE CE
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 55 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
SOIT, EXPRESSE OU IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, MAIS La copie et la distribution de copies exactes de ce Un cas plus frquemment rencontr est celui o une
SANS Y ETRE LIMITE, LES GARANTIES IMPLICITES DE
COMMERCIABILITE ET DE LA CONFORMITE A UNE
document sont autorises, mais aucune modification nest
permise.
bibliothque libre remplit la mme fonction que des
bibliothques non libres et trs rpandues. Il y a alors peu
08
UTILISATION PARTICULIERE. VOUS ASSUMEZ LA [Ceci est la premire version de la GPL Limite. Elle gagner limiter la bibliothque libre aux logiciels libres,
TOTALITE DES RISQUES LIES A LA QUALITE ET AUX succde la version 2 de la Licence Publique GNU pour les et on utilisera la Licence Publique Gnrale Limite.
PERFORMANCES DU PROGRAMME. SI LE bibliothques, do le numro de version 2.1. Dans dautres cas, autoriser des programmes non libres
PROGRAMME SE REVELAIT DEFECTUEUX, LE COUT Prambule utiliser une bibliothque particulire autorise plus de
DE L'ENTRETIEN, DES REPARATIONS OU DES Les licences de la plupart des logiciels sont conues pour monde utiliser une grande quantit de logiciels libres.
CORRECTIONS NECESSAIRES VOUS INCOMBENT vous enlever toute libert de les partager et de les modifier. Par exemple, la permission dutiliser la bibliothque GNU
INTEGRALEMENT. A contrario, les Licences Publiques Gnrales GNU sont pour le langage C dans des programmes non libres permet
12. EN AUCUN CAS, SAUF LORSQUE LA LOI APPLICABLE destines garantir votre libert de partager et de modifier beaucoup plus de gens dutiliser lensemble du systme
OU UNE CONVENTION ECRITE L'EXIGE, UN TITULAIRE les logiciels libres, et assurer que ces logiciels soient dexploitation GNU, ainsi que sa variante GNU/Linux.
DE DROIT D'AUTEUR QUEL QU'IL SOIT, OU TOUTE libres pour tous leurs utilisateurs. Bien que la Licence Publique Gnrale Limite limite la
PARTIE QUI POURRAIT MODIFIER ET/OU La prsente Licence Publique Gnrale sapplique la libert des utilisateurs, elle assure que lutilisateur dun
REDISTRIBUER LE PROGRAMME COMME PERMIS CI- plupart des logiciels de la Free Software Foundation, ainsi programme li avec la Bibliothque a la libert et la
DESSUS, NE POURRAIT ETRE TENU POUR qu tout autre programme pour lequel ses auteurs possibilit dexcuter ce programme en utilisant une
RESPONSABLE A VOTRE EGARD DES DOMMAGES, sengagent lutiliser. Vous pouvez aussi lappliquer aux version modifie de la Bibliothque.
INCLUANT LES DOMMAGES GENERIQUES, programmes qui sont les vtres mais nous vous Les termes et conditions prcis selon lesquels on peut
SPECIFIQUES, SECONDAIRES OU CONSECUTIFS, conseillons de rflchir attentivement au fait que la Licence copier, distribuer, et modifier une telle bibliothque
RESULTANT DE L'UTILISATION OU DE L'INCAPACITE Publique Gnrale ordinaire peut tre mieux adapte dans suivent. Accordez une attention toute particulire la
D'UTILISER LE PROGRAMME (Y COMPRIS, MAIS SANS certains cas, compte tenu des considrations suivantes. diffrence entre un travail fond sur la bibliothque et un
Y ETRE LIMITE, LA PERTE DE DONNEES, OU LE FAIT Quand nous parlons de logiciels libres, nous parlons de travail qui utilise la bibliothque. Celui-l renferme du
QUE DES DONNEES SOIENT RENDUES IMPRECISES, libert, non de prix. Nos licences publiques gnrales sont code driv de la bibliothque, alors que celui-ci doit tre
OU LES PERTES EPROUVEES PAR VOUS OU PAR DES conues pour vous donner lassurance dtre libres de combin la bibliothque pour tre excut.
TIERS, OU LE FAIT QUE LE PROGRAMME ECHOUE A distribuer des copies des logiciels libres (et de facturer ce LICENCE PUBLIQUE GNRALE GNU LIMITE
INTEROPERER AVEC UN AUTRE PROGRAMME QUEL service, si vous le souhaitez), de recevoir le code source ou STIPULATIONS ET CONDITIONS RELATIVES LA COPIE,
QU'IL SOIT) MEME SI LE DIT TITULAIRE DU DROIT de pouvoir lobtenir si vous le souhaitez, de pouvoir modifier LA DISTRIBUTION ET LA MODIFICATION
D'AUTEUR OU LE PARTIE CONCERNEE A ETE AVERTI les logiciels ou en utiliser des lments dans de nouveaux 0. Le prsent Accord de Licence sapplique toute
DE L'EVENTUALITE DE TELS DOMMAGES. programmes libres et de savoir que vous pouvez le faire. bibliothque logicielle ou tout autre programme o
FIN DES CONDITIONS Pour protger vos droits, il nous est ncessaire dimposer figure une note, place par le dtenteur des droits ou un
Comment appliquer ces conditions vos nouveaux des limitations qui interdisent quiconque de vous refuser tiers autoris ce faire, stipulant que ladite
programmes ces droits ou de vous demander dy renoncer. Certaines bibliothque ou programme peut tre distribue selon
Si vous dveloppez un nouveau programme, et si vous responsabilits vous incombent en raison de ces les termes de la prsente Licence Publique Gnrale
voulez qu'il soit de la plus grande utilit possible pour le limitations si vous distribuez des copies de cette Limite (galement appele cette licence). Chaque
public, le meilleur moyen d'y parvenir est d'en faire un bibliothque, ou si vous les modifiez. personne concerne par la Licence Publique Gnrale
logiciel libre que chacun peut redistribuer et modifier au Par exemple, si vous distribuez des copies dune telle Limite sera dsigne par le terme Vous.
titre des prsentes conditions. bibliothque, titre gratuit ou contre une rmunration, Une "bibliothque" signifie une collection de fonctions
Pour ce faire, munissez le programme des avis qui suivent. vous devez accorder aux destinataires tous les droits dont et/ou de donnes logicielles prpares de manire
Le plus sr est de les ajouter au dbut de chaque fichier vous disposez. Vous devez vous assurer queux aussi tre convenablement lies avec des programmes
source pour vhiculer le plus efficacement possible reoivent ou puissent disposer du code source. Si vous dapplication (qui utilisent certaines des fonctions et
l'absence de toute garantie ; chaque fichier devrait aussi reliez un autre code au logiciel, vous devrez fournir les des donnes) dans le but de former des excutables.
contenir au moins la ligne "copyright" et une indication de fichiers complets aux destinataires, pour quils puissent les Ci-dessous, le terme "Bibliothque" se rapporte toute
l'endroit o se trouve l'avis complet. relier la bibliothque aprs lavoir modifie ou bibliothque ou uvre logicielle distribue selon les
[Une ligne donnant le nom du programme et une courte recompile. Et vous devez leur montrer les prsentes prsents termes. Un "travail fond sur la Bibliothque"
ide de ce qu'il fait.] Copyright (C) [anne] [nom de conditions afin quils aient connaissance de leurs droits. signifie aussi bien la Bibliothque elle-mme que tout
l'auteur] Ce programme est un logiciel libre ; vous Nous protgeons vos droits en deux tapes : (1) nous travail qui en est driv selon la loi, cest--dire tout
pouvez le redistribuer et/ou le modifier au titre des sommes titulaires des droits dauteur du logiciel, et (2) ouvrage reproduisant la Bibliothque ou une partie de
clauses de la Licence Publique Gnrale GNU, telle que nous vous dlivrons cette licence, qui vous donne cette dernire, lidentique ou bien modifie, et/ou
publie par la Free Software Foundation ; soit la version lautorisation lgale de copier, distribuer et/ou modifier la traduit dans une autre langue (la traduction est
2 de la Licence, ou ( votre discrtion) une version bibliothque. considre comme une "modification").
ultrieure quelconque. Ce programme est distribu En outre, pour la protection de chaque auteur ainsi que la Le "code source" dun travail dsigne la forme de cet
dans l'espoir qu'il sera utile, mais SANS AUCUNE ntre, nous voulons nous assurer que chacun comprenne ouvrage sous laquelle les modifications sont les plus
GARANTIE ; sans mme une garantie implicite de que cette bibliothque libre ne fait lobjet daucune aises. Sont ainsi dsigns la totalit du code source
COMMERCIABILITE ou DE CONFORMITE A UNE garantie. Si cette bibliothque est modifis par quelquun de tous les modules composant une bibliothque
UTILISATION PARTICULIERE. Voir la Licence Publique dautre puis transmise des tiers, nous voulons que les logicielle, de mme que tout fichier de dfinition
Gnrale GNU pour plus de dtails. Vous devriez avoir destinataires soient mis au courant que ce quils ont reu associ, ainsi que les scripts utiliss pour effectuer la
reu un exemplaire de la Licence Publique Gnrale nest pas le logiciel dorigine, de sorte que tout problme compilation et linstallation de la bibliothque.
GNU avec ce programme ; si ce n'est pas le cas, crivez introduit par dautres ne puisse entacher la rputation de Les activits autres que copie, distribution et
la Free Software Foundation Inc., 51 Franklin Street, lauteur originel. modification ne sont pas couvertes par la prsente
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. En dfinitive, un programme libre restera la merci des Licence et sortent de son cadre. Rien ne restreint
Ajoutez aussi des informations sur la manire de vous brevets de logiciels. Nous souhaitons viter le risque que lutilisation de la Bibliothque, et les donnes issues de
contacter par courrier lectronique et courrier postal. les redistributeurs dun programme libre fassent des celle-ci ne sont couvertes que si leur contenu constitue
Si le programme est interactif, faites en sorte qu'il affiche demandes individuelles de licence de brevet, ceci ayant un travail fond sur la Bibliothque (indpendamment
un court avis tel que celui-ci lorsqu'il dmarre en mode pour effet de rendre le programme propritaire. Pour viter du fait davoir t ralis en utilisant la Bibliothque).
interactif : cela, nous tablissons clairement que toute licence de Tout dpend de ce que la Bibliothque et le programme
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) anne nom de brevet doit tre concde de faon ce que lusage en soit qui y fait appel sont censs produire.
l'auteur Gnomovision n'est accompagn libre pour tous ou bien quaucune licence ne soit 1. Vous pouvez copier et distribuer des copies conformes
d'ABSOLUMENT AUCUNE GARANTIE ; pour plus de concde. et compltes du code source de la Bibliothque, tel que
dtails tapez "show w". Ceci est un logiciel libre et vous La plupart des logiciels GNU, bibliothques comprises, Vous lavez reue, sur nimporte quel support,
tes invit le redistribuer en respectant certaines sont couvert par la Licence Publique Gnrale GNU condition de placer sur chaque copie un copyright
obligations ; pour plus de dtails tapez "show c". ordinaire. Cette licence, la Licence Publique Gnrale appropri et une restriction de garantie, de ne pas
Les instructions hypothtiques "show w" et "show c" sont Limite GNU, concerne un certain nombre de modifier ou omettre toutes les stipulations se rfrant
supposes montrer les parties ad hoc de la Licence bibliothques et diffre beaucoup de la Licence Publique la prsente Licence et la limitation de garantie, et de
Publique Gnrale. Bien entendu, les instructions que vous Gnrale ordinaire. Nous couvrons par la prsente licence fournir avec toute copie de la Bibliothque un
utilisez peuvent porter d'autres noms que "show w" et "show certaines bibliothques afin de permettre des exemplaire de la Licence.
c" ; elles peuvent mme tre des clics de souris ou des programmes non libres dtre lis avec ces dernires. Vous pouvez demander une rtribution financire pour
lments d'un menu ou tout ce qui convient votre Quand un programme est li une bibliothque, que ce la ralisation de la copie et demeurez libre de proposer
programme. soit de manire statique ou par lutilisation dune une garantie assure par vos soins, moyennant
Vous devriez aussi obtenir de votre employeur (si vous bibliothque partage, lensemble forme lgalement finances.
travaillez en tant que dveloppeur) ou de votre cole, si c'est parlant un travail combin, driv de la bibliothque 2. Vous pouvez modifier votre copie ou vos copies de la
le cas, qu'il (ou elle) signe une "renonciation aux droits originale. Cest pourquoi la Licence Publique Gnrale Bibliothque ou partie de celle-ci, ou dun travail fond
d'auteur" concernant le programme, si ncessaire. Voici un ordinaire nautorise une telle dition de liens que si sur cette Bibliothque, et copier et distribuer ces
exemple (changez les noms) : lensemble qui en rsulte satisfait ses critres de libert. . modifications selon les termes de larticle 1, condition
Yoyodyne, Inc., dclare par la prsente renoncer toute La Licence Publique Gnrale Limite est permissive quant de Vous conformer galement aux conditions suivantes
prtention sur les droits d'auteur du programme aux critres que doit remplir un code li avec la :
"Gnomovision" (qui fait des avances aux compilateurs) bibliothque en question. a) Le travail driv doit tre lui-mme une bibliothque
crit par James Hacker. [signature de Ty Coon], 1er avril Nous qualifions cette licence de Limite car les garanties logicielle.
1989 Ty Coon, Prsident du Vice de libert quelle apporte lutilisateur sont limites par b) Ajouter aux fichiers modifis lindication trs claire
La prsente Licence Publique Gnrale n'autorise pas rapport celles de la Licence Publique Gnrale ordinaire. des modifications effectues, ainsi que la date de
l'incorporation de votre programme dans des programmes Elle limite galement les avantages que peuvent acqurir chaque changement.
propritaires. Si votre programme est une bibliothque de dautres dveloppeurs de logiciels libres dans la c) Distribuer sous les termes de la prsente Licence
sous-programmes, vous pouvez considrer plus utile concurrence avec les programmes non libres. Cest lensemble de la ralisation, tous, et sans frais.
d'autoriser l'dition de liens d'applications propritaires cause de ces limitations que nous utilisons la Licence d) Si une fonctionnalit de la Bibliothque modifie se
avec la bibliothque. Si c'est ce que vous voulez faire, Publique Gnrale ordinaire pour de nombreuses rfre une fonction ou des donnes fournies par
utilisez la GNU Lesser General Public License au lieu de la bibliothques. Cependant, la Licence Limite est le programme dapplication qui utilise la
prsente Licence. avantageuse dans certaines circonstances particulires. fonctionnalit en question sans pour cela utiliser
Par exemple, on observe (rarement) un besoin particulier dargument lors de lappel de cette dernire, vous
LICENCE PUBLIQUE GNRALE GNU LIMITE dencourager autant que possible lutilisation dune devez agir au mieux pour assurer que la
Version 2.1, Fvrier 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
certaine bibliothque, de telle sorte quelle devienne un
standard de fait. Pour atteindre un tel but, il faut autoriser
fonctionnalit se comporte correctement et remplit
ceux de ses buts qui ont encore un sens lorsquune
55
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA des programmes non libres utiliser cette bibliothque. Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 56 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
application ne fournit pas la fonction ou les donnes directement li avec la Bibliothque proprement la Bibliothque sous cette Licence. Toutefois, les tiers
08 auxquelles la Bibliothque se rfre.
(Par exemple, si une fonction dune bibliothque
parler.
6. Le prcdent article fait exception aux prcdents. Vous
ayant reu de Vous des copies de la Bibliothque ou le
droit dutiliser ces copies continueront bnficier de
calcule des racines carres, elle a un but absolument pouvez galement combiner ou lier un travail qui leur droit dutilisation tant quils respecteront
bien dfini, indpendamment de lapplication. Par utilise la Bibliothque avec cette dernire pour pleinement les conditions de la prsente Licence.
consquent, la clause 2d exige que toute fonction ou produire un travail contenant des portions de la 9. Ne layant pas signe, Vous ntes pas oblig
toutes donnes fournies par lapplication et Bibliothque, et distribuer ce dernier sous les daccepter la prsente Licence. Cependant, rien
utilisation cette fonction soient optionnelles : si conditions qui vous siront, pourvu que ces conditions dautre ne Vous autorise modifier ou distribuer la
lapplication ne les propose pas, la fonction de calcul autorisent la modification de ce travail pour utilisation Bibliothque ou quelques travaux drivs : la loi
de racines carres doit encore calculer des racines personnelle, ainsi que lingnierie revers afin de linterdit tant que Vous nacceptez pas les termes de la
carres.) dboguer ces modifications. prsente Licence. En consquence, en modifiant ou en
Toutes ces conditions sappliquent lensemble des Vous devez fournir avec chaque copie du travail une distribuant la Bibliothque (ou tout travail fond sur
modifications. Si des lments identifiables de ce note trs claire expliquant que la Bibliothque fut elle), Vous acceptez implicitement tous les termes et
travail ne sont pas drivs de la Bibliothque et peuvent utilise dans sa conception, et que la Bibliothque et conditions de la prsente Licence.
tre raisonnablement considrs comme son utilisation sont couvertes par la prsente Licence. 10. La diffusion dune Bibliothque (ou de tout travail
indpendants, la prsente Licence ne sapplique pas Vous devez galement fournir une copie de la prsente driv) suppose lenvoi simultan dune licence
ces lments lorsque Vous les distribuez seuls. Mais, Licence. Si le travail, lors de son excution, affiche des autorisant la copie, la distribution, ldition de liens
si Vous distribuez ces mmes lments comme partie copyrights, vous devez inclure parmi ces derniers le avec, ou la modification de la Bibliothque, aux termes
dun ensemble cohrent dont le reste est fond sur une copyright de la Bibliothque, ainsi quune rfrence et conditions de la Licence. Vous navez pas le droit
Bibliothque soumise la Licence, ils lui sont expliquant lutilisateur o il pourra trouver une copie dimposer de restrictions supplmentaires aux droits
galement soumis, et la Licence stend ainsi de la prsente Licence. Vous devez aussi vous transmis au destinataire. Vous ntes pas responsable
lensemble du produit, quel quen soit lauteur. conformer lun des points suivants : du respect de la Licence par un tiers.
Cet article na pas pour but de sapproprier ou de a) Accompagner le travail avec lintgralit du code 11. Si, la suite dune dcision de Justice, dune plainte en
contester vos droits sur un travail entirement ralis source pour la Bibliothque, sous une forme lisible contrefaon ou pour toute autre raison (lie ou non la
par Vous, mais plutt douvrir droit un contrle de la par un ordinateur, ainsi que les ventuelles contrefaon), des conditions Vous sont imposes (que
libre distribution de tout travail driv ou collectif fond modifications que vous lui avez apportes pour ce soit par ordonnance, accord amiable ou autre) qui se
sur la Bibliothque. raliser ce travail (lequel doit tre distribu selon les rvlent incompatibles avec les termes de la prsente
En outre, toute fusion dun autre travail, non fond sur termes des articles 1 et 2). Si le travail est un Licence, Vous ntes pas pour autant dgag des
la Bibliothque, avec la Bibliothque (ou avec un travail excutable li avec la Bibliothque, il vous faut obligations lies celle-ci : si Vous ne pouvez concilier
driv de cette dernire), effectue sur un support de proposer galement, sous une forme lisible par un vos obligations lgales ou autres avec les conditions de
stockage ou de distribution, ne fait pas tomber cet autre ordinateur, lensemble du travail qui utilise la cette Licence, Vous ne devez pas distribuer la
travail sous le contrle de la Licence. Bibliothque, sous forme de code source ou objet, Bibliothque. Par exemple, si une licence ne permettait
3. Vous pouvez opter pour la Licence Publique Gnrale de telle sorte que lutilisateur puisse modifier la pas la redistribution de redevance de la Bibliothque
GNU ordinaire pour protger une copie donne de la Bibliothque et effectuer de nouveau ldition de par tous ceux qui des copies ont t donnes
Bibliothque. Pour cela, il vous faudra modifier toutes liens, afin de produire un excutable modifi, directement ou indirectement, la seule faon de
les notes se rfrant la prsente Licence, pour quelles renfermant une version modifie de la Bibliothque satisfaire aux deux, serait de ne pas distribuer du tout la
se rfrent plutt la Licence Publique Gnrale GNU (il est entendu que lutilisateur qui modifie le contenu Bibliothque.
ordinaire, version 2 (si une version plus rcente de la des fichiers de dfinitions de la Bibliothque ne sera Si une partie quelconque de cet article est invalide ou
Licence Publique Gnrale GNU a vu le jour, vous pas forcment capable de recompiler lapplication inapplicable pour quelque raison que ce soit, le reste de
pouvez alors spcifier cet autre numro de version si tel afin dutiliser la version modifie de ces dfinitions). larticle continue de sappliquer et lintgralit de
est votre dsir). Ne vous livrez aucune autre b) Utiliser un mcanisme de partage de bibliothques larticle sappliquera en toute autre circonstance.
modification dans ces notes. convenable pour ldition de liens avec la Le prsent article na pas pour but de Vous pousser
Une fois que ce changement a t effectu dans une Bibliothque. Un mcanisme convenable est un enfreindre des droits ou des dispositions lgales ni en
copie donne, il est irrversible pour cette copie, aussi mcanisme qui: (1) utilise une copie de la contester la validit; son seul objectif est de protger
la Licence Publique Gnrale ordinaire sappliquera bibliothque dj prsente sur le systme de lintgrit du systme de distribution du Logiciel Libre.
toutes les copies et tous les travaux drivs qui en lutilisateur, plutt que de copier des fonctions de la De nombreuses personnes ont gnreusement
seront extraits. bibliothque au sein de lexcutable, et (2) contribu la large gamme de logiciels distribue de
Cette option vous servira lorsque vous souhaiterez fonctionnera correctement avec une version cette faon en toute confiance; il appartient chaque
copier une portion du code de la Bibliothque dans un modifie de la bibliothque, si lutilisateur en installe auteur/donateur de dcider de diffuser ses logiciels
programme qui nest pas lui-mme une bibliothque. une, tant que la version modifie sera compatible selon les critres de son choix.
4. Vous pouvez copier et distribuer la Bibliothque (ou tout avec la version qui a servi la ralisation du travail. Cette section a pour but de mettre en vidence ce qui
travail driv selon les conditions nonces dans c) Faire une offre crite, valable pendant au moins trois est suppos tre une consquence du reste de cette
larticle 2) sous forme de code objet ou excutable, ans, proposant de distribuer cet utilisateur les licence.
selon les termes des articles 1 et 2, condition de lments spcifis dans larticle 6a, ci-dessus, pour 12. Si la distribution et/ou lutilisation de la Bibliothque est
fournir le code source complet de la Bibliothque, sous un tarif nexcdant pas le cot de la copie. limite dans certains pays par des brevets ou des droits
une forme lisible par un ordinateur et selon les termes d) Si le travail est distribu en proposant un accs une sur des interfaces, le dtenteur original des droits qui
des articles 1 et 2, sur un support habituellement utilis copie situe un endroit dsign, proposer de place la Bibliothque sous la Licence Publique
pour lchange de donnes. manire quivalente, depuis ce mme endroit, un Gnrale peut ajouter explicitement une clause de
Si la distribution du code objet consiste offrir un accs accs aux objets spcifis ci-dessus. limitation gographique excluant ces pays. Dans ce
permettant de copier la Bibliothque depuis un endroit e) Vrifier que lutilisateur a dj reu une copie de ces cas, cette clause devient une partie intgrante de la
particulier, loffre dun accs quivalent pour se objets, ou que vous la lui avez dj envoye. Licence.
procurer le code source au mme endroit satisfait Pour un programme excutable, la forme requise du 13. La Free Software Foundation se rserve le droit de
lobligation de distribution de ce code source, mme si travail qui utilise la Bibliothque doit comprendre publier priodiquement des mises jour ou de
lutilisateur choisit de ne pas profiter de cette offre. toute donne et tout utilitaire ncessaires pour pouvoir nouvelles versions de la Licence. Rdiges dans le
5. On appelle travail qui utilise la Bibliothque tout reconstruire lexcutable. Toutefois, lenvironnement mme esprit que la prsente version, elles seront
programme qui nest driv daucune portion de la standard de dveloppement du systme dexploitation cependant susceptibles den modifier certains dtails
Bibliothque, mais qui est conu dans le but de mis en uvre (source ou binaire) -- compilateurs, mesure que de nouveaux problmes se font jour.
fonctionner avec cette dernire en lincluant la bibliothques, noyau, etc. -- constitue une exception, Chaque version possde un numro distinct. Si la
compilation ou ldition de liens. Isole, une telle sauf si ces lments sont diffuss en mme temps que Bibliothque prcise un numro de version de cette
uvre nest pas un travail driv de la Bibliothque, et le programme excutable. Licence et toute version ultrieure, Vous avez le choix
sort donc du cadre de cette License. Il est possible que cette clause soit en contradiction de suivre les termes et conditions de cette version ou de
Cependant, lier un travail qui utilise la Bibliothque avec les restrictions apportes par les licences dautres toute autre version plus rcente publie par la Free
cette dernire produit un excutable qui est driv de la bibliothques propritaires qui habituellement Software Foundation. Si la Bibliothque ne spcifie
Bibliothque (en ce quil en contient des portions), et naccompagnent pas le systme dexploitation. Une aucun numro de version, Vous pouvez alors choisir
non plus un travail qui utilise la Bibliothque. Cet telle contradiction signifie quil Vous est impossible lune quelconque des versions publies par la Free
excutable est donc couvert par la prsente License. dutiliser ces dernires en conjonction avec la Software Foundation.
Cest larticle 6 qui nonce les conditions de Bibliothque au sein dun excutable distribu par 14. Si Vous dsirez incorporer des lments de la
distribution de tels excutables. Vous. Bibliothque dans dautres programmes libres dont les
Dans le cas o un travail qui utilise la Bibliothque 7. Vous pouvez incorporer au sein dune mme conditions de distribution diffrent, Vous devez crire
utilise des portions dun fichier den-ttes inclus dans bibliothque des fonctionnalits fondes sur la lauteur pour lui en demander la permission. Pour ce
cette dernire, le code objet qui en rsulte peut fort bien Bibliothque, qui forment un travail fond sur cette qui est des programmes directement dposs par la
tre un travail driv de la Bibliothque, quand bien dernire, avec des fonctionnalits issues dautres Free Software Foundation, crivez-nous: une exception
mme ce nest pas le cas du code source. Cette bibliothques, non couvertes par la prsente Licence, et est toujours envisageable. Notre dcision sera base
prcision prend toute son importance si on peut lier ce distribuer la bibliothque rsultante, si tant est quil est sur notre volont de prserver la libert de notre
travail sans la Bibliothque, ou si le travail est lui-mme autoris par ailleurs de distribuer sparment le travail Programme ou de ses drivs et celle de promouvoir le
une bibliothque. Le seuil partir duquel cela prend fond sur la Bibliothque et les autres fonctionnalits, partage et la rutilisation du logiciel en gnral.
effet nest pas exactement dfini par la loi. et pourvu que vous vous acquittiez des deux obligations LIMITATION DE GARANTIE
Si un tel fichier objet nutilise que des paramtres suivantes : 15. PARCE QUE LUTILISATION DE LA BIBLIOTHQUE EST
numriques, les reprsentations des structures de a) Accompagner la bibliothque rsultante dune copie LIBRE ET GRATUITE, AUCUNE GARANTIE NEST
donnes et ce par quoi elles sont lues ou modifies, du travail fond sur la Bibliothque, sans le combiner FOURNIE, COMME LE PERMET LA LOI. SAUF
ainsi que de petites instructions macros ou fonctions aux autres fonctionnalits de bibliothques. Cet MENTION CRITE, LES DTENTEURS DU COPYRIGHT
embarques (de moins de dix lignes de longueur), alors ensemble doit tre distribu selon les conditions des ET/OU LES TIERS FOURNISSENT LA BIBLIOTHQUE
on pourra utiliser le fichier objet de la manire que lon articles ci-dessus. EN LTAT, SANS AUCUNE SORTE DE GARANTIE
souhaite, quil soit ou non, lgalement parlant, un b) Ajouter la bibliothque mixte lindication trs claire EXPLICITE OU IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS LES GARANTIES
travail driv (mais les excutables renfermant ce code du fait quune portion de la bibliothque est un travail DE COMMERCIALISATION OU DADAPTATION DANS
objet et des portions de la Bibliothque continuent fond sur la Bibliothque, et en expliquant o trouver UN BUT PARTICULIER. VOUS ASSUMEZ TOUS LES
tre soumis larticle 6). la version non mlange du mme travail. RISQUES QUANT LA QUALIT ET AUX EFFETS DE LA
Sinon, si le travail est driv de la Bibliothque, vous 8. Vous ne pouvez pas copier, modifier, cder, dposer ou BIBLIOTHQUE. SI LA BIBLIOTHQUE EST
56 pouvez distribuer le code objet de ce travail selon les
conditions de larticle 6. Tout excutable renfermant ce
distribuer la Bibliothque dune autre manire que
lautorise la prsente Licence. Toute tentative de ce
DFECTUEUSE, VOUS ASSUMEZ LE COT DE TOUS
LES SERVICES, CORRECTIONS OU RPARATIONS
Fr travail est lui aussi soumis larticle 6, quil soit ou non type annule immdiatement vos droits dutilisation de NCESSAIRES.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 57 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
57
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 58 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Nintroduisez pas plus dun disque dans le lecteur. Nutilisez pas de benzne, diluant ni dautres produits
chimiques volatils. Nutilisez pas non plus de 08
Ne collez pas de papier ni dautocollant sur le disque,
nutilisez pas de crayon, stylo bille ou un instrument vaporisateur pour microsillons ni de produits
bout pointu. Ils risquent dendommager le disque. antistatiques.
Pour enlever les taches rebelles, imprgnez deau un
chiffon doux, tordez bien le chiffon, essuyez la salet, puis
passez un chiffon sec sur le disque.
En cas de panne
Une erreur de commande est souvent prise pour une anomalie de fonctionnement ou une panne. Si vous estimez que
ce composant ne fonctionne pas correctement, vrifiez les points ci-dessous. Parfois, le problme peut provenir dun
autre composant. Examinez les autres composants et les appareils lectriques utiliss. Si le problme persiste malgr
les vrifications des points suivants, confiez les rparations au service aprs-vente Pioneer le plus proche ou votre
revendeur.
Lecture
Anomalie Vrification Solution
Le disque ne fonctionne Est-ce que le disque peut tre Assurez-vous que le disque est un disque pouvant tre lu sur ce lecteur
pas. lu sur ce lecteur ? (page 7).
Le tiroir disque souvre Est-ce que le fichier peut tre Assurez-vous que le fichier est un fichier pouvant tre lu sur ce
automatiquement. lu sur ce lecteur ? lecteur (page 10).
Vrifiez si le fichier nest pas endommag.
Est-ce que le disque est ray ? Les disques rays ne peuvent pas tre lus parfois.
Est-ce que le disque est sale ? Nettoyez le disque (ci-dessus).
Est-ce quun morceau de Le disque est peut-tre voil et ne peut pas tre lu.
papier ou dtiquette est coll
au disque ?
Est-ce que le disque est bien Posez le disque en orientant sa face imprime vers le haut.
pos sur le tiroir disque ? Posez le disque correctement dans le renfoncement du tiroir
disque.
Est-ce que le code rgional Reportez-vous page 9 pour les numros rgionaux des disques
est correct ? pouvant tre lus sur ce lecteur.
59
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 60 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
08 Contrle
Anomalie Vrification Solution
Le Contrle par lHDMI ne Est-ce que le cble HDMI est Pour utiliser le Contrle par lHDMI, raccordez le Tlviseur cran
fonctionne pas. correctement raccord ? Plat et le systme AV (rcepteur ou amplificateur AV, etc.) la prise
HDMI OUT (page 15).
Est-ce que le cble HDMI que Utilisez un cble HDMI haute vitesse. Le Contrle par lHDMI peut ne
vous utilisez est un cble pas fonctionner correctement si le cble HDMI utilis nest pas de type
HDMI haute vitesse ? cble HDMI haute vitesse.
Est-ce que le lecteur est Quand les signaux vido sont restitus par une autre prise que la prise
raccord au tlviseur HDMI OUT, le Contrle par lHDMI nest pas disponible. Raccordez le
laide dun cble HDMI pour tlviseur avec un cble HDMI (page 15).
le visionnage de limage ?
Pour le BDP-LX55: Lorsque les deux prises HDMI OUT (MAIN et SUB) sont utilises, la
Est-ce que le rglage de fonction Contrle nagit que pour la prise HDMI OUT (SUB) (page 16).
HDMI Mode est appropri ?
Est-ce que Control est rgl Rglez Control sur On sur le lecteur (page 41).
sur On sur le lecteur ?
Est-ce que lappareil Le Contrle par lHDMI ne fonctionne pas avec les appareils dautres
raccord est compatible avec marques ne prenant pas en charge cette fonction, mme sils sont
le Contrle par lHDMI ? raccords laide dun cble HDMI.
Le Contrle par lHDMI ne fonctionne pas si des appareils ne prenant
pas en charge cette fonction sont raccords entre un appareil
compatible avec le Contrle par lHDMI et le lecteur.
Reportez-vous page 16.
Mme lorsquun produit Pioneer compatible avec le Contrle par
lHDMI est raccord, certaines des fonctions nagissent pas.
Reportez-vous aussi au mode demploi de lappareil raccord.
Est-ce que le Contrle par Activez le Contrle par lHDMI sur lappareil raccord. Le Contrle par
lHDMI est activ sur lHDMI fonctionne lorsquil est activ sur tous les appareils raccords
lappareil raccord ? la prise HDMI OUT.
Lorsque vous avez reli et rgl tous les appareils, assurez-vous que
limage du lecteur apparat bien sur le Tlviseur cran Plat. (Ceci est
galement ncessaire lorsque vous changez les appareils raccords et
branchez et/ou dbranchez les cbles HDMI.) Le Contrle par lHDMI
ne fonctionne peut-tre pas correctement si limage du lecteur ne
saffiche pas sur le Tlviseur cran Plat.
Reportez-vous aussi au mode demploi de lappareil raccord pour le
dtail.
Est-ce que plusieurs lecteurs Le Contrle par lHDMI peut ne pas fonctionner si trois lecteurs dont
sont raccords ? celui-ci, ou plus, sont raccords laide dun cble HDMI.
Rseau
Anomalie Vrification Solution
La fonction BD-LIVE Excutez Connection Test (page 45). Si Network is OK. saffiche,
(connexion Internet) ne vrifiez les rglages du serveur proxy (page 44). Votre connexion
peut pas tre utilise. Internet est peut-tre elle-mme en panne. Contactez votre fournisseur
No valid id file found! de service Internet.
saffiche lorsque vous
essayez de faire la mise jour
du logiciel.
La mise jour du logiciel est Selon la connexion Internet et dautres facteurs, il faut parfois un
lente. certain temps pour effectuer la mise jour.
62
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 63 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Divers
Anomalie Vrification Solution
Le lecteur se met Est-ce que Auto Power Off Si Auto Power Off est rgl sur 10 min/20 min/30 min, le lecteur se
automatiquement hors est rgl sur 10 min/20 min/ met de lui-mme hors service aprs 30 minutes dinactivit (page 43).
service. 30 min ?
Le lecteur sallume Est-ce que Control est rgl Le lecteur sallume en mme temps que le tlviseur raccord la prise
automatiquement. sur On ? HDMI OUT. Si vous ne voulez pas que le lecteur se mette en service en
mme temps que le tlviseur, rglez Control sur Off (page 41).
La commande du lecteur Est-ce que vous vous placez Utilisez la tlcommande moins de 7 m du capteur de
laide de la tlcommande trop loin du lecteur lorsque tlcommande.
nest pas possible. vous utilisez la
tlcommande ?
Est-ce que les piles sont vides ? Remplacez les piles (page 5).
Lentre du tlviseur et du Est-ce que Control est rgl Lentre du tlviseur et du systme AV (rcepteur ou amplificateur AV,
systme AV raccords sur On ? etc.) raccord la prise HDMI OUT peut se rgler automatiquement
change automatiquement. sur le lecteur lorsque vous activez la lecture sur le lecteur ou affichez
une page du menu (Home Media Gallery, etc.). Si vous ne voulez pas
que les entres du tlviseur et du systme AV (rcepteur ou
amplificateur AV, etc.) raccords changent automatiquement, rglez
Control sur Off (page 41).
Les rglages effectus ont Avez-vous dbranch le Appuyez toujours sur STANDBY/ON sur la face avant du lecteur ou
t effacs. cordon dalimentation alors sur STANDBY/ON de la tlcommande et assurez-vous que POWER
que le lecteur tait en service ? OFF sest teint sur lafficheur de la face avant du lecteur avant de
Y a-t-il eu une coupure de dbrancher le cordon dalimentation. Faites particulirement attention
courant ? si le cordon dalimentation est raccord la prise secteur dun autre
appareil car le lecteur se met hors tension en mme temps que
lappareil.
63
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 64 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
Glossaire BDAV
Sur ce lecteur et dans ce mode demploi, le format BDAV dsigne
un format audio-vido denregistrement des missions
numriques HD, de format BD.
Adresse IP
Il sagit dune adresse qui identifie un ordinateur ou un autre BD-J
priphrique raccord un rseau Internet ou local. Il est
Reportez-vous page 9.
reprsent par un nombre se divisant en quatre sections.
BD-LIVE
Adresse MAC (Contrle daccs au
Reportez-vous page 8.
mdia)
Il sagit dun matricule affect tout particulirement un BDMV
priphrique rseau (carte LAN, etc.). Sur ce lecteur et dans ce mode demploi, le format BDMV
dsigne le format audio-vido conu pour les films haute
Angle (Multiangles) dfinition (HD) prenregistrs, de format BD.
Un maximum de 9 angles de prises de vue peuvent tre
enregistrs simultanment sur un BD-ROM ou un DVD-Vido, ce BONUSVIEW
qui permet de voir une scne sous diffrents angles. Reportez-vous page 8.
65
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 66 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
08 Spcifications
Modle BDP-LX55
BDP-440
BDP-140
Type LECTEUR Blu-ray 3DTM
Tension nominale AC 100 V 240 V
Frquence nominale 50 Hz/60 Hz
Consommation BDP-LX55 : 25 W
BDP-440, BDP-140 : 23 W
Consommation (en veille) 0,3 W
Poids BDP-LX55 : 3,5 kg
BDP-440 : 2,6 kg
BDP-140 : 2,1 kg
Dimensions extrieures (projections comprises) BDP-LX55 : 435 mm (L) x 93 mm (H) x 252 mm (P)
BDP-440 : 435 mm (L) x 90 mm (H) x 252 mm (P)
BDP-140 : 435 mm (L) x 58 mm (H) x 249 mm (P)
Temprature de fonctionnement tolre +5 C +35 C
Humidit de fonctionnement tolre 5 % 85 % (sans condensation)
Prises de sortie
Remarque
Les caractristiques et la prsentation peuvent tre modifies, sans avis pralable, dans un souci damlioration.
2011 PIONEER CORPORATION. Tous droits de reproduction et de traduction rservs.
66
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_FR.book Page 67 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:24 AM
08
67
Fr
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 2 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
9LHOHQ'DQNGDVV6LHVLFKIUGLHVHV3LRQHHU3URGXNWHQWVFKLHGHQKDEHQ
%LWWHOHVHQ6LHGLHVH%HGLHQXQJVDQOHLWXQJJUQGOLFKGXUFKXPVLFKPLWGHU%HGLHQXQJGHV*HUlWVYHUWUDXW]X
PDFKHQ1DFKGHP6LHGLH%HGLHQXQJVDQOHLWXQJJHOHVHQKDEHQOHJHQ6LHVLHJULIIEHUHLW]XP1DFKVFKODJHQDE
WICHTIG
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
Das Blitzsymbol in einem Dreieck weist den ACHTUNG: Ein Ausrufezeichen in einem Dreieck weist
Benutzer darauf hin, dass eine UM SICH NICHT DER GEFAHR EINES den Benutzer auf wichtige Bedienungs- und
Berhrungsgefahr mit nicht isolierten Teilen ELEKTRISCHEN SCHLAGES Wartungsanweisungen in den Dokumenten
im Gerteinneren, die eine gefhrliche AUSZUSETZEN, DRFEN SIE NICHT DEN hin, die dem Gert beiliegen.
Spannung fhren, besteht. Die Spannung DECKEL (ODER DIE RCKSEITE)
kann so hoch sein, dass sie die Gefahr eines ENTFERNEN. IM GERTEINNEREN
elektrischen Schlages birgt. BEFINDEN SICH KEINE VOM BENUTZER
REPARIERBAREN TEILE. BERLASSEN SIE
REPARATUREN DEM QUALIFIZIERTEN
KUNDENDIENST.
D3-4-2-1-1_A1_De
WARNUNG
Keine Quellen offener Flammen (z.B. eine brennende
Kerze) auf dieses Gert stellen.
D3-4-2-1-7a_A1_De
K058a_A1_De
6ORSICHTSHINWEISEZUM$
"ETRACHTEN
p 7ENN3IEBEIM"ETRACHTENVON$
"ILDERN-DIGKEITODER5NWOHLSEINVERSPRENHREN3IEMITDEM"ETRACHTENAUF
p +INDERINSBESONDEREIM!LTERVONUNTER*AHRENSINDBESONDERSEMPFINDLICHDERAUFSEHENDE%RWACHSENEMUSSAUF
:EICHENVON%RMDUNGODER5NWOHLSEINACHTEN
p ,EGEN3IEBEIM"ETRACHTENVON$
"ILDERREGELMIGEINE0AUSEUM
,ANGES"ETRACHTENVON$
"ILDERNOHNE0AUSENKANN-DIGKEITODER5NWOHLSEINHERVORRUFEN
3
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 4 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Inhalt
01 Vor der Inbetriebnahme Verwendung des FUNCTION-Mens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Lieferumfang . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Abspielen ab einer bestimmten Zeit (Zeitsuche) . . . . 32
Einlegen der Batterien in die Fernbedienung. . . . . . . . 5 Abspielen eines bestimmten Titels, Kapitels oder
Software-Aktualisierung . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Tracks (Suche). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
ber die Bedienung dieses Players von einem Wiedergabe eines festgelegten Bereichs von
mobilen Gert (iPod, iPhone, iPad usw.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Discs, Titeln oder Kapiteln (Track/Datei) in
Abspielbare Disc- und Dateitypen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 zuflliger Reihenfolge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Abspielbare Discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Fortgesetzte Wiedergabe von einer spezifizierten
Abspielbare Dateien . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Position (Fortgesetzte Betrachtungswiedergabe) . . . 33
Bezeichnungen und Funktionen der 05 Wiedergabe von Home Media Gallery
Komponenten. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 ber Home Media Gallery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Fernbedienung . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 ber die Netzwerk-Wiedergabe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Frontplatte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 DLNA Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Rckseite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Disc-/USB-Wiedergabe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
02 Anschluss Abspielen von Bilddateien . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Anschluss mit einem HDMI-Kabel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Abspielen in der gewnschten Reihenfolge
ber HDMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 (Playlist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Hinweise zur Steuerfunktion mit HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Hinzufgen von Tracks/Dateien. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Anschluss eines Fernsehgerts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Abspielen der Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Anschluss an einen AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker . . . 18 Lschen von Tracks/Dateien aus der Playlist . . . . . . . 37
Anschluss mit Video- und Audiokabeln. . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 06 Abspielen der Web-Inhalte
Anschlieen eines Fernsehgerts mit Verfgbare Web-Inhalte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Video-/Audiokabel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Abspielen der Eintrge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Anschluss an einen AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker
mit einem Digital-Audiokabel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
07 Erweiterte Einstellungen
ndern der Einstellungen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Anschlieen von Komponenten an die USB-Buchse. . 20
Verwendung des Initial Setup-Bildschirms. . . . . . . . . 39
ber USB-Speichergerte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Software-Aktualisierung . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Anschlieen des USB-Speichergerts . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Zurcksetzen aller Einstellungen auf die
Herstellen der Verbindung zum Netzwerk ber
Standardeinstellungen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
die LAN-Schnittstelle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Sprachcode-Tabelle und Lnder-/
Anschluss an ein WLAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Gebietscode-Tabelle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Anschlieen des Netzkabels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
08 Zustzliche Informationen
03 Die ersten Schritte Hinweis zur Software-Lizenz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Vornehmen von Einstellungen mithilfe des Setup
Vorsichtshinweise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Navigator-Mens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Transportieren des Players. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Bedienung des Fernsehgerts mit der Installationsort. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Fernbedienung des Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Schalten Sie den Player aus, wenn Sie ihn nicht
Liste der TV-Herstellercodes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 verwenden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
04 Wiedergabe Kondensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Abspielen von Discs oder Dateien . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Reinigen des Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Vorwrts- und Rckwrtssuchlauf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Vorsichtsmaregel, wenn das Gert in einem Rack
Abspielen von bestimmten Kapiteln oder Tracks. . . . 27 mit Glastr aufgestellt ist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
berspringen von Inhalt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Reinigen der Abtastlinse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Zeitlupenwiedergabe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Handhabung von Discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Schritt vorwrts und Schritt rckwrts . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Strungssuche. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Wiederholtes Abspielen eines Abschnitts innerhalb Wiedergabe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
eines Titels oder Tracks (A-B-Wiederholung) . . . . . . . 27 Steuerungsfunktion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Wiederholtes Abspielen (Wiederholwiedergabe) . . . . 27 Netzwerk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Abspielen in der gewnschten Reihenfolge Sonstiges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
(Programmwiedergabe) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Glossar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Lesenzeichen setzen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Technische Daten . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Zoom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Anzeige von Miniaturbildern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Umschalten der Kamerawinkel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Umschalten der Untertitel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Anzeigen der Disc-Informationen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Umschalten von Audio und sekundrem Audio . . . . 29
Umschalten des sekundren Videostreams . . . . . . . . 30
Genieen von BONUSVIEW oder BD-LIVE . . . . . . . . . 30
4 Wiedergabe-Funktionen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 5 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Kapitel 1 01
Vor der Inbetriebnahme
Lieferumfang WARNUNG
Verwenden oder lagern Sie Batterien nicht in
Fernbedienung x 1 direktem Sonnenlicht oder an sehr heien Orten wie
Video/Audio-Kabel (gelbe/weie/rote Stecker) x 1 im Inneren eines Fahrzeugs oder in der Nhe von
Heizkrpern. Dadurch knnen die Batterien
AAA/R03-Trockenbatterien x 2 auslaufen, sich berhitzen, explodieren oder in Brand
Garantiekarte geraten. Auch kann dies die Lebensdauer der
Netzkabel Batterien verringern.
Bedienungsanleitung (dieses Handbuch)
Achtung
Einlegen der Batterien in die Verwenden Sie keine anderen Batterien als die
Fernbedienung vorgeschriebenen. Legen Sie auerdem keine neuen
und alten Batterien gemischt ein.
1 ffnen Sie die rckseitige Abdeckung. Beim Einlegen der Batterien in die Fernbedienung
achten Sie auf die richtige Richtung, wie durch die
Polungsmarkierungen ( und ) angegeben.
Batterien drfen nicht erhitzt, zerlegt oder in
Flammen oder Wasser geworfen werden.
Drcken Sie leicht Batterien knnen verschiedene Spannungen
auf die Abdeckung, besitzen, auch wenn sie hnlich aussehen.
und schieben Sie sie
in Pfeilrichtung. Verwenden Sie keine unterschiedlichen
Batterietypen zusammen.
Um ein Austreten von Batterieflssigkeit zu
2 Setzen Sie die Batterien ein (AAA/R03 x 2).
vermeiden, entnehmen Sie die Batterien, wenn Sie
Beachten Sie beim Einsetzen der Batterien die Zeichen
die Fernbedienung lngere Zeit nicht verwenden (1
/ im Batteriefach.
Monat oder mehr). Wenn Batterieflssigkeit
ausgetreten ist, wischen Sie die Innenseite des Fachs
sorgfltig sauber, und legen Sie dann neue Batterien
ein. Falls eine Batterie leck wird und
Setzen Sie den Batterieflssigkeit auf die Haut gert, splen Sie sie
Minuspol () zuerst
ein.
mit viel flieendem Wasser ab.
Bei der Entsorgung von verbrauchten Batterien sind
die einschlgigen gesetzlichen Vorschriften und
Anweisungen der Umweltschutzbehrden strikt
einzuhalten.
3 Schlieen Sie die rckseitige Abdeckung.
Die Abdeckung muss hrbar einrasten.
5
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 6 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
01 Software-
Aktualisierung
Produktinformation ber diesen Player ist auf der
Pioneer-Website verfgbar. Sehen Sie auf der Website
bezglich Informationen zum Update oder zur Wartung
Ihres Blu-ray Disc Spieler.
IN Europe:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
IN Grobritannien:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer.co.uk/
IN Russland:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer-rus.ru/
IN Hongkong:
http://www.pioneerhongkong.com.hk/
IN Singapur:
http://www.pioneer.com.sg/firmwaredownload
IN Australien
http://www.pioneer.com.au/
6
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 7 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Abspielbare Discs
Es knnen Discs abgespielt werden, deren Beschriftung, Verpackung oder Auenhlle eines der folgenden
Logos aufweist.
Achtung
Nur finalisierte Discs knnen abgespielt werden.
Anwendungsformat
Disc-Typ Logo DVD- DVD- CD-DA DATA-
BDMV BDAV DVD VR
Video Audio DTS-CD DISC1
BD-ROM
BD-R
BD2
BD-RE
DVD-ROM 3
DVD
DVD-R2,4,5 6 7
DVD-RW4,8 6 7
DVD+R2,4
DVD+RW4
CD-DA
(Audio-CD)9
CD
CD-R4
CD-RW4
CD-ROM
1. Discs, auf denen Video, Bild- oder Audiodateien aufgenommen sind. Dieser Player untersttzt nicht Multisession-Discs oder Multiborder-
Aufnahme.
2. Einschlielich doppelschichtige Discs.
3. Nur BDP-LX55 und BDP-440.
4. Finalisieren Sie diese Discs, bevor Sie sie auf diesem Player abspielen.
5. DVD-R fr Authoring-Discs (3,95 und 4,7 GB) knnen nicht abgespielt werden.
6. Einschlielich AVCHD-Format.
7. Einschlielich AVCREC-Format.
8. Version 1.0 DVD-RW-Discs knnen abgespielt werden.
9. Einschlielich Video-CDs.
7
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 8 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Blu-ray Disc, Blu-ray und das Blu-ray Disc Logo Abspielen von BDs
01 sind Markenzeichen der Blu-ray Disc Association.
Es knnen BDs (BDMV) abgespielt werden, die mit
ist ein Warenzeichen der DVD Format/Logo den folgenden Formaten kompatibel sind.
Hier genannte Unternehmens- und Produktnamen Blu-ray Disc Recordable (R)-Format Version 2
sind Warenzeichen oder eingetragene Warenzeichen Blu-ray Disc Rewritable (RE)-Format Version 3
der jeweiligen Unternehmen.
Dieser Player untersttzt BD-ROM Profile 5.
Nicht abspielbare Discs
HD-DVDs
DVD-RAM-Discs
Es ist mglich, dass einige andere als die oben
aufgefhrten Discs ebenfalls nicht abspielbar sind. Blu-ray 3D und das Blu-ray 3D Logo sind Marken
von Blu-ray Disc Association.
Hinweis BONUSVIEW-Funktionen wie die Wiedergabe eines
Einige Discs knnen mglicherweise nicht abgespielt sekundren Videostreams (Bild-in-Bild, P-in-P) und
werden, auch wenn sie mit einem der auf der eines sekundren Audiostreams knnen verwendet
vorherigen Seite genannten Logos versehen sind. werden. Die mit den BONUSVIEW-Funktionen
Um 8-cm-Discs abzuspielen, legen Sie die Disc in die verwendeten Daten (Sekundrvideo- (Bild-in-Bild)
8-cm-Vertiefung in der Mitte der Disc-Lade ein. Es ist und Sekundraudiodaten) knnen im Speicher
kein Adapter erforderlich. 8-cm-BD-ROMs knnen abgelegt werden. Ausfhrliche Hinweise zur
nicht abgespielt werden. Wiedergabe des sekundren Videostreams und des
sekundren Audiostreams finden Sie in der Anleitung
ber Audioformate zur Disc.
Von diesem Player werden folgende Audioformate
untersttzt:
Dolby TrueHD BONUSVIEW ist eine Marke der Blu-ray Disc
Association.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital BD-LIVE-Funktionen wie Download von Spielfilm-
DTS-HD Master Audio Trailern oder zustzlichen Audio- und
Untertitelsprachen und Spielen von Online-Spielen
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio sind ber das Internet mglich. Die mit der BD-LIVE-
DTS Digital Surround Funktion heruntergeladenen Daten (Trailers usw.)
MPEG-Audio (AAC) werden im Speicher abgelegt. Siehe Anweisungen
der Disc fr Einzelheiten ber BD-LIVE-Funktionen.
Linear PCM
Um den Surround-Klang von Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital
Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio und DTS-HD High Resolution
Audio genieen zu knnen, wird empfohlen, den Player
mit einem HDMI-Kabel an einen mit diesen
Audioformaten kompatiblen AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker
BD-LIVE Logo ist eine Marke der Blu-ray Disc
anzuschlieen. Nachdem Sie eine BD mit Aufnahmen in
Association.
einem dieser Audioformate eingelegt haben, whlen Sie
das Audioformat auf dem Menbildschirm aus.
Hergestellt unter Lizenz von Dolby Laboratories. Dolby und
das Doppel-D-Symbol sind Warenzeichen von Dolby
Laboratories.
Hergestellt unter Lizenz unter den U.S. Patent Nrn.:
5.956.674; 5.974.380; 6.226.616; 6.487.535; 7.392.195;
7.272.567; 7.333.929; 7.212.872 u. andere U.S. und
weltweite Patente sind angemeldet. DTS-HD, das Symbol,
& DTS-HD und das Symbol zusammen sind eingetragene
Markenzeichen und DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential ist
ein Markenzeichen von DTS, Inc. Das Produkt enthlt
Software. DTS, Inc. Alle Rechte vorbehalten.
8
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 9 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
9
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 10 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
*
01 Ordner Ordner 001.jpg/001.mp3
DivX, DivX Certified, DivX PlusTM HD und die
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
einschlgigen Logos sind Marken der DivX, Inc. und
001.jpg/001.mp3
werden unter Lizenz verwendet.
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3 *
XX-Ordners 001.jpg/001.mp3 * Hinweis
MKV
MKV-Dateien knnen abgespielt werden.
Bezeichnungen und 01
MKV ist ein Dateiformat, das es erlaubt, mehrfache Funktionen der
Audio- und Videodateien in einer einzigen Datei
zusammenzufassen. Komponenten
Die abspielbaren Dateien sind wie folgt:
Auflsung: Bis zu 1 280 x 720
Erweiterung: .mkv oder .MKV
Fernbedienung
Windows Media Video (WMV)
19
Windows Media -Videodateien (WMV) knnen
1 20
abgespielt werden.
2
Die abspielbaren Dateien sind wie folgt:
Auflsung: Bis zu 1 280 x 720
Erweiterung: wmv oder WMV
3 21
Mit Windows Media codierte Dateien Die
Encoder 9 Serie ist untersttzt.
Windows Media ist eine eingetragene Marke oder 22
eine Marke der Microsoft Corporation in den USA 4 23
und/oder anderen Lndern.
5 24
Dieses Produkt enthlt Technologie, die Eigentum
der Microsoft Corporation ist und nicht ohne Lizenz 6 25
von Microsoft Licensing, Inc. vertrieben werden 7
darf. 8 26
Untersttzte Bilddateiformate 9
JPEG
Progressive JPEG 10 27
Dateiformat: JFIF Ver. 1.02/Exif Ver. 2.2
Auflsung: Bis zu 4 096 x 4 096 Pixel
28
Untersttzte Audiodateiformate 11 29
12
Windows Media Audio 9 (WMA9) 30
13
Bit-Rate: Bis zu 192 kbps 14 31
Abtastfrequenzen: 22,05 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz und 48 32
kHz 15 33
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3) 34
Bit-Rate: Bis zu 320 kbps 35
Abtastfrequenzen: 8 kHz, 11,025 kHz, 12 kHz, 16 kHz, 16 36
22,05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz und 48 kHz 17 37
Free Lossless Audio Codec (FLAC) (nur fr BDP- 18 38
LX55)
Abtastfrequenzen: 96 kHz bis 192 kHz
Quantisierung-Bitrate: 16 Bit, 24 Bit
Kanal: 2-Kanal
11
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 12 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
5 FL DIMMER 24 HDMI
01 BDP-LX55, BDP-440 Bei jedem Drcken dieser BDP-LX55 Zum Umschalten des HDMI Mode
Taste wechselt die Helligkeit des Frontplattendisplays verwenden (Seiten 16 und 41).
um, und/oder der Leuchtstatus der Anzeigen am BDP-440/BDP-140 Verwenden Sie diese Tasten, um die
Frontplattendisplay schaltet um, wie in der Tabelle Auflsung der Videosignale, die von der Buchse HDMI OUT
unten gezeigt. (Seite 41) ausgegeben werden, umzuschalten.
Anzeigen 25 EXIT (Seite 38)
Frontplatten
display Blu-ray PQLS FL OFF
(Nur BDP-LX55) 26 POP UP MENU/MENU Drcken Sie diese Taste, um
die BD-ROM- oder DVD-Video-Mens anzuzeigen.
Hell Leuchtet Leuchtet Aus
Mitte Leuchtet Leuchtet Aus 27 RETURN Drcken Sie die Taste, um zum
Dunkel Leuchtet Leuchtet Aus vorherigen Bildschirm zurckzukehren.
Aus Aus Aus Leuchtet 28 Farbtasten Verwenden Sie diese Tasten, um in BD-
ROM-Mens zu navigieren.
BDP-140 Bei jedem Drcken dieser Taste schaltet PROGRAM (Seite 28)
die Helligkeit des Display auf der Frontplatte um (in 4
Stufen). BOOK MARK (Seite 28)
CD/SACD ZOOM (Seite 28)
Bei Hybrid-Discs drcken Sie die Taste, um zwischen INDEX (Seite 28)
den CD- und SACD-Ebenen umzuschalten.
29 FWD (Seite 27)
6 TOP MENU Drcken Sie diese Taste, um das Top-
30 // (Seite 27)
Men der BD-ROM- oder DVD-Video-Disc anzuzeigen.
31 STOP (Seite 26)
7 FUNCTION (Seite 32)
32 2nd VIDEO (Seite 30)
8 HOME MEDIA GALLERY (Seite 34)
33 2nd AUDIO (Seite 29)
9 /// Verwenden Sie diese Tasten, um
Eintrge auszuwhlen, Einstellungen zu ndern und 34 A-B (Seite 27)
den Cursor zu bewegen.
35 ENTER Drcken Sie diese Taste, um einen
ENTER Drcken Sie diese Taste, um einen
ausgewhlten Eintrag auszufhren oder eine
ausgewhlten Eintrag auszufhren oder eine
genderte Einstellung usw. einzugeben.
genderte Einstellung usw. einzugeben.
36 REPEAT (Seite 27)
10 HOME MENU (Seite 39)
37 SKIP SEARCH Drcken Sie die Taste, damit um 30
11 REV (Seite 27) Sekunden nach vorne gesprungen wird, wenn SKIP
SEARCH whrend der Wiedergabe gedrckt wird.
12 PLAY (Seite 26)
38 REPLAY Drcken Sie die Taste, damit um 10
13 // (Seite 27) Sekunden zurck gesprungen wird, wenn REPLAY
whrend der Wiedergabe gedrckt wird.
14 PAUSE (Seite 26)
15 Zifferntasten Verwenden Sie diese Tasten, um den Tastensperre-Funktion
Titel/das Kapitel/den Track zu whlen, den bzw. das Sie knnen die Tastensperre aktivieren, um
Sie betrachten oder hren mchten und Eintrge aus versehentliche Bedienung zu verhindern.
Mens auszuwhlen.
Diese Funktion erlaubt es Fernsehgerten, die mit der
16 CLEAR Drcken Sie diese Taste, um eine Ziffer usw. Steuerfunktion mit HDMI kompatibel sind, auch eine
zu lschen. Tastensperre am Player zu aktivieren.
Halten Sie KEYLOCK mindestens zwei Sekunden lang
17 DISPLAY (Seite 29) gedrckt.
18 KEYLOCK (Seite 12) Jedes Mal, wenn Sie diese Bedienung ausfhren,
wird die Funktion aktiviert oder deaktiviert.
19 Fernbedienung-LED Leuchtet auf, wenn ein Befehl
von der Fernbedienung gesendet wird. Blinkt, whrend Wenn Sie den Player bedienen, whrend die Tastensperre
der Fernseher-Herstellercode eingestellt wird. aktiviert ist, leuchtet LOCK am Frontplattendisplay.
Frontplatte 01
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-140
1 3 4 6 8 9 10 11
1 STANDBY/ON Drcken Sie diese Taste, um das 7 PQLS-Anzeige (nur BDP-LX55 und BDP-440)
Gert ein- und auszuschalten. (Seite 17)
2 FL OFF-Anzeige (nur BDP-LX55 und BDP-440) 8 OPEN/CLOSE Drcken Sie diese Taste, um die
(Seite 12) Disc-Lade zu ffnen und zu schlieen.
3 Disc-Lade 9 Drcken Sie diese Taste, um die Wiedergabe zu
stoppen.
4 Frontplattendisplay
10 USB-Anschluss (Seite 20)
5 Blu-ray-Anzeige (nur BDP-LX55) (Seite 12)
11 Drcken Sie diese Taste, um die Wiedergabe zu
6 Fernbedienungssensor Richten Sie die starten.
Fernbedienung in einem Abstand von bis zu ca. 7 m
auf den Fernbedienungssensor, um das Gert zu
bedienen.
Der Player kann die Fernbedienungssignale
mglicherweise nicht empfangen, wenn sich in der
Nhe eine Leuchtstoffrhre befindet. Stellen Sie den
Player in dem Fall weiter entfernt von der
Leuchtstoffrhre auf.
13
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 14 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
01 Rckseite
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 5 6 8
BDP-140
3 4 2 1 5 6 8
1 HDMI OUT-Buchse(n) (unten und Seite 15) 5 LAN (10/100)-Buchse (Seite 21)
2 VIDEO OUTPUT-Buchsen (Seite 20) 6 USB-Anschluss (Seite 20)
3 DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL)-Buchse (Seite 20) 7 RS-232C-Buchse (nur BDP-LX55) Diese Buchse
wird nicht verwendet.
4 AUDIO OUTPUT-Buchsen (Seite 20)
8 AC IN (Seite 22)
Hinweis
Videosignale knnen nicht ber die SUB-Buchse ausgegeben werden. Schlieen Sie Ihren Fernseher immer an
die MAIN-Buchse an.
14
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 15 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Kapitel 2 02
Anschluss
Schalten Sie die Stromversorgung aus und ziehen Sie Dieses Produkt ist mit x.v.Color kompatibel und hat
das Netzkabel aus der Netzsteckdose, bevor Sie Gerte dadurch die Fhigkeit einen wide-gamut Farbraum
anschlieen oder die Anschlsse ndern. basierend auf den xvYCC-Spezifikationen zu
Nachdem Sie die Gerte angeschlossen haben, nehmen verwirklichen.
Sie im Setup Navigator- oder Initial Setup-Men die Bei Wiedergabe von den xvYCC-Standards
Einstellungen entsprechend dem angeschlossenen entsprechenden Videosignalen auf diesem Player bei
Kabeltyp vor (Seite 23). Anschluss an ein mit x.v.Color kompatibles
Fernsehgert usw. werden die
Beachten Sie auch die Bedienungsanleitung fr die Farbreproduktionsfhigkeiten erweitert und natrliche
angeschlossene Komponente. Farben knnen treuer denn je reproduziert werden.
x.v.Color ist ein Promotionsname fr die Produkte, die
Hinweis die Fhigkeit haben, einen wide-gamut Farbraum
basierend auf internationalen Standardspezifikationen
Die hier verwendeten Abbildungen beziehen sich
wie xvYCC zu verwirklichen.
hauptschlich auf den BDP-LX55.
17
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 18 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Achtung
Halten Sie das Kabel beim Anschlieen und
erhltlich)
Fachhandel
HDMI-Kabel (im
Abziehen stets am Stecker.
Richten Sie den
Wenn ein Gewicht auf dem Stecker lastet, kann es zu Stecker auf die Buchse
Kontaktstrungen und Beeintrchtigungen der aus, und fhren Sie ihn
Zur HDMI- gerade ein.
Videosignalausgabe kommen. Eingangsbuchse Sie knnen den Player mit einem HDMI-
Achtung
Schlieen Sie immer ein Fernsehgert an die HDMI
OUT (MAIN)-Buchse an, denn Videosignale knnen
nicht von der HDMI OUT (SUB)-Buchse ausgegeben
werden.
Stellen Sie immer den HDMI Mode auf Single
(Seite 41).
18
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 19 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
BDP-LX55
Achtung 02
Rckseite des BDP-LX55
Schlieen Sie immer ein Fernsehgert an die HDMI
OUT (MAIN)-Buchse an, denn Videosignale knnen
nicht von der HDMI OUT (SUB)-Buchse ausgegeben
werden.
Stellen Sie immer den HDMI Mode auf Separate
(Seite 41).
Wenn der an die Buchse HDMI OUT (SUB)
HDMI-Kabel angeschlossene AV-Verstrker auch an ein
(im Fachhandel erhltlich)
Fernsehgert angeschlossen ist, kann der
Fernsehgert-Eingang automatisch umschalten. In
Eingangsbuchse
Zur HDMI-
HDMI-Kabel
(im Fachhandel erhltlich)
Eingangsbuchse
Zur HDMI-
Fernsehgert
19
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 20 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Audiokabel
erhltlich)
2-Kanal-Analog-Audio
Zur optischen Digital- kann ebenfalls
Achtung Audioeingangsbuchse angeschlossen werden.
Schlieen Sie den Video-Ausgang des Players AV-Receiver Zu den Audio-Eingangsbuchsen
direkt an Ihr Fernsehgert an. oder
-Verstrker Richtung der Signalbertragung
Dieser Player untersttzt analoge
Kopierschutztechnologie. Das Bild wird daher
mglicherweise nicht korrekt angezeigt, wenn dieser Hinweis
Player ber einen DVD-Recorder/ein DVD-Videodeck
an das Fernsehgert angeschlossen ist oder wenn auf Zum Umschalten des Videos vom AV-Receiver oder
dem Player Videomaterial abgespielt wird, das von Verstrker schlieen Sie auch die Video-
einem DVD-Recorder/Videodeck aufgenommen wird. Ausgangsbuchsen an.
Auerdem wird das Bild aufgrund des Kopierschutzes
mglicherweise nicht korrekt angezeigt, wenn der
Player an ein Fernsehgert mit integriertem Videodeck
Anschlieen von
angeschlossen ist. Nhere Informationen erhalten Sie Komponenten an die
USB-Buchse
vom Hersteller Ihres Fernsehgerts.
Rckseite des BDP-LX55
Router
LAN
3 2 1 WAN
USB-Speichergert
PC
Hinweis
Siehe Bedienungsanleitung des angeschlossenen
Gerts, da die Anschlussmethode sich je nach Ihrer
Internetumgebung unterscheiden kann.
Bei Verwendung einer Broadband-
Internetverbindung mssen Sie einen Vertrag mit
einem Internet-Provider haben. Fr weitere
Einzelheiten wenden Sie sich an Ihren Internet-
Provider.
21
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 22 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Internet
LAN/USB-Speisekabel
(mit dem AS-WL300 mitgeliefert) Router
WAN
Wireless LAN-Wandler
(AS-WL300) DC 5V Ethernet WPS
22
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 23 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Kapitel 3 03
Die ersten Schritte
Vornehmen von 3 Starten Sie Setup Navigator.
Drcken Sie ENTER.
Einstellungen mithilfe Setup Navigator startet.
Fernbedienung des PIONEER 00, 31, 32, 07, 36, 42, 51,
22
GPM 41
GRAETZ 31, 42
Players ACURA 44
ADMIRAL 31
GRANADA 07, 35, 42, 43, 48
GRADIENTE 30, 57
AIWA 60 GRANDIN 18
Wenn der Herstellercode fr die Marke Ihres Fernsehgerts auf AKAI 32, 35, 42 GRUNDIG 31, 53
die Fernbedienung des Players eingestellt ist, kann das AKURA 41 HANSEATIC 07, 42
Fernsehgert mit der Fernbedienung des Players bedient werden. ALBA 07, 39, 41, 44 HCM 18, 44
AMSTRAD 42, 44, 47 HINARI 07, 41, 44
ANITECH 44 HISAWA 18
Achtung ASA 45 HITACHI 31, 33, 34, 36, 42, 43, 54,
ASUKA 41 06, 10, 24, 25, 18
Bei bestimmten Modellen kann das Fernsehgert AUDIOGONIC 07, 36 HUANYU 56
nicht mit der Fernbedienung des Players bedient BASIC LINE 41, 44 HYPSON 07, 18, 46
werden kann, auch wenn das Fernsehgert in der BAUR 31, 07, 42 ICE 46, 47
BEKO 38 IMPERIAL 38, 42
Liste der Herstellercodes aufgefhrt ist. BEON 07 INDIANA 07
Die Einstellung wird nach dem Austausch von BLAUPUNKT 31 INGELEN 31
Batterien mglicherweise auf den Standardwert BLUE SKY 41 INTERFUNK 31, 32, 07, 42
BLUE STAR 18 INTERVISION 46, 49
zurckgesetzt. Setzen Sie sie in diesem Fall zurck.
BPL 18 ISUKAI 41
BRANDT 36 ITC 42
BTC 41 ITT 31, 32, 42
BUSH 07, 41, 42, 44, 47, 56 JEC 05
CASCADE 44 JVC 13, 23
CATHAY 07 KAISUI 18, 41, 44
CENTURION 07 KAPSCH 31
CGB 42 KENDO 42
CIMLINE 44 KENNEDY 32, 42
CLARIVOX 07 KORPEL 07
CLATRONIC 38 KOYODA 44
CONDOR 38 LEYCO 07, 40, 46, 48
CONTEC 44 LIESENK&TTER 07
CROSLEY 32 LOEWE 07
CROWN 38, 44 LUXOR 32, 42, 43
CRYSTAL 42 M-ELECTRONIC 31, 44, 45, 54, 56,
CYBERTRON 41 07, 36, 51
DAEWOO 07, 44, 56 MAGNADYNE 32, 49
DAINICHI 41 MAGNAFON 49
DANSAI 07 MAGNAVOX 07, 10, 03, 12, 29
DAYTON 44 MANESTH 39, 46
DECCA 07, 48 MARANTZ 07
1 Geben Sie den 2-stelligen Herstellercode ein. DIXI 07, 44 MARK 07
Drcken Sie die Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) zur Eingabe des DUMONT 53 MATSUI 07, 39, 40, 42, 44, 47, 48
Codes, whrend Sie TV CONTROL gedrckt halten. ELIN 07 MCMICHAEL 34
ELITE 41 MEDIATOR 07
ELTA 44 MEMOREX 44
Hinweis EMERSON 42 METZ 31
ERRES 07 MINERVA 31, 53
Die werkseitige Standardeinstellung ist 00 (PIONEER). FERGUSON 07, 36, 51 MITSUBISHI 09, 10, 02, 21, 31
FINLANDIA 35, 43, 54 MULTITECH 44, 49
Wenn Sie bei der Eingabe des Codes einen Fehler
FINLUX 32, 07, 45, 48, 53, 54 NEC 59
machen, geben Sie TV CONTROL frei und FIRSTLINE 40, 44 NECKERMANN 31, 07
beginnen Sie noch einmal von vorn. FISHER 32, 35, 38, 45 NEI 07, 42
Wenn fr einen Hersteller mehrere Codes vorhanden FORMENTI 32, 07, 42 NIKKAI 05, 07, 41, 46, 48
sind, versuchen Sie, diese in der angegebenen FRONTECH 31, 42, 46 NOBLIKO 49
Reihenfolge oder bis das Fernsehgert bedient FRONTECH/PROTECH 32 NOKIA 32, 42, 52
werden kann einzugeben. FUJITSU 48 NORDMENDE 32, 36, 51, 52
FUNAI 40, 46, 58 OCEANIC 31, 32, 42
2 berprfen Sie, dass das Fernsehgert bedient GBC 32, 42 ORION 32, 07, 39, 40
werden kann. GE 00, 01, 08, 07, 10, 11, 17, 02, OSAKI 41, 46, 48
28, 18 OSO 41
Bedienen Sie das Fernsehgert mit TV CONTROL.
GEC 07, 34, 48 OSUME 48
Drcken Sie diese Taste, um das Fernsehgert GELOSO 32, 44 OTTO VERSAND 31, 32, 07, 42
ein- und auszuschalten. GENERAL 29 PALLADIUM 38
GENEXXA 31, 41 PANAMA 46
INPUT SELECT Drcken Sie diese Taste, um auf den GOLDSTAR 10, 23, 21, 02, 07, 50 PANASONIC 31, 07, 08, 42, 22
TV-Eingang umzuschalten. GOODMANS 07, 39, 47, 48, 56 PATHO CINEMA 42
GORENJE 38 PAUSA 44
CH +/ Drcken Sie diese Tasten, um einen
Fernsehkanal zu whlen.
24 VOL +/ Drcken Sie diese Taste, um die Lautstrke
De einzustellen.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 25 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
PHILCO 32, 42
PHILIPS 31, 07, 34, 56, 68
SONOLOR 31, 35
SONTEC 07
03
PHOENIX 32 SONY 04
PHONOLA 07 SOUNDWAVE 07
PROFEX 42, 44 STANDARD 41, 44
PROTECH 07, 42, 44, 46, 49 STERN 31
QUELLE 31, 32, 07, 42, 45, 53 SUSUMU 41
R-LINE 07 SYSLINE 07
RADIOLA 07 TANDY 31, 41, 48
RADIOSHACK 10, 23, 21, 02 TASHIKO 34
RBM 53 TATUNG 07, 48
RCA 01, 10, 15, 16, 17, 18, 61, 62, TEC 42
09 TELEAVIA 36
REDIFFUSION 32, 42 TELEFUNKEN 36, 37, 52
REX 31, 46 TELETECH 44
ROADSTAR 41, 44, 46 TENSAI 40, 41
SABA 31, 36, 42, 51 THOMSON 36, 51, 52, 63
SAISHO 39, 44, 46 THORN 31, 07, 42, 45, 48
SALORA 31, 32, 42, 43 TOMASHI 18
SAMBERS 49 TOSHIBA 05, 02, 26, 21, 53
SAMSUNG 07, 38, 44, 46, 69, 70 TOWADA 42
SANYO 35, 45, 48, 21, 14, 91 ULTRAVOX 32, 42, 49
SBR 07, 34 UNIDEN 92
SCHAUB LORENZ 42 UNIVERSUM 31, 07, 38, 42, 45,
SCHNEIDER 07, 41, 47 46, 54
SEG 42, 46 VESTEL 07
SEI 32, 40, 49 VICTOR 13
SELECO 31, 42 VOXSON 31
SHARP 02, 19, 27, 67, 90 WALTHAM 43
SIAREM 32, 49 WATSON 07
SIEMENS 31 WATT RADIO 32, 42, 49
SINUDYNE 32, 39, 40, 49 WHITE WESTINGHOUSE 07
SKANTIC 43 YOKO 07, 42, 46
SOLAVOX 31 ZENITH 03, 20
SONOKO 07, 44
25
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 26 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
04 Kapitel 4
Wiedergabe
Beim Einlegen einer BD mit von einem BD-Recorder
gesetzten Verwendungsbeschrnkungen erscheint
der Bildschirm zur PIN-Code-Eingabe. Geben Sie
dann Ihren PIN-Code ein.
3 Drcken Sie PLAY, um die Disc abzuspielen.
Um die Wiedergabe auf Pause zu schalten, drcken
Sie PAUSE whrend der Wiedergabe.
Um die Wiedergabe zu stoppen, drcken Sie STOP
whrend der Wiedergabe.
Hinweis
Einige Discs werden automatisch abgespielt, wenn
die Disc-Lade geschlossen wird.
DVD-Video-Discs verfgen ber
Kindersicherungsfunktionen. Geben Sie das in den
Einstellungen des Players gespeicherte Passwort ein,
um die Kindersicherung zu entsperren. Einzelheiten
siehe Seite 46.
Abspielen von Discs anschlieend wird, setzt der Player die Wiedergabe
an diesem Punkt fort.
Achtung
Hinweis
Die Untertitel knnen nicht fr mit einem DVD- oder
BD-Recorder aufgenommene Discs umgeschaltet Je nach der Datei werden mglicherweise externe
werden. Beachten Sie auch die Bedienungsanleitung Untertitel nicht richtig angezeigt.
der zur Aufnahme verwendeten Komponente.
Drcken Sie SUBTITLE whrend der Wiedergabe.
Anzeigen der Disc-
Der aktuelle Untertitel und die Gesamtanzahl der Informationen
aufgenommenen Untertitel werden auf dem
Fernsehbildschirm angezeigt. Drcken Sie DISPLAY.
Zum Umschalten des Untertitels drcken Sie Die Disc-Informationen erscheinen auf dem
SUBTITLE erneut.
Fernsehbildschirm. Um die Informationsanzeige
Die Untertitel knnen auch durch Auswahl von abzuschalten, drcken Sie DISPLAY erneut.
Subtitle im FUNCTION-Men umgeschaltet werden.
Whrend der Wiedergabe und bei gestoppter
Wenn die Untertitel durch Drcken von SUBTITLE Wiedergabe werden unterschiedliche Informationen
nicht umgeschaltet werden, schalten Sie sie auf dem angezeigt.
Disc-Menbildschirm um.
Hinweis
Primrer Sekundrer Audio-/ Die Funktion der USB-Speichergerte wird nicht
Audio-/Video-Stream Video-Stream garantiert.
Die sekundren Videostreams knnen auch durch Wiedergabe der BD-LIVE-Funktionsdaten ist je nach
Auswahl von Secondary Video im FUNCTION-Men der Disc unterschiedlich. Einzelheiten finden Sie in
umgeschaltet werden. der Bedienungsanleitung zu der Disc.
Wenn das Sekundr-Video durch Drcken von 2nd Um die BD-LIVE-Funktion zu genieen, sind eine
VIDEO nicht umgeschaltet wird, schalten Sie es auf Netzwerkverbindung und entsprechende
dem Disc-Menbildschirm um. Einstellungen erforderlich (Seite 21 und 44).
BD-LIVE ist eine Funktion, die Verbindung zum
Ausschalten von Sekundr-Video Internet bietet. Discs, die die BD-LIVE-Funktion
untersttzen, knnen diesen Player und die Disc-
Drcken Sie 2nd VIDEO mehrmals oder whlen
Inhalte identifizierende ID-Codes ber das Internet
Sie Secondary Video aus dem FUNCTION-Men, um
zum Inhaltsanbieter senden.
die Einstellung auf Off umzuschalten.
Wiedergabe-Funktionen 04
Die verwendbaren Funktionen hngen vom Typ der Disc und der Datei ab. In bestimmten Fllen knnen einige der
Funktionen verwendet werden. Die jeweils verwendbaren Funktionen finden Sie in der nachstehenden Tabelle.
Disc/Dateityp
DVD-R
1
Funktion BD- BD-R DVD- DVD- /-RW Video- Bild- Audio- Audio-
AVCREC AVCHD
ROM /-RE Video Audio2 (VR- datei datei datei CD
Format)
Vorwrts- und
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5
Rckwrtssuchlauf3
Abspielen von bestimmten
Titeln, Kapiteln oder Tracks
berspringen von Inhalt
Zeitlupenwiedergabe3,6 7
Schritt vorwrts und Schritt
8
rckwrts3
A-B-
Wiederholungswiedergabe3
Wiederholwiedergabe
Zoom
Winkel9
Untertitel10
Audio11
Sekundrer Audiostream12 13
Sekundrer Videostream14 15
Disc-Information
1. Manche Funktionen arbeiten mglicherweise nicht bei bestimmten Discs oder Dateien, auch wenn mit [] in der Tabelle gekennzeichnet.
2. Ausgenommen BDP-140.
3. Bei einigen Discs wird die normale Wiedergabe automatisch fortgesetzt, wenn das Kapitel wechselt.
4. Whrend Vorwrts- und Rckwrtssuchlauf erfolgt keine Tonausgabe.
5. Whrend Vorwrts- und Rckwrtssuchlauf erfolgt Tonausgabe.
6. Whrend der Zeitlupenwiedergabe erfolgt keine Tonausgabe.
Whrend der Zeitlupenwiedergabe in Rckwrtsrichtung kann die Geschwindigkeit nicht umgeschaltet werden.
7. Die Zeitlupenwiedergabe in Rckwrtsrichtung ist nicht mglich.
8. Die Schrittwiedergabe in Rckwrtsrichtung ist nicht mglich.
9. Das Winkelzeichen wird bei Szenen angezeigt, fr die mehrere Kamerawinkel aufgezeichnet sind, wenn Angle Mark auf On gestellt ist
(Seite 42).
10. Die aufgenommenen Untertiteltypen hngen von der Disc oder Datei ab.
In manchen Fllen kann der Untertitel umschalten oder der Umschalten-Bildschirm auf der Disc kann sofort angezeigt werden, ohne den
aktuellen Untertitel oder die Gesamtzahl der Untertitel auf der Disc anzuzeigen.
11. Die Typen der aufgenommenen sekundren Audiostreams hngen von der Disc und Datei ab.
12. Die Typen der aufgenommenen Audiostreams/Kanle hngen von der Disc oder Datei ab.
In manchen Fllen kann das sekundre Audio umschalten oder der Umschalten-Bildschirm auf der Disc kann sofort angezeigt werden,
ohne das aktuelle sekundre Audio oder die Gesamtzahl der sekundren Audiostreams auf der Disc anzuzeigen.
Das Sekundr-Audio-Zeichen wird bei Szenen angezeigt, fr die Sekundr-Audio aufgezeichnet ist, wenn Secondary Audio Mark auf On
gestellt ist (Seite 42).
13. Manche Discs enthalten kein sekundres Audio.
14. In manchen Fllen kann das sekundre Video umschalten oder der Umschalten-Bildschirm auf der Disc kann sofort angezeigt werden,
ohne das aktuelle sekundre Video oder die Gesamtzahl der sekundren Videostreams auf der Disc anzuzeigen.
Das Sekundr-Video-Zeichen wird bei Szenen angezeigt, fr die Sekundr-Video aufgezeichnet ist, wenn PIP Mark auf On gestellt ist
(Seite 42).
15. Manche Discs enthalten kein sekundres Video.
31
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 32 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
2 Whlen Sie den Eintrag, und stellen Sie ihn ein. Transition ndern Sie den Stil der Diashow
whrend der Wiedergabe der Bild-
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
Diashow.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
* Die im FUNCTION-Men gezeigten Einstellpunkte sind
Hinweis je nach Typ der Disc unterschiedlich.
Zufallswiedergabe
Der festgelegte Bereich von Discs, Titeln oder Kapiteln
(Track/Datei) wird in zuflliger Reihenfolge abgespielt.
Das gleiche Element kann nacheinander abgespielt
werden.
Mischwiedergabe
Der festgelegte Bereich von Discs, Titeln oder Kapiteln
(Track/Datei) wird in zuflliger Reihenfolge abgespielt.
Jedes Element wird einmal abgespielt.
Fortgesetzte Wiedergabe
von einer spezifizierten
Position (Fortgesetzte
Betrachtungswiedergabe)
Diese Funktion erlaubt es Ihnen, die Wiedergabe von
einer von Ihnen spezifizierten Position zur Wiedergabe
beim nchsten Mal fortzusetzen, auch nach dem
Ausschalten der Stromversorgung.
Einstellung
Whrend der Wiedergabe drcken Sie
CONTINUED in der Stellung, von der Sie die
fortgesetzte Betrachtungswiedergabe starten
wollen.
Die verflossene Spielzeit nach der spezifizierten Position
wird im Fernsehbildschirm angezeigt.
Wiedergabe
1 Drcken Sie PLAY, um den Titel abzuspielen,
fr den Sie fortgesetzte Betrachtungswiedergabe
eingestellt haben.
Der FUNCTION-Menbildschirm erscheint automatisch,
um den Punkt (die Zeit) zu zeigen, wo CONTINUED
gedrckt wurde.
Der Funktionssteuerung-Bildschirm kann auch
angezeigt werden, indem FUNCTION whrend der
Wiedergabe gedrckt wird.
2 Drcken Sie ENTER, und whlen Sie dann die
spezifizierte Zeit zur fortgesetzten
Betrachtungswiedergabe.
Die Wiedergabe beginnt ab der festgelegten Position. 33
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 34 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
05 Kapitel 5
Wiedergabe von Home Media Gallery
Die folgenden Dateien knnen von Home Media
Gallery abgespielt werden:
PCs, die mit Microsoft Windows Vista oder XP
laufen, mit installiertem Windows Media Player 11
PCs, die mit Microsoft Windows 7 laufen, mit
installiertem Windows Media Player 12
DLNA-kompatible digitale Media-Server (auf PCs
oder anderen Komponenten)
In einem PC oder DMS (digitaler Media-Server) wie
oben beschrieben gespeicherte Dateien knnen
vom digitalen Media-Player (DMP) abgespielt
werden.
ber Home Media Der Player untersttzt die Verwendung eines
solchen DMP.
Gallery Zur Wiedergabe von Audio- oder Fotodateien, die auf
Komponenten im Netzwerk gespeichert sind mssen
Sie die DHCP-Server-Funktion Ihres Routers
einschalten. Wenn Ihr Router keine eingebaute
DHCP-Server-Funktion hat, mssen Sie das Netzwerk
manuell einrichten. Andernfalls knnen Sie nicht
Dateien, die auf Komponenten im Netzwerk
Die Funktion Home Media Gallery dieses Players erlaubt gespeichert sind, wiedergeben. Siehe Seite 44.
es Ihnen, eine Liste von Eingangsquellen anzuzeigen, und
die Wiedergabe zu starten. Dieses Kapitel beschreibt ber die Netzwerk-
Setup und Wiedergabeverfahren zur Verwendung dieser Wiedergabe
Funktionen. Wenn Sie die auf Ihrem Computer oder in
Komponenten im Netzwerk gespeicherte Dateien Die Netzwerk-Wiedergabefunktion dieses Gerts setzt die
abspielen, raten Ihnen auerdem, die folgenden Technologien ein:
Bedienungsanleitung zu beachten, die mit Ihrer
Netzwerkkomponente mitgeliefert wurde. Windows Media Player
Die Eingangsquellen, die von der Home Media Gallery Siehe Windows Media Player 11/Windows Media Player
abgespielt werden knnen, sind wie unten gezeigt. 12 oben fr weitere Einzelheiten.
BD-R/RE (BDAV-Format) Discs Windows Media DRM
DVD-R/RW (VR-Format)-Discs Microsoft Windows Media Digital Rights Management
Audio-CDs (CD-DA, SACD und DTS-CDs) (WMDRM) ist eine Plattform zum Schtzen und sicheren
DVD/CDs, auf denen nur Datendateien von Video-, Liefern von Inhalten zur Wiedergabe auf Computern,
Bild- oder Audiodateien aufgenommen wurden. tragbaren und Netzwerk-Gerten. Home Media Gallery
fungiert als ein WMDRM 10 fr vernetzte Gerte. Mit
USB-Speichergert WMDRM geschtzter Inhalt kann nur auf Media-Servern
Dateien auf den Netzwerk-Servern (auf den PCs oder abgespielt werden, die WMDRM untersttzen.
Komponenten, die am Player ber LAN-Schnittstelle Inhalte-Inhaber verwenden WMDRM-Technologie zum
angeschlossen sind.) Schutz ihrer geistigen Eigentumsrechte, einschlielich
Copyright. Dieses Gert verwendet WMDRM-Software zum
Zugriff auf mit WMDRM geschtzte Inhalte. Wenn die
Hinweis WMDRM-Software den Inhalt nicht erkennt, knnen die
Die Home Media Gallery erlaubt es Ihnen, Dateien auf Inhalt-Inhaber Microsoft dazu auffordern, die Fhigkeit der
Media-Servern abzuspielen, die an das gleiche LAN Software zum Abspielen oder Kopieren von mit WMDRM
(Local Area Network) wie der Receiver angeschlossen geschtztem Inhalt rckgngig zu machen.
sind. Rckgngigmachung hat keine Auswirkung auf nicht
geschtzten Inhalt. Wenn Sie Lizenzen fr geschtzten
Inhalt herunterladen, stimmen Sie zu, dass Microsoft eine
Rckgngigmachungsliste mit den Lizenzen mitliefert.
Inhalt-Inhaber knnen anfordern, dass Sie WMDRM
aktualisieren, um auf ihre Inhalte zuzugreifen. Wenn Sie
eine Aktualisierung verweigern, knnen Sie nicht auf den
Inhalt zugreifen, der die Aktualisierung erfordert. Dieses
Produkt wird von bestimmten intellektuellen
Eigentumsrechten von Microsoft geschtzt. Verwendung
oder Vetrieb solcher Technologie auerhalb dieses
34 Produkts ohne Lizenz von Microsoft ist untersagt.
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 35 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Auch bei Codierung in einem kompatiblen Format Je nach auf dem angeschlossenen PC installierter
kann es sein, das manche Dateien nicht korrekt Sicherheitssoftware und der Einstellung solcher
abgespielt werden. Software kann die Netzwerkverbindung blockiert
werden.
Manche Funktionen werden mglicherweise nicht
untersttzt, je nach dem Servertyp oder der Pioneer bernimmt keine Verantwortung fr jegliche
verwendeten Version. Fehlfunktion am Player und/oder den Home Media
Gallery Merkmalen aufgrund von
Untersttzte Dateiformate sind je nach Server
unterschiedlich. Deshalb werden nicht-untersttzte Kommunikationsfehlern/Fehlfunktionen, die mit der
Dateiformate von diesem Gert nicht angezeigt. Fr Netzwerkverbindung und/oder dem PC oder anderen
weitere Informationen wenden Sie sich an den angeschlossenen Gerten zusammenhngen. Bitte
Hersteller Ihres Servers. wenden Sie sich an Ihren PC-Hersteller oder Internet-
Provider.
Windows Media ist eine eingetragene Marke oder eine
Marke der Microsoft Corporation in den USA und/oder
anderen Lndern.
Dieses Produkt enthlt Technologie, die Eigentum der
Microsoft Corporation ist und nicht ohne Lizenz von
Microsoft Licensing, Inc. vertrieben werden darf.
Microsoft, Windows7, WindowsVista, WindowsXP,
Windows2000, WindowsMillennium Edition,
Windows98 und WindowsNT sind eingetragene Marken
oder Marken der Microsoft Corporation in den USA und/
oder anderen Lndern.
35
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 36 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
2 Whlen Sie die Disc oder USB. 1 Drcken Sie HOME MEDIA GALLERY, um die
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und Home Media Gallery anzuzeigen.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER. Die Home Media Gallery kann auch angezeigt werden,
indem Sie Home Media Gallery aus dem Home Menu
3 Wn Sie Photo/Music/Video/AVCHD. whlen und dann ENTER drcken.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
2 Whlen Sie die Disc oder USB.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Legen Sie zuvor die Disc ein.
Dieser Schritt ist nicht fr Discs geeignet, die im VR-
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
Format bespielt wurden. drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
4 Whlen Sie den zur Wiedergabe gewnschten 3 Whlen Sie den Track oder die Datei, den/die Sie
Titel/Track bzw. die Datei. hinzufgen mchten.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und Nehmen Sie die Auswahl mit vor.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
4 Drcken Sie POP UP MENU, um das Men POP UP
Die Wiedergabe beginnt mit dem festgelegten Titel/
MENU aufzurufen.
Kapitel bzw. der Datei.
Wenn die zur Wiedergabe gewnschte Datei in dem 5 Whlen Sie Add to Playlist, um zur Playlist
Ordner ist, whlen Sie zuerst den Ordner, der die hinzuzufgen.
Datei enthlt. Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Der Track oder die Datei, der bzw. die in Schritt 3
ausgewhlt wurde, wird der Playlist hinzugefgt.
Um weitere Tracks oder Dateien hinzuzufgen,
wiederholen Sie die Schritte 3 bis 5.
36
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 37 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
37
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 38 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
06 Kapitel 6
Abspielen der Web-Inhalte
Sie knnen einige Streaming-Inhalte im Internet mit dem Dienste von Drittanbietern knnen eine High-Speed-
Player genieen. Internet-Verbindung sowie Ihre Registrierung
voraussetzen und ggfs. Gebhren nach sich ziehen.
38
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 39 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Kapitel 7 07
Erweiterte Einstellungen
ndern der Verwendung des Initial
Einstellungen Setup-Bildschirms
1 Rufen Sie bei gestoppter Wiedergabe den Home
Menu-Bildschirm auf.
Drcken Sie HOME MENU.
2 Whlen und stellen Sie Initial Setup ein.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
3 Whlen Sie den Eintrag, und ndern Sie die
Einstellung.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit ///
aus, und drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Hinweis
Welche Eintrge ausgewhlt werden knnen, hngt vom Status des Players ab.
In Optionen werden die Standardeinstellungen ab Werk in Fettschrift angegeben.
Einstellung Options Erluterung
16:9 Full
Display Setting
TV Screen Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn ein Breitbild-Fernsehgert (16:9) angeschlossen wird.
16:9 Normal Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn ein Breitbild-Fernsehgert (16:9) angeschlossen ist.
4:3-Bilder werden mit vertikalen schwarzen Balken an den Seiten angezeigt.
4:3 Pan&Scan Whlen Sie diese Option beim Anschluss an ein Fernsehgert mit einem
Seitenverhltnis von 4:3 und Wiedergabe von Video im Seitenverhltnis von 16:9. Das
Video wird angezeigt, wobei die linke und rechte Seite des Bildes beim 4:3-Bildschirm
beschnitten sind. (Diese Funktion arbeitet, wenn die Disc das Label 4:3PS trgt.)
4:3 Letterbox Whlen Sie diese Option beim Anschluss an ein Fernsehgert mit einem
Seitenverhltnis von 4:3 und Wiedergabe von Video im Seitenverhltnis von 16:9. Das
Video wird mit schwarzen Streifen am oberen und unteren Rand angezeigt.
Video Adjust Sie knnen die Qualitt des wiedergegebenen Bildes auf Ihr Fernsehgert abstimmen (Seite 44).
Sharpness High Whlen Sie den Pegel der Schrfe.
(Ausgenommen BDP- Middle
LX55)
Low
Video Mode Standard Whlen Sie den Video-Ausgangsmodus.
(Ausgenommen BDP- Vivid
LX55)
Cinema
Custom
Noise Reduction 0 Whlen Sie den Pegel der Rauschunterdrckung.
(Ausgenommen BDP- 1
LX55)
2
3
39
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 40 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Digital Output Bitstream Whlen Sie diese Option, um digitale Audiosignale direkt auszugeben.
PCM Whlen Sie diese Option, um digitale Audiosignale umgewandelt in PCM-Audiosignale
auszugeben.
Re-encode Whlen Sie diese Option, um digitale Audiosignale umgewandelt in DTS Digital
Surround auszugeben.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option, um andere als digitale Audiosignale auszugeben.
DTS Downmix (BDP- Stereo DTS-HD Master Audio-Signale, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio-Signale oder in Linear
LX55) PCM-Audiosignale umgewandelte DTS Digital Surround-Audiosignale werden fr die
Ausgabe in 2-Kanal-Signale (Stereo) umgewandelt.
Lt/Rt DTS-HD Master Audio-Signale, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio-Signale oder in Linear
PCM-Audiosignale umgewandelte DTS Digital Surround-Audiosignale werden fr die
Ausgabe in mit Dolby Surround kompatible 2-Kanal-Signale umgewandelt (wenn der
angeschlossene AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker usw. mit Dolby Pro Logic kompatibel ist,
gibt der AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker die Linear PCM-Audiosignale als Surround-
Audiosignale aus).
Downsampling 48k Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn Sie eine Disc abspielen, die mit einer Abtastfrequenz
von 48 kHz aufgenommen wurde.
96k Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn Sie eine Disc abspielen, die mit einer Abtastfrequenz
von 96 kHz aufgenommen wurde.
192k Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn Sie eine Disc abspielen, die mit einer Abtastfrequenz
von 192 kHz aufgenommen wurde.
DRC (Dynamikbereich- Off Whlen Sie diese Option, um Audiosignale ohne Verwendung der DRC-Funktion
Steuerung) auszugeben.
* Es werden nur Dolby On Whlen Sie diese Option, um den Bereich zwischen den lautesten und weichsten
Digital- und analoge Sounds (Dynamikumfang) fr Wiedergabe mit durchschnittlicher Lautstrke
Audiosignale einstellen. Verwenden Sie dies, wenn es schwer ist, den Dialog zu hren oder wenn Sie
untersttzt. Spielfilme spt in der Nacht sehen.
Auto Whlen Sie diese Option, um die DRC-Einstellung automatisch entsprechend dem
Audio-Eingangssignal von der Disc zwischen Ein und Aus umzuschalten.
40
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 41 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
IP setting Whlen Sie dies, um die IP-Adresse des Players und des DNS-Servers einzustellen (Seite 44).
Proxy Server Stellen Sie den Proxy-Server nur ein, wie von Ihrem Internetanbieter vorgeschrieben (Seite 44).
Information Zeigt die Werte fr MAC-Adresse, IP-Adresse, Subnet-Maske, Default-Gateway und DNS-Server (primr)
imd DNS-Server (sekundr) an.
Connection Test Whlen Sie diese Option, um die Netzwerkverbindung anzuzeigen (Seite 45).
Internet Connection Enable Whlen Sie diese Einstellung, wenn die Verbindung zum Internet hergestellt wird.
Disable Whlen Sie diese Einstellung, wenn keine Verbindung zum Internet hergestellt wird.
BD-Live connection Permitted Alle Discs drfen nicht mit BD-LIVE verbunden werden.
Partial Permitted Nur Discs, deren Sicherheit besttigt ist, drfen mit BD-LIVE verbunden werden.
Prohibited Keine Disc darf mit BD-LIVE verbunden werden.
DLNA Enable Whlen Sie diese Einstellung, wenn die Verbindung zum DLNA-Server hergestellt wird. 41
Disable Whlen Sie diese Einstellung, wenn keine Verbindung zum DLNA-Server hergestellt wird. De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 42 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
OSD Verfgbare Whlen Sie eine der aufgelisteten Sprachen fr die Bildschirmanzeigen aus.
Sprachen
Audio Verfgbare Whlen Sie eine der aufgelisteten Sprachen aus, um die Standard-Audiosprache fr
* Bei einigen Discs Sprachen die BD-ROM- und DVD-Video-Wiedergabe festzulegen.
kann die ausgewhlte
Sprache
mglicherweise nicht
gendert werden.
Wenn eine Sprache ausgewhlt ist, die auf der BD/DVD nicht vorhanden ist, wird automatisch eine der vorhandenen Sprachen
zur Wiedergabe ausgewhlt.
Subtitle Verfgbare Whlen Sie eine der aufgelisteten Sprachen aus, um die Standard-Untertitelsprache
* Bei einigen Discs Sprachen fr die BD-ROM- und DVD-Video-Wiedergabe festzulegen.
kann die ausgewhlte
Sprache
mglicherweise nicht
gendert werden.
Wenn eine Sprache ausgewhlt ist, die auf der BD/DVD nicht vorhanden ist, wird automatisch eine der vorhandenen Sprachen
zur Wiedergabe ausgewhlt.
Menu Verfgbare Whlen Sie eine der aufgelisteten Sprachen aus, um die Standardsprache fr die BD-
* Bei einigen Discs Sprachen ROM- und DVD-Video-Mens festzulegen.
kann die ausgewhlte
Sprache
mglicherweise nicht
gendert werden.
Wenn eine Sprache ausgewhlt ist, die auf der BD/DVD nicht vorhanden ist, wird automatisch eine der vorhandenen Sprachen
zur Wiedergabe ausgewhlt.
Playback
Angle Mark On Whlen Sie diese Option, um die Winkelmarke auf dem Fernsehbildschirm anzuzeigen
(Seite 28). Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn Sie die Winkelmarke auf dem Fernsehbildschirm nicht
angezeigt werden soll. Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den BDP-LX55.
PIP Mark On Whlen Sie diese Option, um die PIP-Marke auf dem Fernsehbildschirm anzuzeigen.
Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn Sie die PIP-Marke auf dem Fernsehbildschirm nicht
angezeigt werden soll. Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den BDP-LX55.
Secondary Audio Mark On Whlen Sie diese Option, um die Sekundr-Audiomarke auf dem Fernsehbildschirm
anzuzeigen (Seite 29). Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option, wenn die Sekundr-Audiomarke nicht auf dem
Fernsehbildschirm angezeigt werden soll. Dies ist die werkseitige Einstellung fr den
BDP-LX55.
DivX(R) VOD DRM Registration Zeigt den Registrierungscode des Players an, der zum Abspielen von DivX VOD-Dateien
Code erforderlich ist (Seite 10).
DVD Playback DVD AUDIO Whlen Sie diese Option, um nur den Audio-Teil der DVD-Audio-Disc abzuspielen.
* Diese Einstellung ist DVD VIDEO Whlen Sie diese Option, um nur den Video-Teil der DVD-Audio-Disc abzuspielen.
fr DVD-Audio-Disc-
Wiedergabe.
(Ausgenommen BDP-
140)
Internet Setting Permitted Web-Inhalte knnen beobachtet werden, ohne das Passwort einzugeben.
Partial Permitted Das Passwort muss eingegeben werden, um Web-Inhalte zu betrachten.
Prohibited Es knnen keine Web-Inhalte betrachtet werden.
Disc Auto Playback On Discs werden automatisch abgespielt, nachdem sie eingesetzt wurden.
Off Eingesetzte Discs beginnen nicht, automatisch abzuspielen.
Last Memory On Whlen Sie diese Option, um den Punkt zu speichern, wo die Wiedergabe zuletzt
gestoppt wurde, auch nachdem das Disc-Fach geffnet wurde oder Sie auf den
Bereitschaftsmodus geschaltet haben.
Off Whlen Sie dies, wenn Sie nur Wiedergabe mit fortgesetzter Betrachtung verwenden
wollen (Seite 33).
PBC (Play Back On Whlen Sie diese Option zur Wiedergabe von Video-CDs (Version 2.0), die mit PBC
Control) kompatibel sind, ber das Disc-Men.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option zur Wiedergabe von Video-CDs (Version 2.0), die mit PBC
kompatibel sind, ohne Verwendung des Disc-Mens.
Setup Navigator Startet die Vornahme von Einstellungen mithilfe des Setup Navigator-Mens. Einzelheiten siehe Seite 23.
42
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 43 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Change Password Registrieren (ndern) Sie das Passwort fr die Kindersicherungseinstellungen oder fr die Entsperrung
zum Abspielen von DVD-Videos mit Kindersicherungsfunktion (Seite 45).
Parental Control Zum ndern der Kindersicherungsebene des Players (Seite 46).
Country Code Zum ndern des Lnder-/Gebietscodes (Seite 46).
Options
30 min
Quick Start On Whlen Sie diese Option, um die erforderliche Zeit zum Systemstart zu verkrzen.
Off Whlen Sie diese Option zum normalen Systemstart.
Update Disc Whlen Sie das Verfahren zur Software-Aktualisierung. (Seite 46)
USB Storage
Network
Load Default Zurcksetzen aller Einstellungen auf die werkseitige Standardeinstellung.
System Information Prfen Sie die System-Versionsnummer.
Disc Auto Update On Anzeigen des Software-Aktualisierung-Bildschirms, wenn die Disc mit der
Aktualisierungsdatei des Players eingesetzt ist.
Off Der Software-Aktualisierung-Bildschirm muss manuell angezeigt werden. (Seite 46)
BUDA BUDA Information Anzeigen und Einrichten der BUDA-Daten auf dem angeschlossenen USB-
BUDA Setup Speichergert.
43
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 44 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Hinweis
Beim BDP-LX55 hat die Einstellung Video Adjust
keinen Einfluss auf die Videosignale der VIDEO
44
OUTPUT-Buchsen.
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 45 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
4 Geben Sie die IP Address oder den Server Name ein. Lschen von Daten, die zu BDs und
Geben Sie die Zahlen bei der Eingabe der IP-Adresse in 07
Anwendungsdaten hinzugefgt werden
Schritt 3 mit den Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) ein. Bewegen Sie
den Cursor mit /. Verwenden Sie dieses Verfahren zum Lschen von Daten, die zu
BDs hinzugefgt werden (Daten, die mit der Funktion BD-LIVE
Wenn in Schritt 3 Server Name gewhlt wird, verwenden heruntergeladen werden und Daten, die mit der BONUSVIEW-
Sie die Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) zum Starten der Software- Funktion verwendet werden) und Anwendungsdaten.
Tastatur. Bettigen Sie danach /// zum Whlen
von Zeichen, und drcken Sie dann ENTER zur Eingabe. Achtung
5 Eingang Port Number. Eine gewisse Zeit ist zum Lschen der Daten erforderlich.
Drcken Sie , und geben Sie dann die Nummer mit Ziehen Sie nicht das Netzkabel whrend der Datenlschung ab.
den Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) ein. 1 Whlen Sie BUDA BUDA Setup, und nehmen
Sie eine Einstellung vor.
6 Drcken Sie zur Einstellung auf ENTER. Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Anzeige der Netzwerk-
2 Whlen und stellen Sie Fmt buda ein.
Einstellungen Drcken Sie ENTER.
Whlen Sie Network Information Next ndern oder Registrieren des Passworts
Screen, und nehmen Sie eine Einstellung vor.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und Verwenden Sie dieses Verfahren, um die Code-Nummer
fr die Einstellungen der Kindersicherung zu registrieren
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER. oder zu ndern.
Die Einstellungen fr MAC-Adresse, IP-Adresse, Subnet- ber das Standard-Passwort dieses Gerts
Maske, Default-Gateway und DNS-Server (primr und Das Standard-Passwort ist 0000.
sekundr) werden angezeigt. Dieses Gert fordert Sie mglicherweise zur Eingabe eines
Wenn Auto Set IP Address auf On gestellt ist, werden Passworts auf, wenn Sie das Passwort ndern mchten.
die automatisch erhaltenen Werte angezeigt. Wenn Sie dieses Gert zurcksetzen, wird Ihr Passwort
automatisch auf die Standardeinstellung zurckgesetzt.
Hinweis 1 Whlen Sie Security Change Password Next
0.0.0.0 wird angezeigt, wenn nicht jede IP-Adresse Screen, und nehmen Sie eine Einstellung vor.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
eingestellt ist.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Testen der Netzwerkverbindung 2 Geben Sie das Passwort ein.
Geben Sie die Nummer mit den Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) ein,
Whlen Sie Network Connection Test Start, und drcken Sie dann ENTER, um die Einstellung
und nehmen Sie eine Einstellung vor. vorzunehmen.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und Bewegen Sie den Cursor mit /.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
3 Geben Sie das Passwort erneut ein.
Network is OK. (Netzwerkverbindung-Test erfolgreich Geben Sie die Nummer mit den Zifferntasten (0 bis 9) ein,
beendet) wird angezeigt, wenn der Test beendet ist. Wenn und drcken Sie dann ENTER, um die Einstellung
eine andere Meldung angezeigt wird, prfen Sie die vorzunehmen.
Verbindungen und/oder Einstellungen (Seiten 21 und
41). Bewegen Sie den Cursor mit /.
Geben Sie zum ndern des Passworts das zuvor
ndern der Spracheinstellung auf registrierte Passwort und danach das neue Passwort ein.
eine andere Sprache
Hinweis
1 Whlen und stellen Sie Language ein.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und Es wird empfohlen, sich das Passwort zu notieren.
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER. Wenn Sie das Passwort vergessen haben, setzen Sie
2 Whlen Sie OSD, Audio, Subtitle oder Menu und den Player auf die Standardeinstellungen zurck, und
nehmen Sie Einstellungen vor. registrieren sie das Passwort erneut (Seite 47).
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
3 Whlen Sie die gewnschte Sprache und legen
diese fest.
Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
Hinweis
Wenn eine Sprache ausgewhlt ist, die auf der BD/DVD
nicht vorhanden ist, wird automatisch eine der
vorhandenen Sprachen ausgewhlt und wiedergegeben. 45
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 46 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
5 Whlen und stellen Sie Start ein. 4 Whlen Sie Options Update Disc oder USB
Drcken Sie ENTER. Storage Start, und nehmen Sie eine Einstellung 07
vor.
6 Download der Software beginnt. Whlen Sie den gewnschten Eintrag mit / aus, und
Der Software-Download-Status wird auf dem Bildschirm drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
angezeigt.
Je nach den Bedingungen der Internetverbindung 5 Whlen und stellen Sie Yes ein.
kann der Software-Download eine gewisse Zeit dauern. Whlen Sie mit /// die Option Yes aus, und
drcken Sie anschlieend ENTER.
7 Die Aktualisierung beginnt.
Der Software-Update kann eine gewisse Zeit in 6 Die Aktualisierung beginnt.
Anspruch nehmen. Der Software-Update kann eine gewisse Zeit in
Anspruch nehmen.
8 Die Aktualisierung ist fertiggestellt.
Dieses Gert startet automatisch neu. 7 Die Aktualisierung ist fertiggestellt.
Lnder-/Gebietscode-Tabelle
Bezeichnung des Landes/Gebiets, Lnder-/Gebietscode,
Eingabecode
Anguilla, ai, 0109 Estland, ee, 0505 Luxemburg, lu, 1221 Singapur, sg, 1907
Antigua und Barbuda, ag, 0107 Finnland, fi, 0609 Mazedonien, ehem. Slowakei, sk, 1911
Argentinien, ar, 0118 Frankreich, fr, 0618 Yusgoslavische Republik, mk, Slowenien, si, 1909
Armenien, am, 0113 Georgien, ge, 0705 1311 Spanien, es, 0519
Australien, au, 0121 Deutschland, de, 0405 Malaysia, my, 1325 Surinam, sr, 1918
sterreich, at, 0120 Griechenland, gr, 0718 Malta, mt, 1320 Schweden, se, 1905
Aserbaidschan, az, 0126 Grnland, gl, 0712 Mexiko, mx, 1324 Schweiz, ch, 0308
Bahamas, bs, 0219 Grenada, gd, 0704 Republik Moldawien, md, 1304 Taiwan, Provinz von China, tw, 2023
Barbados, bb, 0202 Guyana, gy, 0725 Monaco, mc, 1303 Tadschikistan, tj, 2010
Weirussland, by, 0225 Haiti, ht, 0820 Montserrat, ms, 1319 Thailand, th, 2008
Belgien, be, 0205 Hongkong, hk, 0811 Niederlande, nl, 1412 Trinidad und Tobago, tt, 2020
Belize, bz, 0226 Ungarn, hu, 0821 Neuseeland, nz, 1426 Tunesien, tn, 2014
Bermuda, bm, 0213 Island, is, 0919 Norwegen, no, 1415 Trkei, tr, 2018
Brasilien, br, 0218 Indien, in, 0914 Pakistan, pk, 1611 Turkmenistan, tm, 2013
Bulgarien, bg, 0207 Indonesien, id, 0904 Peru, pe, 1605 Turks- und Caicos-Inseln, tc, 2003
Kanada, ca, 0301 Irland, ie, 0905 Philippinen, ph, 1608 Ukraine, ua, 2101
Kaimaninseln, ky, 1125 Israel, il, 0912 Polen, pl, 1612 Grobritannien, gb, 0702
Chile, cl, 0312 Italien, it, 0920 Portugal, pt, 1620 Vereinigte Staaten von Amerika,
China, cn, 0314 Jamaica, jm, 1013 Puerto Rico, pr, 1618 us, 2119
Kolumbien, co, 0315 Japan, jp, 1016 Rumnien, ro, 1815 Uruguay, uy, 2125
Kroatien, hr, 0818 Kasachstan, kz, 1126 Russische Fderation, ru, 1821 Usbekistan, uz, 2126
Zypern, cy, 0325 Republik Korea, kr, 1118 Saint Kitts und Nevis, kn, 1114 Venezuela, ve, 2205
Tschechische Republik, cz, 0326 Kirgisien, kg, 1107 Santa Lucia, lc, 1203 Jungferninseln, Britisch, vg,
Dnemark, dk, 0411 Lettland, lv, 1222 St. Vincent und die Grenadinen, 2207
Dominica, dm, 0413 Liechtenstein, li, 1209 vc, 2203
Dominikanische Republik, do, 0415 Litauen, lt, 1220 San Marino, sm, 1913
48
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 49 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Kapitel 8 08
Zustzliche Informationen
Hinweis zur THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not
just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms
Lizenz
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is
OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as
ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES form of a textual message at program startup or in
WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA documentation (online or textual) provided with the
Die Lizenzen fr die Open Source OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, package.
Software, die fr diesen Player NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR without modification, are permitted provided that the
verwendet wird, sind nachstehend PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. following conditions are met:
aufgefhrt. Aus Grnden der Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
Genauigkeit haben wir den englischen promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software disclaimer.
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
Text eingeschlossen (auf English). above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
jpeg
curl This software is based in part on the work of the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE independent JPEG Group. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
Copyright 1996 - 2007, Daniel Stenberg, this software must display the following
<[email protected]>. All rights reserved. openssl acknowledgement:
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the "This product includes cryptographic software written
software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby conditions of the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word
granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this license apply to the toolkit. 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the
permission notice appear in all copies. See below for the actual license texts. Actually both library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
THE SOF TWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" , WI THOUT licenses are BSD-style Open Source licenses. In case of any 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, license issues related to OpenSSL please contact openssl- derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF [email protected]. code) you must include an acknowledgement:
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL License "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights ([email protected])"
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR reserved. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS''
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN without modification, are permitted provided that the INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING following conditions are met: WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
SOFTWARE. disclaimer. LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. materials provided with the distribution. OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
expat 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
this software must display the following IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software acknowledgment: NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
Center Ltd "This product includes software developed by the OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:/ THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
obtaining a copy of this software and associated /www.openssl.org/)" The licence and distribution terms for any publically
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" available version or derivative of this code cannot be
without restriction, including without limitation the rights must not be used to endorse or promote products changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, derived from this software without prior written under another distribution licence [including the GNU
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to permission. For written permission, please contact Public Licence.]
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the [email protected].
following conditions: 5. Products derived from this software may not be called zlib
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names This software is based in part on zlib see http://www.zlib.net
be included in all copies or substantial portions of the without prior written permission of the OpenSSL for information.
Software. Project.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the GNU General Public License and
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
following acknowledgment: GNU Lesser General Public License
"This product includes software developed by the
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR This product includes the following software licensed for
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. use under the terms of GNU General
www.openssl.org/)"
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT Public License v2, GNU Lesser General Public License v2.1.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR linux kernel 2.6. Copyright (C) 1991 Linus Torvalds.
PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF Licensed under GPLv2.0
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT BusyBox v1.17.1 multi-call binary. Copyright (C) 1998-
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE 2009 Erik Andersen, Rob Landley, Denys Vlasenko and
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. others. Licensed under GPLv2.0
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL
SquashFS Copyright: (C) 2002-2009 Phillip Lougher
freetype PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
Licensed under GPL v2.0
This software is based in part on freetype see http:// Das U-Boot Copyright: (C) 2000-2005 Wolfang Denk,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
www.freetype.org for information. DENX Software Engineering, [email protected]. Licensed
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
under GPL v2.0
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
International Components for BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
LIRC 0.8.5 Copyright (C) 1996 Ralph Metzler
<[email protected]> Copyright (C) 1998-2008
Unicode ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
Christoph Bartelmus <[email protected]> Licensed
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
under GPL v2.0
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
glibc 2.9 Copyright (C) 1992-2006, 2007 Free Software
Copyright (c) 1995-2010 International Business Machines THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
Foundation, Inc. Licensed under LGPL v2.1.
Corporation and others OF SUCH DAMAGE.
You can get corresponding open source code from the
All rights reserved. This product includes cryptographic software written by
following URL.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person Eric Young ([email protected]). This product includes
http://www.oss-pioneer.com/homeav/blu-ray
obtaining a copy of this software and associated software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Please refer to the following URL for further information of
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software Original SSLeay License
GNU General Public License Version 2.
without restriction, including without limitation the rights Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected])
http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl-2.0.html
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell All rights reserved.
Please refer to the following URL for further information of
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric
GNU Library General Public License Version 2.1.
Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above Young ([email protected]).
http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all The implementation was written so as to conform with
copies of the Software and that both the above copyright Netscapes SSL.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use
as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The
Version 2, June 1991 49
documentation. Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
following conditions apply to all code found in this De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 50 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA started running for such interactive use in the most limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
08 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is not
ordinary way, to print or display an announcement
including an appropriate copyright notice and a
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
allowed. notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
Preamble you provide a warranty) and that users may cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your
The licenses for most software are designed to take away redistribute the program under these conditions, and obligations under this License and any other pertinent
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU telling the user how to view a copy of this License. obligations, then as a consequence you may not
General Public License is intended to guarantee your (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure does not normally print such an announcement, your license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of
the software is free for all its users. This General Public work based on the Program is not required to print an the Program by all those who receive copies directly or
License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's announcement.) indirectly through you, then the only way you could
software and to any other program whose authors commit These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the entirely from distribution of the Program.
is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License Program, and can be reasonably considered independent If any portion of this section is held invalid or
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. and separate works in themselves, then this License, and unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
When we speak of free software, we are referring to its terms, do not apply to those sections when you balance of the section is intended to apply and the
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute section as a whole is intended to apply in other
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based circumstances.
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get the terms of this License, whose permissions for other infringe any patents or other property right claims or to
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and contest validity of any such claims; this section has the
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you every part regardless of who wrote it. sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
can do these things. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or software distribution system, which is implemented by
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, public license practices. Many people have made
forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution generous contributions to the wide range of software
surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain of derivative or collective works based on the Program. distributed through that system in reliance on
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on consistent application of that system; it is up to the
software, or if you modify it. the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium distribute software through any other system and a
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all does not bring the other work under the scope of this licensee cannot impose that choice.
the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, License. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what
receive or can get the source code. And you must show 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
them these terms so they know their rights. based on it, under Section 2) in object code or License.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal above provided that you also do one of the following: restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to machine-readable source code, which must be who places the Program under this License may add an
make certain that everyone understands that there is no distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
warranty for this free software. If the software is modified on a medium customarily used for software those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to interchange; or, or among countries not thus excluded. In such case,
know that what they have is not the original, so that any b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least this License incorporates the limitation as if written in
problems introduced by others will not reflect on the three years, to give any third party, for a charge no the body of this License.
original authors' reputations. more than your cost of physically performing source 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of or new versions of the General Public License from time
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that the corresponding source code, to be distributed to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a present version, but may differ in detail to address new
patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. medium customarily used for software interchange; problems or concerns.
To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must or, Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. c) Accompany it with the information you received as to If the Program specifies a version number of this
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution the offer to distribute corresponding source code. License which applies to it and "any later version", you
and modification follow. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial have the option of following the terms and conditions
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE distribution and only if you received the program in either of that version or of any later version published by
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION object code or executable form with such an offer, in the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not
AND MODIFICATION accord with Subsection b above.) specify a version number of this License, you may
0. This License applies to any program or other work The source code for a work means the preferred form of the choose any version ever published by the Free Software
which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder work for making modifications to it. For an executable Foundation.
saying it may be distributed under the terms of this work, complete source code means all the source code for 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to all modules it contains, plus any associated interface other free programs whose distribution conditions are
any such program or work, and a "work based on the definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
Program" means either the Program or any derivative and installation of the executable. However, as a special software which is copyrighted by the Free Software
work under copyright law: that is to say, a work exception, the source code distributed need not include Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we
containing the Program or a portion of it, either anything that is normally distributed (in either source or sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included and so on) of the operating system on which the executable of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting
without limitation in the term "modification".) Each runs, unless that component itself accompanies the the sharing and reuse of software generally.
licensee is addressed as "you". executable. NO WARRANTY
Activities other than copying, distribution and If distribution of executable or object code is made by 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF
modification are not covered by this License; they are offering access to copy from a designated place, then CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
restricted, and the output from the Program is covered same place counts as distribution of the source code, even APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE
only if its contents constitute a work based on the though third parties are not compelled to copy the source STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
Program (independent of having been made by running along with the object code. OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
Program does. Program except as expressly provided under this EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Program's source code as you receive it, in any sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
medium, provided that you conspicuously and automatically terminate your rights under this License. PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate However, parties who have received copies, or rights, QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact from you under this License will not have their licenses WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
all the notices that refer to this License and to the terminated so long as such parties remain in full DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients compliance. NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
of the Program a copy of this License along with the 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
Program. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring permission to modify or distribute the Program or its COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM
protection in exchange for a fee. you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or or distributing the Program (or any work based on the DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that distributing or modifying the Program or works based PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS
you also meet all of these conditions: on it. OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent 6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES
notices stating that you changed the files and the based on the Program), the recipient automatically OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
date of any change. receives a license from the original licensor to copy, ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived and conditions. You may not impose any further POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
50 terms of this License.
c) If the modified program normally reads commands
compliance by third parties to this License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the
greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve
De interactively when run, you must cause it, when of patent infringement or for any other reason (not
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 51 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
this is to make it free software which everyone can after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And based on the Library (independent of the use of the
redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is
you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we
Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true
depends on what the Library does and what the
08
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license, program that uses the Library does.
effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to modify the library. Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any
where the full notice is found. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear medium, provided that you conspicuously and
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
of what it does.> library is modified by someone else and passed on, the copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> recipients should know that what they have is not the all the notices that refer to this License and to the
This program is free software; you can redistribute it original version, so that the original author's reputation will absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General not be affected by problems that might be introduced by License along with the Library.
Public License as published by the Free Software others. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty
option) any later version. existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that protection in exchange for a fee.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library,
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license and copy and distribute such modifications or work
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you
Public License for more details. the full freedom of use specified in this license. also meet all of these conditions:
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
Public License along with this program; if not, write to the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain notices stating that you changed the files and the
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary date of any change.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic General Public License. We use this license for certain c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed
and paper mail. libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non- at no charge to all third parties under the terms of
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice free programs. this License.
like this when it starts in an interactive mode: When a program is linked with a library, whether statically d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of or using a shared library, the combination of the two is or a table of data to be supplied by an application
author legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the program that uses the facility, other than as an
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO original library. The ordinary General Public License argument passed when the facility is invoked, then
WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. therefore permits such linking only if the entire you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in
This is free software, and you are welcome to combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General the event an application does not supply such
redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other function or table, the facility still operates, and
for details. code with the library. performs whatever part of its purpose remains
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License meaningful.
show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the (For example, a function in a library to compute
Of course, the commands you use may be called ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could software developers Less of an advantage over competing defined independent of the application. Therefore,
even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
program. use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. function or table used by this function must be
You should also get your employer (if you work as a However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain optional: if the application does not supply it, the
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright special circumstances. square root function must still compute square
disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special roots.)
alter the names: need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain These requirements apply to the modified work as a
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
the program this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) A more frequent case is that a free library does the same considered independent and separate works in
written by James Hacker. job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989 little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, apply to those sections when you distribute them as
Ty Coon, President of Vice so we use the Lesser General Public License. separate works. But when you distribute the same
This General Public License does not permit incorporating In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non- sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
your program into proprietary programs. If your program is free programs enables a greater number of people to use a Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the
a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to large body of free software. For example, permission to use terms of this License, whose permissions for other
permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each
this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Public License instead of this License. well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLICLICENSE protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
Version 2.1, February 1999 user of a program that is linked with the Library has the distribution of derivative or collective works based on
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a the Library.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA modified version of the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
copies of this license document, but changing it is not and modification follow. Pay close attention to the based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
allowed. difference between a "work based on the library" and a distribution medium does not bring the other work
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also "work that uses the library". The former contains code under the scope of this License.
counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, derived from the library, whereas the latter must be 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU
version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] combined with the library in order to run. General Public License instead of this License to a given
Preamble GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the
The licenses for most software are designed to take away TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU AND MODIFICATION ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure or other program which contains a notice placed by the the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared,
the software is free for all its users. copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may then you can specify that version instead if you wish.)
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Do not make any other change in these notices.
some specially designated software packages--typically Public License (also called "this License"). Each Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other licensee is addressed as "you". irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we A "library" means a collection of software functions and/ Public License applies to all subsequent copies and
suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with derivative works made from that copy.
or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy application programs (which use some of those This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations functions and data) to form executables. code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
below. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
When we speak of free software, we are referring to or work which has been distributed under these terms. derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are A "work based on the Library" means either the Library executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, above provided that you accompany it with the
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either complete corresponding machine-readable source
service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get verbatim or with modifications and/or translated code, which must be distributed under the terms of
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed translation is included without limitation in the term for software interchange.
that you can do these things. "modification".) If distribution of object code is made by offering access
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of to copy from a designated place, then offering
forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to the work for making modifications to it. For a library, equivalent access to copy the source code from the
surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to complete source code means all the source code for all same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the modules it contains, plus any associated interface source code, even though third parties are not
library or if you modify it. definition files, plus the scripts used to control compelled to copy the source along with the object
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether compilation and installation of the library. code.
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights Activities other than copying, distribution and 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of
that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, modification are not covered by this License; they are the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code
with the library, you must provide complete object files to
outside its scope. The act of running a program using
the Library is not restricted, and output from such a
being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that
uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a
51
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library program is covered only if its contents constitute a work De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 52 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
08 the scope of this License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the
the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library,
and explaining where to find the accompanying
LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN
WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the uncombined form of the same work. PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
Library (because it contains portions of the Library), 8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
rather than a "work that uses the library". The distribute the Library except as expressly provided IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
executable is therefore covered by this License. Section under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
6 states terms for distribution of such executables. modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from void, and will automatically terminate your rights under RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
a header file that is part of the Library, the object code this License. However, parties who have received THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even copies, or rights, from you under this License will not PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is have their licenses terminated so long as such parties NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
especially significant if the work can be linked without remain in full compliance. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, permission to modify or distribute the Library or its MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY
data structure layouts and accessors, and small derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, or distributing the Library (or any work based on the INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
(Executables containing this object code plus portions do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) distributing or modifying the Library or works based on DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you it. LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
may distribute the object code for the work under the 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that based on the Library), the recipient automatically OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are receives a license from the original licensor to copy, OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
linked directly with the Library itself. distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also these terms and conditions. You may not impose any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
Library to produce a work containing portions of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making
choice, provided that the terms permit modification of 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation it free software that everyone can redistribute and change.
the work for the customer's own use and reverse of patent infringement or for any other reason (not You can do so by permitting redistribution under these
engineering for debugging such modifications. limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that General Public License).
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library contradict the conditions of this License, they do not To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the
and its use are covered by this License. You must excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
supply a copy of this License. If the work during cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
execution displays copyright notices, you must include obligations under this License and any other pertinent each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well obligations, then as a consequence you may not pointer to where the full notice is found.
as a reference directing the user to the copy of this distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of
License. Also, you must do one of these things: license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of what it does.>
a) Accompany the work with the complete the Library by all those who receive copies directly or Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
corresponding machine-readable source code for the indirectly through you, then the only way you could This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/
Library including whatever changes were used in the satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 entirely from distribution of the Library. Public
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked If any portion of this section is held invalid or License as published by the Free Software Foundation;
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or balance of the section is intended to apply, and the later version.
source code, so that the user can modify the Library section as a whole is intended to apply in other This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
and then relink to produce a modified executable circumstances. useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
containing the modified Library. (It is understood It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS
that the user who changes the contents of definitions infringe any patents or other property right claims or to FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser
files in the Library will not necessarily be able to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the General Public License for more details.
recompile the application to use the modified sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
definitions.) software distribution system which is implemented by General Public License along with this library; if not,
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking public license practices. Many people have made write to the Free Software
with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) generous contributions to the wide range of software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston,
uses at run time a copy of the library already present distributed through that system in reliance on MA 02110-1301 USA
on the user's computer system, rather than copying consistent application of that system; it is up to the Also add information on how to contact you by electronic
library functions into the executable, and (2) will author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to and paper mail.
operate properly with a modified version of the library, distribute software through any other system and a You should also get your employer (if you work as a
if the user installs one, as long as the modified licensee cannot impose that choice. programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright
version is interface-compatible with the version that This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
the work was made with. is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this alter the names:
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in
least three years, to give the same user the materials 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted by James Random Hacker.
more than the cost of performing this distribution. interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access Library under this License may add an explicit Ty Coon, President of Vice
to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent geographical distribution limitation excluding those That's all there is to it!
access to copy the above specified materials from the countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
same place. among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of License incorporates the limitation as if written in the
these materials or that you have already sent this body of this License.
user a copy. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
For an executable, the required form of the "work that or new versions of the Lesser General Public License
uses the Library" must include any data and utility from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
programs needed for reproducing the executable from spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be address new problems or concerns.
distributed need not include anything that is normally Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the If the Library specifies a version number of this License
major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the which applies to it and "any later version", you have the
operating system on which the executable runs, unless option of following the terms and conditions either of
that component itself accompanies the executable. that version or of any later version published by the Free
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do license version number, you may choose any version
not normally accompany the operating system. Such a ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other
Library together in an executable that you distribute. free programs whose distribution conditions are
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
the Library side-by-side in a single library together with permission. For software which is copyrighted by the
other library facilities not covered by this License, and Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software
distribute such a combined library, provided that the Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
separate distribution of the work based on the Library Our decision will be guided by the two goals of
and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
and provided that you do these two things: software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the software generally.
52 same work based on the Library, uncombined with
any other library facilities. This must be distributed 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
NO WARRANTY
De under the terms of the Sections above. CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 53 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Vorsichtshinweise Kondensation 08
Wenn der Player pltzlich aus der Klte in einen warmen Raum
Transportieren des Players gebracht wird (z. B. im Winter) oder wenn die Temperatur in
dem Raum, in dem der Player aufgestellt ist, pltzlich aufgrund
eines Heizlfters usw. ansteigt, knnen sich im Inneren des
Wenn Sie dieses Gert transportieren mssen, nehmen
Gerts Wassertropfen (Kondensation) bilden (auf beweglichen
Sie zuerst die Disc heraus, falls eine eingelegt ist, und
Teilen und der Linse). Wenn es zu Kondensation kommt,
schlieen Sie die Disc-Lade. Drcken Sie als nchstes
arbeitet der Player nicht ordnungsgem, und die Wiedergabe
STANDBY/ON, um das Gert in den
ist nicht mglich. Lassen Sie den Player fr 1 bis 2 Stunden bei
Bereitschaftsmodus zu schalten. Achten Sie dabei
Raumtemperatur eingeschaltet (die erforderliche Dauer hngt
darauf, dass die POWER OFF-Anzeige auf dem
vom Ausma der Kondensation ab). Die Wassertropfen
Frontplattendisplay erlischt. Warten Sie mindestens 10
verdampfen und die Wiedergabe ist wieder mglicht.
Sekunden. Ziehen Sie zum Schluss das Netzkabel ab.
Zu Kondensation kann es auch im Sommer kommen,
Whrend der Wiedergabe darf das Gert nicht
wenn der Player direkt dem Luftzug aus einer
angehoben und nicht bewegt werden. Die Disc rotiert mit
Klimaanlage ausgesetzt wird. Stellen Sie den Player in
hoher Drehzahl und kann beschdigt werden.
diesem Fall an einem anderen Ort auf.
Installationsort Reinigen des Players
Whlen Sie einen stabilen Aufstellort in der Nhe des
In der Regel gengt es, den Player mit einem weichen Tuch
Fernsehgerts und AV-Systems, an die Sie das Gert
abzuwischen. Tragen Sie bei hartnckigen Verschmutzungen
anschlieen.
ein wenig in 5 bis 6 Teilen Wasser verdnnten Neutralreiniger
Stellen Sie den Player nicht auf ein Fernsehgert oder auf ein weiches Tuch auf. Wringen Sie das Tuch sorgfltig
einen Farbmonitor. Halten Sie den Player von aus, wischen Sie den Schmutz ab, und wischen Sie mit
Kassettendecks oder anderen Komponenten mit starken einem trockenen Tuch nach.
Magnetfeldern fern.
Beachten Sie, dass das Auftragen von Alkohol, Verdnner,
Vermeiden Sie folgende Aufstellorte: Benzin oder Insektiziden auf den Player dazu fhren kann,
Orte, die direkter Sonneneinstrahlung ausgesetzt sind dass sich Beschriftungen und Beschichtungen ablsen.
Vermeiden Sie auerdem, dass Gummi- oder
Feuchte oder schlecht belftete Orte
Vinylprodukte lngere Zeit in Kontakt mit dem Player
Orte mit extrem hohen oder niedrigen Temperaturen geraten, da dies das Gehuse beschdigen knnte.
Orte, die Vibrationen ausgesetzt sind Wenn Sie chemisch imprgnierte Wischtcher usw.
Staubige Orte verwenden, lesen Sie sich die Vorsichtshinweise zu den
Orte, die Ru, Dampf oder Hitze ausgesetzt sind (in Produkten sorgfltig durch.
Kchen usw.) Ziehen Sie das Netzkabel von der Wandsteckdose ab,
wenn Sie den Player reinigen.
Stellen Sie keine Gegenstnde auf
das Gert Vorsichtsmaregel, wenn das
Stellen Sie keine Gegenstnde auf den Player. Gert in einem Rack mit
Blockieren Sie nicht die
Glastr aufgestellt ist
Lftungsffnungen Drcken Sie nicht die Taste OPEN/CLOSE auf der
Fernbedienung, um die Disc-Lade bei geschlossener
Verwenden Sie den Player nicht auf dicken Teppichen, Glastr zu ffnen. Die Tr behindert die Bewegung der
Betten oder Sofas, und decken Sie ihn nicht mit Kleidung Disc-Lade, und das Gert knnte beschdigt werden.
usw. ab. Dies verhindert die Wrmeableitung und kann
zu Beschdigungen fhren.
Reinigen der Abtastlinse
Von Hitze fernhalten Die Linse des Players verschmutzt bei normalem
Stellen Sie den Player nicht auf einen Verstrker oder ein Gebrauch praktisch nicht. Sollte sie dennoch auf Grund
anderes Gert, das Hitze erzeugt. Wenn Sie den Player in von Staub oder Schmutz versagen, wenden Sie sich an
einem Rack platzieren, stellen Sie ihn nach Mglichkeit die nchste Pioneer-Kundendienstvertretung. Von der
auf ein Fach unterhalb des Verstrkers, um ihn keiner Verwendung im Fachhandel erhltlicher Linsen-Reiniger
durch den Verstrker erzeugten Hitze auszusetzen. wird abgeraten, da einige dieser Reiniger die Linse
beschdigen knnen.
Schalten Sie den Player aus,
wenn Sie ihn nicht verwenden Handhabung von Discs
Verwenden Sie keine beschdigten (gebrochenen oder
Je nach den Empfangsbedingungen des Fernsehsignals verbogenen) Discs.
knnen auf dem Bildschirm Streifenmuster erscheinen, wenn
das Fernsehgert bei eingeschaltetem Player eingeschaltet Achten Sie darauf, dass die Datentrgeroberflche der
wird. Dies ist keine Fehlfunktion des Players oder Disc nicht zerkratzt oder verschmutzt.
Fernsehgerts. Schalten Sie in diesem Fall den Player aus. Legen Sie nicht mehr als eine Disc zur Zeit in den Player ein.
hnlich kann es zu Rauschen beim Radioempfang kommen. 53
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 54 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Bekleben Sie Discs nicht mit Papier oder Aufklebern, und Verwenden Sie weder Benzin, Verdnner noch andere
08 beschriften Sie sie nicht mit einem Bleistift, flchtige Chemikalien. Verwenden Sie kein
Kugelschreiber oder einem anderen spitzen Schallplattenspray oder Antistatikspray.
Schreibgert. Diese knnten die Disc beschdigen. Tragen Sie bei hartnckigen Verschmutzungen ein wenig
Wasser auf ein weiches Tuch auf. Wringen Sie das Tuch
sorgfltig aus, wischen Sie den Schmutz ab, und wischen
Sie mit einem trockenen Tuch nach.
Strungssuche
Bedienungsfehler werden oft irrtmlich fr Strungen oder Ausflle gehalten. Wenn Sie den Eindruck haben, dass
diese Komponente nicht ordnungsgem funktioniert, berprfen Sie bitte die folgenden Punkte. Manchmal wird eine
Strung auch durch ein externes Gert verursacht. berprfen Sie die anderen verwendeten Komponenten und
elektrischen Gerte. Falls sich die Strung selbst nach einer berprfung der unten aufgelisteten Punkte nicht
beheben lsst, wenden Sie sich bezglich einer Reparatur an die nchste autorisierte Pioneer-Kundendienststelle.
Wiedergabe
Problem Prfen Abhilfe
Disc-Wiedergabe startet Kann der Disc-Typ auf Prfen Sie, ob der Disc-Typ auf diesem Player abgespielt werden kann
nicht. diesem Player abgespielt (Seite 7).
Disc-Lade ffnet sich werden?
automatisch. Kann der Dateityp auf diesem Prfen Sie, ob der Dateityp auf diesem Player abgespielt werden kann
Player abgespielt werden? (Seite 10).
Prfen Sie, ob die Datei beschdigt ist.
Ist die Disc zerkratzt? Zerkratzte Discs knnen mglicherweise nicht abgespielt werden.
Ist die Disc verschmutzt? Reinigen Sie die Disc (oben).
Ist ein Stck Papier oder ein Die Disc ist mglicherweise verwellt und nicht abspielbar.
Aufkleber an den Discs
angebracht?
Ist die Disc ordnungsgem Legen Sie die Disc mit der bedruckten Seite nach oben ein.
in die Disc-Lade eingelegt? Legen Sie die Disc ordnungsgem in die Vertiefung in der Disc-Lade
ein.
Ist der Regionalcode korrekt? Siehe Seite 9 fr die Regionalcodes auf Discs, die auf diesem Player
abgespielt werden knnen.
54
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 55 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Steuerungsfunktion 08
Problem Prfen Abhilfe
Steuerungsfunktion Ist das HDMI-Kabel richtig Zur Verwendung der Steuerungsfunktion schlieen Sie den
funktioniert nicht. angeschlossen? Flachbildfernseher und Ihre AV-Anlage (AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker
usw.) an die HDMI OUT-Buchse an (Seite 15).
Handelt es sich bei dem Verwenden Sie ein High-Speed-HDMI-Kabel. Die HDMI Control-
verwendeten HDMI-Kabel Funktion arbeitet mglicherweise nicht ordnungsgem, wenn Sie ein
um ein High-Speed-HDMI- anderes HDMI-Kabel als ein High-Speed-HDMI-Kabel verwenden.
Kabel?
Ist dieser Player mit einem Wenn Videosignale von einer anderen Buchse als der HDMI OUT-
HDMI-Kabel zum Betrachten Buchse ausgegeben werden, arbeitet die Steuerungsfunktion nicht.
des Bildes am Fernsehgert Stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fernsehgert mit einem HDMI-Kabel
angeschlossen? (Seite 15) vor.
Fr den BDP-LX55: Wenn beide HDMI OUT-Buchsen (MAIN und SUB) verwendet werden,
Ist der HDMI Mode richtig arbeitet die Steuerfunktion nur fr die HDMI OUT (SUB)-Buchse
eingestellt? (Seite 16).
Ist Control auf dem Player Stellen Sie Control auf dem Player auf On (Seite 41).
auf On gestellt?
Untersttzt das Die Steuerungsfunktion kann nicht mit Gerten anderer Hersteller
angeschlossene Gert die verwendet werden, die die Steuerungsfunktion nicht untersttzen,
Steuerungsfunktion? auch wenn sie ber ein HDMI-Kabel angeschlossen sind.
Die Steuerungsfunktion arbeitet nicht, wenn Gerte, welche die
Steuerungsfunktion nicht untersttzen, zwischen dem mit Steuerung
kompatiblen Gert und dem Player angeschlossen sind.
Siehe Seite 16.
Auch bei Anschluss an ein mit der Steuerungsfunktion kompatibles
Pioneer-Produkt knnen einige der Funktionen nicht arbeiten.
Beachten Sie auch die Bedienungsanleitung fr die angeschlossene
Komponente.
Ist die Steuerung auf dem Aktivieren Sie die Steuerung auf dem angeschlossenen Gert. Die
angeschlossenen Gert Steuerungsfunktion arbeitet, wenn Steuerung fr alle an die HDMI
aktiviert? OUT-Buchse angeschlossenen Gerte auf On geschaltet ist.
Wenn die Anschlsse und Einstellungen aller Gerte abgeschlossen
sind, vergewissern Sie sich, dass das Bild des Players an den
Flachbildfernseher ausgegeben wird. (berprfen Sie dies auch,
nachdem Sie die angeschlossenen Gerte gewechselt und HDMI-
Kabel angeschlossen und/oder abgezogen haben.) Wenn das Bild des
Players nicht an den Flachbildfernseher ausgegeben wird, arbeitet die
Steuerungsfunktion mglicherweise nicht korrekt.
Einzelheiten finden Sie in der Bedienungsanleitung der
angeschlossenen Komponente.
Sind mehrere Player Die Steuerungsfunktion arbeitet unter Umstnden nicht, wenn drei
angeschlossen? oder mehr Player (einschlielich dieses Players) ber ein HDMI-Kabel
verbunden sind.
Netzwerk
Problem Prfen Abhilfe
BD-LIVE-Funktion Fhren Sie den Connection Test aus (Seite 45). Wenn Networks is
(Verbindung zum Internet) OK. (Netzwerkverbindung-Test erfolgreich beendet) angezeigt wird,
kann nicht verwendet prfen Sie die Einstellungen des Proxy-Servers (Seite 44). Auerdem
werden. kann ein Problem mit der Internetverbindung vorliegen. Wenden Sie
No valid id file found! sich an Ihren Internetanbieter.
(Verbindung zum Software-
Update-Server ist
fehlgeschlagen) erscheint,
wenn ich versuche, die
Software upzudaten.
Software-Aktualisierung ist Je nach der Internetverbindung und anderen Bedingungen kann eine
langsam. gewisse Zeit fr den Update der Software erforderlich sein.
57
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 58 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Sonstiges
Problem Prfen Abhilfe
Die Stromversorgung des Ist Auto Power Off auf 10 Wenn Auto Power Off auf 10 min/20 min/30 min gestellt ist, schaltet
Players schaltet automatisch min/20 min/30 min gestellt? sich der Player automatisch aus, wenn 30 Minuten lang keine Eingabe
aus. erfolgt (Seite 43).
Die Stromversorgung des Ist Control auf On gestellt? Der Player schaltet sich mglicherweise mit der Stromversorgung des
Players schaltet automatisch an die HDMI OUT-Buchse angeschlossenen Fernsehgerts ein und
aus. aus. Wenn Sie nicht mchten, dass der Player beim Ein- oder
Ausschalten des Fernsehgerts ebenfalls ein- oder ausgeschaltet wird,
stellen Sie Control auf Off (Seite 41).
Der Player kann nicht mit der Befindet sich die Verwenden Sie die Fernbedienung in einer Entfernung von maximal 7
Fernbedienung bedient Fernbedienung zu weit vom m zum Fernbedienungssensor.
werden. Player entfernt?
Sind die Batterien Tauschen Sie die Batterien aus (Seite 5).
verbraucht?
Der Eingang des Ist Control auf On gestellt? Der Eingang des angeschlossenen Fernsehgerts und AV-Systems
angeschlossenen (AV-Receiver und -Verstrker usw.), angeschlossen an die HDMI OUT-
Fernsehgert und AV-System Buchse, schaltet mglicherweise automatisch auf den Player um,
schaltet automatisch um. wenn auf dem Player die Wiedergabe gestartet oder der Men-
Bildschirm (Home Media Gallery, usw.) angezeigt wird. Wenn Sie nicht
mchten, dass die Eingnge des angeschlossenen Fernsehgerts und
Ihres AV-Systems (AV-Receiver oder -Verstrker usw.) automatisch
umgeschaltet werden, stellen Sie Control auf Off (Seite 41).
Einstellungen, die ich Haben Sie das Netzkabel Drcken Sie stets STANDBY/ON an der Frontplatte des Players oder
vorgenommen habe, wurden abgezogen, whrend der STANDBY/ON auf der Fernbedienung, und prfen Sie, dass
mglicherweise gelscht. Player eingeschaltet war? POWER OFF auf dem Frontplattendisplay erloschen ist, bevor Sie das
Gab es einen Stromausfall? Netzkabel ziehen. Seien Sie insbesondere vorsichtig, wenn das
Netzkabel an eine Netzsteckdose eines anderen Gerts angeschlossen
ist, da der Player in diesem Fall gemeinsam mit dem Gert
ausgeschaltet wird.
58
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 59 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Parental Lock
Siehe Seite 46.
60
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_DE.book Page 61 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:03 AM
Technische Daten 08
Modell BDP-LX55
BDP-440
BDP-140
Typ Blu-ray 3DTM SPIELER
Nennspannung Wechselstrom 100 V bis 240 V
Nennfrequenz 50 Hz/60 Hz
Leistungsaufnahme BDP-LX55: 25 W
BDP-440, BDP-140: 23 W
Leistungsaufnahme (Standby) 0,3 W
Gewicht BDP-LX55: 3,5 kg
BDP-440: 2,6 kg
BDP-140: 2,1 kg
Auenabmessungen (einschlielich vorstehender Teile) BDP-LX55: 435 mm (B) x 93 mm (H) x 252 mm (T)
BDP-440: 435 mm (B) x 90 mm (H) x 252 mm (T)
BDP-140: 435 mm (B) x 58 mm (H) x 249 mm (T)
Betriebstemperatur +5 C bis +35 C
Betriebsluftfeuchtigkeit 5 % bis 85 % (keine Kondensation)
Ausgangsbuchsen
Hinweis
nderungen der technischen Daten und das Design dieses Gerts ohne vorherige Ankndigung bleiben
vorbehalten.
2011 PIONEER CORPORATION. Alle Rechte vorbehalten.
61
De
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 2 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
9LULQJUD]LDPRSHUDYHUHDFTXLVWDWRTXHVWRSURGRWWR3LRQHHU
9LSUHJKLDPRGLOHJJHUHTXHVWHTXHVWHLVWUX]LRQLSHUOXVRLQPRGRGDVDSHUHXVDUHFRUUHWWDPHQWHLOSURSULRPRGHOOR
'RSRDYHUOHWWRTXHVWHLVWUX]LRQLULSRUOHLQXQOXRJRVLFXURSHUSRWHUOHFRQVXOWDUHGLQXRYRDOPRPHQWRGHOELVRJQR
IMPORTANTE
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
Il simbolo del lampo con terminale a forma ATTENZIONE: Il punto esclamativo in un triangolo
di freccia situato allinterno di un triangolo PER EVITARE IL RISCHIO DI SCOSSE equilatero serve ad avvisare lutilizzatore
equilatero serve ad avvisare lutilizzatore ELETTRICHE, NON RIMUOVERE IL della presenza di importanti istruzioni di
della presenza di una tensione pericolosa COPERCHIO (O IL RETRO). NON CI SONO funzionamento e manutenzione riportate nel
non isolata nella struttura del prodotto che PARTI INTERNE LA CUI MANUTENZIONE libretto allegato al prodotto.
potrebbe essere di unintensit tale da POSSA ESSERE EFFETTUATA
provocare scosse elettriche allutilizzatore. DALLUTENTE. IN CASO DI NECESSIT,
RIVOLGERSI ESCLUSIVAMENTE A
PERSONALE DI SERVIZIO QUALIFICATO.
D3-4-2-1-1_A1_It
ATTENZIONE AVVERTENZA
Prima di collegare per la prima volta lapparecchio alla Linterruttore principale ( STANDBY/ON)
sorgente di alimentazione leggere attentamente la dellapparecchio non stacca completamente il flusso
sezione che segue. di corrente elettrica dalla presa di corrente alternata
La tensione della sorgente di elettricit differisce di rete. Dal momento che il cavo di alimentazione
da Paese a Paese e da regione a regione. Verificare costituisce lunico dispositivo di distacco
che la tensione di rete della zona in cui si intende dellapparecchio dalla sorgente di alimentazione, il
utilizzare lapparecchio sia quella corretta, come cavo stesso deve essere staccato dalla presa di
indicato sul pannello posteriore dellapparecchio corrente alternata di rete per sospendere
stesso (ad es.: 230 V o 120 V). completamente qualsiasi flusso di corrente.
D3-4-2-1-4*_A1_It
Verificare quindi che lapparecchio sia stato installato
in modo da poter procedere con facilit al distacco
Condizioni ambientali di funzionamento del cavo di alimentazione dalla presa di corrente, in
Gamma ideale della temperatura ed umidit caso di necessit. Per prevenire pericoli di incendi,
dellambiente di funzionamento: inoltre, il cavo di alimentazione deve essere staccato
da +5 C a +35 C, umidit relativa inferiore all85 % dalla presa di corrente alternata di rete se si pensa di
(fessure di ventilazione non bloccate) non utilizzare lapparecchio per periodi di tempo
Non installare lapparecchio in luoghi poco ventilati, o relativamente lunghi (ad esempio, durante una
in luoghi esposti ad alte umidit o alla diretta luce del vacanza). D3-4-2-2-2a*_A1_It
K058a_A1_It
!VVERTENZERIGUARDANTILAVISIONE$
p 3ESIDOVESSEROACCUSAREAFFATICAMENTOODISAGIODURANTELAVISIONEDIIMMAGINI$INTERROMPERELAVISIONE
p )BAMBINIINPARTICOLAREDIETALDISOTTODEIANNIPOSSONOESSEREPARTICOLARMENTESENSIBILIECHILISORVEGLIADEVEFARE
ATTENZIONEALLAPOSSIBILEPRESENZADISEGNIDIAFFATICAMENTOODISAGIO
p $URANTELAVISIONEDIIMMAGINIA$RIPOSAREPERIODICAMENTE
,APROLUNGATAVISIONEDIIMMAGINIA$SENZAPERIODIDIRIPOSAPUCAUSAREAFFATICAMENTOODISAGIO
3
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 4 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Indice
01 Prima di iniziare Uso del menu FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Contenuto della confezione . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Riproduzione da un momento particolare
Inserimento delle batterie nel telecomando . . . . . . . . . 5 (ricerca a tempo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Software Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Riproduzione di un titolo, capitolo o brano
Controllo di questo lettore da un dispositivo mobile specifico (ricerca) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
(iPod, iPhone, iPad, ecc.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Riproduzione in ordine casuale di una gamma
Tipi di dischi/file riproducibili . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 specifica di dischi, titoli o capitoli (brani/file) . . . . . . . 33
Dischi riproducibili . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Continuazione della riproduzione da una posizione
File riproducibili. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 particolare (Continued Viewing Playback) . . . . . . . . . 33
Nome delle varie parti e funzioni . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 05 Riproduzione con Home Media Gallery
Telecomando . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Home Media Gallery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Pannello anteriore. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 La riproduzione in rete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Pannello posteriore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 DLNA Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
02 Collegamento Riproduzione di dischi/USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Collegamenti via cavo HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Riproduzione di file di immagine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Informazioni su HDMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Riproduzione in un ordine desiderato (Playlist) . . . . . . 36
La funzione Control con HDMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Aggiunta di brani o file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Collegamento di un televisore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Riproduzione con Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Collegamento con un ricevitore o Cancellazione di brani/file da Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
amplificatore AV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 06 Riproduzione di contenuti dal Web
Collegamento di cavi video ed audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Contenuti dal Web disponibili . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Collegamento ad un televisore con un cavo Riproduzione di voci . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
video/audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Collegamento di un ricevitore o amplificatore AV
07 Impostazioni avanzate
Modifica delle impostazioni . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
usando un cavo audio digitale a fibre ottiche. . . . . . . 20
Collegamento di componenti alla porta USB . . . . . . . . 20 Uso della schermata Initial Setup
(Impostazione iniziale) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
I dispositivi di memoria di massa USB . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Aggiornamento del software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Collegamento di dispositivi di memoria di
Ritorno alle impostazioni predefinite di tutti i
massa USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
parametri . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Collegamento alla rete LAN via linterfaccia LAN . . . . . 21
Tabella dei codici delle lingue e tabella dei codici
Collegamento ad una LAN wireless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
di paesi ed area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Collegamento del cavo di alimentazione . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
08 Informazioni aggiuntive
03 Come iniziare Avvertenza sulle licenze del software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Impostazioni con il menu Setup Navigator . . . . . . . . . . 23
Precauzioni per luso . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Controllo del televisore con il telecomando del
Trasporto del lettore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
lettore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Posizione di installazione . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Lista dei codici di controllo del televisore . . . . . . . . . . 24 Spegnere il lettore se non in uso . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
04 Riproduzione Condensa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Riproduzione di dischi e file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Pulizia del lettore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Scansione in avanti ed inversa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Precauzioni nel caso lunit venga installata in
Riproduzione di capitoli e brani particolari. . . . . . . . . 27 uno scaffale con una porta di vetro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Salto di contenuti . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Pulitura della lente del lettore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Riproduzione al rallentatore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Trattamento dei dischi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Passi in avanti ed allindietro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Diagnostica . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Riproduzione ripetuta di una sezione specifica di Riproduzione . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
un titolo o brano (ripetizione A-B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Funzione Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Ripetizione della riproduzione Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
(riproduzione ripetuta) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Altri problemi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Riproduzione in un ordine desiderato Glossario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
(riproduzione programmata) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Dati tecnici . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Creazione di segnalibri . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Zoom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Visualizzazione di anteprime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Cambio dellangolo della telecamera . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Cambiamento dei sottotitoli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Visualizzazione di informazioni sul disco . . . . . . . . . . 29
Cambio dellaudio o audio secondario . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Attivazione del video secondario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Uso di BONUSVIEW o BD-LIVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
4 Funzioni di riproduzione . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 5 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Capitolo 1 01
Prima di iniziare
Contenuto della AVVERTENZA
Documento di garanzia
Attenzione
Cavo di alimentazione
Non usare batterie diverse da quelle specificate.
Istruzioni per luso (questo manuale)
Inoltre, non usare una nuova batteria insieme ad una
Inserimento delle batterie vecchia.
Nel caricare le batterie nel telecomando, fare
nel telecomando attenzione ad orientarle correttamente nel modo
indicato dalle polarit ( e ).
1 Aprire la copertina dal retro. Non riscaldare, smontare o gettare nel fuoco o in
acqua le batterie.
Le batterie possono avere voltaggi differenti anche se
sembrano simili. Non usare insieme batterie
Premere differenti.
leggermente in Per evitare che perdano fluido, togliere le batterie se
questo punto e far
scivolare nella si pensa di non dover usare il telecomando per
direzione della qualche tempo (un mese o pi). Se il fluido dovesse
freccia. fuoriuscire, pulire bene il vano delle batterie prima di
2 Inserire le batterie (AAA/R03 x 2). inserire batterie nuove. Se una batteria dovesse
Inserire nel modo indicato dai segni / del vano delle perdere e del fluido dovessero toccare la pelle, lavarla
batterie. con grandi quantit di acqua.
Nel gettare batterie usate, rispettare le norme di legge
in vigore nel vs. paese o area in tema di protezione
dellambiente.
Inserire per primo il
polo negativo ().
5
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 6 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
01 Software Update
Le informazioni su questo lettore sono fornite dal sito di
Pioneer. Per aggiornamenti ed informazioni sul vostro
Riproduttore di Blu-ray Disc, controllare il sito Web
seguente.
In Europa:
http://www.pioneer.eu
Nel Regno Unito:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer.co.uk/
In Russia:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer-rus.ru/
In Hong Kong:
http://www.pioneerhongkong.com.hk/
In Singapore:
http://www.pioneer.com.sg/firmwaredownload
In Australia
http://www.pioneer.com.au/
Controllo di questo
lettore da un
dispositivo mobile
(iPod, iPhone, iPad,
ecc.)
Il lettore pu venire controllato da un dispositivo mobile
installando su di esso uno speciale applicativo.
Per dettagli, vedere le informazioni sul prodotto del sito
Pioneer.
Questo applicativo speciale potrebbe venire modificato e
abbandonato senza preavviso.
6
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 7 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Dischi riproducibili
Dischi con i logo che seguono stampati sulletichetta, sulla custodia o sulla copertina.
Attenzione
Si possono visualizzare solo dischi finalizzati.
Tipo di uso
Tipo di disco Logo DVD- DVD- CD-DA DATA-
BDMV BDAV DVD VR
Video Audio DTS-CD DISC1
BD-ROM
BD-R
BD2
BD-RE
DVD-ROM 3
DVD
DVD-R2,4,5 6 7
DVD-RW4,8 6 7
DVD+R2.4
DVD+RW4
CD-DA
(CD audio)9
CD
CD-R4
CD-RW4
CD-ROM
1. Dischi sui quali sono registrati file video, di immagini o audio. Questo lettore non supporta i dischi multisession o le registrazioni
multiborder.
2. Compresi i dischi a doppio strato.
3. Soli BDP-LX55 e BDP-440.
4. Finalizzare i dischi prima di provare a riprodurli con questo lettore.
5. I dischi DVD-R for Authoring (da 3,95 e 4,7 GB) non possono venire riprodotti.
6. Incluso il formato AVCHD.
7. Incluso il formato AVCREC.
8. I DVD-RW di Versione 1.0 non possono venire riprodotti.
9. Inclusi i CD video.
7
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 8 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
I nomi di imprese e prodotto menzionati sono marchi di Formato Blu-ray Disc Recordable (R) Versione 2
fabbrica o marchi di fabbrica depositati dei rispettivi Formato Blu-ray Disc Rewritable (RE) Versione 3
proprietari.
Questo lettore supporta i BD-ROM Profile 5.
Dischi non riproducibili
DVD HD
Dischi DVD-RAM
possibile che alcuni dischi non presenti nella lista qui
sopra non possano venire riprodotti. Blu-ray 3D e il logo Blu-ray 3D sono marchi di
fabbrica della Blu-ray Disc Association.
Nota Le funzioni BONUSVIEW come la riproduzione di
Alcuni dischi non possono venire riprodotti anche se video secondari (immagine nellimmagine) ed audio
portano uno dei loghi visti alla pagina precedente. secondario possono venire usate. I dati usati con la
Per riprodurre dischi da 8 cm, metterli nella funzione BONUSVIEW (il video secondario
depressione da 8 cm al centro del piatto portadisco. (immagine nellimmagine) ed i dati dellaudio
Non sono necessari adattatori. I BD-ROM da 8 cm secondario) possono venire salvati in dispositivi di
non possono venire riprodotti. memoria di massa. Per dettagli sulla riproduzione di
video ed audio secondari, consultare le istruzioni del
I formati audio disco.
I seguenti formati audio sono supportati da questo
lettore:
Dolby TrueHD BONUSVIEW un marchio di fabbrica della Blu-ray
Disc Association.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Le funzioni BD-LIVE, ad esempio il download di
DTS-HD Master Audio anteprime di film, audio o lingue addizionali, e la
riproduzione di giochi in linea possono avere luogo su
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio Internet. I dati scaricati con la funzione BD-LIVE
DTS Digital Surround (anteprime, ecc.) vengono memorizzati nel
Audio MPEG (AAC) dispositivo di memoria di massa. Per dettagli sulle
funzioni BD-LIVE, consultare le istruzioni del disco.
Linear PCM
Per riprodurre il segnale surround Dolby TrueHD, Dolby
Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio e DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio, si raccomanda di collegare il lettore ad
un ricevitore o amplificatore AV compatibile con questi
formati audio usando un cavo HDMI. Caricato un disco
Il logo BD-LIVE un marchio di fabbrica della Blu-ray
BD contenente suono in uno di questi formati audio,
Disc Association.
scegliere il formato audio desiderato dal menu.
Prodotto su licenza dei Dolby Laboratories. Dolby e il
simbolo della doppia D sono marchi dei Dolby Laboratories.
Fabbricato su licenza nei termini dei brevetti USA N:
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,392,195;
7,272,567; 7,333,929; 7,212,872 & ed altri brevetti per gli
USA e mondiali rilasciati o richiesti. DTS-HD, il relativo
simbolo, DTS-HD ed il suo simbolo sono tutti marchi di
fabbrica depositati, e DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential
un marchio di fabbrica della DTS, Inc. Il prodotto include
software. DTS, Inc. Tutti i diritti sono riservati.
8
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 9 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
9
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 10 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Base
001.jpg/001.mp3 *
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
001.jpg/001.mp3 Nota
MKV
I file MKV possono venire riprodotti.
Nome delle varie parti 01
MKV un formato di file in grado di contenere vari e funzioni
file audio e video in un solo file.
I file riproducibili sono:
Risoluzione: Fino a 1 280 x 720 Telecomando
Estensione: .mkv o .MKV
19
Windows Media Video (WMV)
I file Windows Media Video (WMV) possono essere 1 20
riprodotti. 2
11
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 12 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Pannello anteriore 01
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-140
1 3 4 6 8 9 10 11
13
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 14 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
01 Pannello posteriore
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 5 6 8
BDP-140
3 4 2 1 5 6 8
1 Terminali HDMI OUT (di seguito e a pagina 15) 5 Terminale LAN (10/100) (pagina 21)
2 Terminali VIDEO OUTPUT (pagina 20) 6 Porta USB (pagina 20)
3 Terminale DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL) (pagina 20) 7 Terminale RS-232C (solo BDP-LX55) Questo
terminale non viene usato.
4 Terminali AUDIO OUTPUT (pagina 20)
8 AC IN (pagina 22)
Nota
Il terminale SUB non pu emettere segnale video. Verificare di aver collegato il televisore al terminale MAIN.
14
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 15 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Capitolo 2 02
Collegamento
Prima di fare o modificare collegamenti, non mancare di Questo compatibile con prodotti x.v.Color capaci di
spegnere lapparecchio e di scollegare il cavo di realizzare lampio spazio di colore dello standard xvYCC.
alimentazione. La riproduzione di segnali video conformi agli standard
Dopo i collegamenti, fare le impostazioni del menu Setup xvYCC con questo lettore quando il lettore collegato
Navigator o Initial Setup a seconda del tipo di cavo con un televisore o altro apparecchio x.v.Color
collegato (pagina 23). compatibile espande le possibilit di riproduzione dei
colori, permettendo la riproduzione pi federe che mai di
Consultare anche le istruzioni per luso del dispositivo colori naturali.
collegato. x.v.Color un nome promozionale dato a prodotti
capaci di riprodurre lampio spazio colore basato sugli
Nota standard internazionali chiamati xvYCC.
Le illustrazioni qui usate sono principalmente del
BDP-LX55.
15
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 16 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
16
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 17 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
17
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 18 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
02 Collegamento di un BDP-440/BDP-140
televisore Pannello posteriore del BDP-440
Attenzione
Nel collegare o scollegare un cavo, far sempre presa
separatamente)
acquistare
Cavo HDMI (da
sulla spina.
Appoggiando oggetti su di una spina questa potrebbe Far corrispondere la
non far bene contatto e non emettere segnali video. direzione della spina al
Al terminale terminale ed inserirla.
HDMI di
BDP-LX55 ingresso anche possibile collegare un
ricevitore o amplificatore AV o usando
Collegare un televisore al terminale HDMI OUT (MAIN). un cavo HDMI (di seguito).
Collegamento con un
ricevitore o amplificatore AV
Il collegamento con un ricevitore o amplificatore AV
necessario per ottenere il suono surround di Dolby
separatamente)
acquistare
Cavo HDMI (da
Televisore Direzione di flusso del segnale Nel collegare o scollegare un cavo, far sempre presa
sulla spina.
Eanche possibile collegare un televisore al terminale Appoggiando oggetti su di una spina questa potrebbe
HDMI OUT (MAIN) attraverso un ricevitore o non far bene contatto e non emettere segnali video.
amplificatore AV. Vedere Collegamento con un ricevitore o
amplificatore AV nella colonna di destra.
Attenzione
Collegare un televisore sempre al terminale HDMI
OUT (MAIN), dato che quello HDMI OUT (SUB) non
emette segnali video.
Verificare di aver regolato HDMI Mode su Single
(pagina 41).
18
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 19 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
BDP-LX55
Attenzione 02
Pannello posteriore del BDP-LX55
Collegare un televisore sempre al terminale HDMI
OUT (MAIN), dato che quello HDMI OUT (SUB) non
emette segnali video.
Regolare HDMI Mode sempre su Separate
(pagina 41).
Se lamplificatore collegato al terminale HDMI OUT
(SUB) collegato anche ad un televisore, lingresso
Cavo HDMI (da del televisore potrebbe venire impostato
acquistare automaticamente. Se questo accade, disattivare la
separatamente)
funzione di controllo via HDMI del televisore.
di ingresso
Al terminale HDMI
Ricevitore o
Far corrispondere amplificatore AV BDP-440/BDP-140
la direzione della
spina al terminale Pannello posteriore del BDP-440
ed inserirla.
Ricevitore o
amplificatore AV
Far corrispondere
la direzione della
Direzione di flusso del segnale Al terminale spina al terminale
HDMI di ed inserirla.
Televisore ingresso
Ricevitore o
Per ottenere video ed audio di migliore qualit amplificatore AV
Per ottenere video ed audio di qualit superiore, collegare
separatamente)
acquistare
Cavo HDMI (da
Ricevitore o
Far corrispondere amplificatore AV
la direzione della
spina al terminale
ed inserirla.
Televisore
19
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 20 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Collegamento ad un
televisore con un cavo video/
Bianco
Cavo video/audio
audio Cavo audio digitale a
fibre ottiche
(accluso)
(da acquistarsi
separatamente)
Attenzione anche possibile
Al terminale di fare uso di audio
Collegare il terminale video del lettore ngresso audio digitale analogico a 2 canali.
a fibre ottiche
direttamente al televisore. Ai terminali di ingresso audio
Ricevitore o
Questo lettore supporta la tecnologia di protezione amplificatore
dalla copia analogica. Limmagine potrebbe quindi Direzione di flusso del segnale
AV
non venire visualizzata correttamente se si collega il
lettore ad un televisore passando per un registratore Nota
DVD/registratore video o se si riproduce il segnale di
uscita del lettore registrato direttamente dal Per poter attivare e disattivare il video del ricevitore o
registratore DVD/registratore video. Inoltre, amplificatore AV, collegare anche i terminali di uscita
limmagine potrebbe non venire visualizzata video.
correttamente a causa della protezione dalla
duplicazione se il lettore viene collegato ad un
televisore con videoregistratore incorporato. Per
Collegamento di
maggiori dettagli, entrare in contatto col fabbricante componenti alla porta
USB
del televisore.
Pannello posteriore del BDP-LX55
Nota
Televisore I dispositivi formattati con file system non fra quelli
elencati non sono utilizzabili. Tali dispositivi possono
per essere usati se riformattati col lettore.
Nota
I dispositivi di memoria di massa USB possono non
Se si usa un cavo video per i collegamenti del lettore, venire riconosciuti se contengono varie partizioni.
i segnali video vengono emessi con una risoluzione
Alcuni dispositivi di memoria di massa USB possono
480/576I or 480/576P.
non funzionare con questo lettore.
A seconda della risoluzione video di uscita impostata,
Il funzionamento dei dispositivi di memoria di massa
limmagine potrebbe non venire emessa.
20 USB non viene garantito.
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 21 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Router
LAN
3 2 1 WAN
PC
Dispositivo di
memoria di massa
21
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 22 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Internet
Cavo di alimentazione
(accluso) Ad una presa a
muro
Modem
WAN
22
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 23 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Capitolo 3 03
Come iniziare
Impostazioni con il 3 Avviare Setup Navigator.
Premere ENTER.
menu Setup Navigator Setup Navigator parte.
4 Scegliere la lingua dei messaggi sullo schermo.
Prima di usare il lettore nei casi seguenti, non mancare di
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
fare queste regolazioni.
Se un televisore flat screen Pioneer compatibile con
Al primo uso del lettore.
Control viene collegato al terminale HDMI OUT di questo
Dopo la formattazione di Initial Setup. lettore, le impostazioni della lingua vengono importate
Dopo aver aggiornato il software del lettore. dal televisore flat screen Pioneer prima che Setup
Navigator inizi.
Attenzione 5 Scegliere la risoluzione di uscita adatta al
Prima di accendere lapparecchio, controllare che i televisore collegato.
collegamenti fra il lettore e gli altri dispositivi siano Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
corretti. Inoltre, accendere i dispositivi collegati al 6 Scegliere il rapporto di forma adatto al televisore
lettore prima di accendere questultimo. collegato.
Se si usa un televisore flat screen o proiettore Pioneer Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
compatibile con la funzione Control, portare Control
7 Chiudere il menu Setup Navigator.
su On nel dispositivo collegato prima di accendere
Premere ENTER.
questo lettore.
Setup Navigator finisce e limpostazione viene
memorizzata.
Nota
Premere RETURN per tonare alla schermata
Se un televisore flat screen o proiettore Pioneer
compatibile con la funzione Control collegato al precedente.
lettore usando un cavo HDMI, il lettore si imposta da
s sulla qualit massima delle immagini di cui il
dispositivo capace.
23
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 24 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
PHILCO 32, 42
PHILIPS 31, 07, 34, 56, 68
SONOLOR 31, 35
SONTEC 07
03
PHOENIX 32 SONY 04
PHONOLA 07 SOUNDWAVE 07
PROFEX 42, 44 STANDARD 41, 44
PROTECH 07, 42, 44, 46, 49 STERN 31
QUELLE 31, 32, 07, 42, 45, 53 SUSUMU 41
R-LINE 07 SYSLINE 07
RADIOLA 07 TANDY 31, 41, 48
RADIOSHACK 10, 23, 21, 02 TASHIKO 34
RBM 53 TATUNG 07, 48
RCA 01, 10, 15, 16, 17, 18, 61, 62, TEC 42
09 TELEAVIA 36
REDIFFUSION 32, 42 TELEFUNKEN 36, 37, 52
REX 31, 46 TELETECH 44
ROADSTAR 41, 44, 46 TENSAI 40, 41
SABA 31, 36, 42, 51 THOMSON 36, 51, 52, 63
SAISHO 39, 44, 46 THORN 31, 07, 42, 45, 48
SALORA 31, 32, 42, 43 TOMASHI 18
SAMBERS 49 TOSHIBA 05, 02, 26, 21, 53
SAMSUNG 07, 38, 44, 46, 69, 70 TOWADA 42
SANYO 35, 45, 48, 21, 14, 91 ULTRAVOX 32, 42, 49
SBR 07, 34 UNIDEN 92
SCHAUB LORENZ 42 UNIVERSUM 31, 07, 38, 42, 45,
SCHNEIDER 07, 41, 47 46, 54
SEG 42, 46 VESTEL 07
SEI 32, 40, 49 VICTOR 13
SELECO 31, 42 VOXSON 31
SHARP 02, 19, 27, 67, 90 WALTHAM 43
SIAREM 32, 49 WATSON 07
SIEMENS 31 WATT RADIO 32, 42, 49
SINUDYNE 32, 39, 40, 49 WHITE WESTINGHOUSE 07
SKANTIC 43 YOKO 07, 42, 46
SOLAVOX 31 ZENITH 03, 20
SONOKO 07, 44
25
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 26 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
04 Capitolo 4
Riproduzione
Se viene caricato un BD con restrizioni alla
riproduzione determinate da un lettore BD, appare la
schermata di digitazione del codice PIN. In tal caso,
digitare il proprio codice PIN.
3 Premere PLAY per riprodurre il disco.
Per portare in pausa il lettore, premere PAUSE
durante la riproduzione.
Per fermare il lettore, premere STOP durante la
riproduzione.
Nota
Alcuni dischi iniziano la riproduzione automaticamente
quando il piatto portadisco viene richiuso.
I DVD-Video possiedono una caratteristica di
controllo genitori. Per sbloccare il controllo genitori,
digitare il password registrato nel lettore. Per dettagli,
vedi pagina 46.
26
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 27 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
28
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 29 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Nota
Il funzionamento dei dispositivi di memoria di massa
Audio/video primari Audio/video secondari
USB non viene garantito.
La riproduzione di dati BD-LIVE differisce a seconda
Il video secondario pu anche venire cambiato
del disco usato. Per dettagli, consultare le istruzioni
scegliendo Secondary Video dal menu FUNCTION.
per luso del disco.
Se il video secondario non cambia quando 2nd Per usare la funzione BD-LIVE sono necessarie una
VIDEO viene premuto, cambiarlo dalla schermata del connessione di rete e delle impostazioni (pagine 21 e
menu del disco. 44).
Disattivazione del video secondario BD-LIVE una funzione che permette la connessione
ad Internet. I dischi che supportano BD-LIVE possono
Premere 2nd VIDEO varie volte o scegliere mandare codici ID identificanti questo lettore ed il
Secondary Video dal menu FUNCTION per impostare disco a chi fornisce i contenuti via Internet.
il parametro su Off.
30
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 31 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Funzioni di riproduzione 04
Le funzioni utilizzabili che possono venire usate dipendono dal disco o file. In certi casi, alcune delle funzioni non
possono venire usate. Controllare le funzioni utilizzabili con la tabella che segue.
Tipo di disco/file
DVD-R
1
Funzione BD- BD-R DVD- DVD- /-RW File File di File CD
AVCREC AVCHD
ROM /-RE Video Audio2 (formato video immagine audio audio
VR)
Scansione in avanti
4
4
4
4
4 4 4 4 5 5
ed inversa3
Riproduzione di
titolo, capitoli e brani
particolari
Salto di contenuti
Rallentatore3,6 7
Passi in avanti ed
8
allindietro3
Riproduzione A-B
Repeat3
Riproduzione
ripetuta
Zoom
Angolazione 9
Sottotitoli 10
Audio11
Audio secondario 12
13
Video secondario14 15
Informazioni sul
disco
1. Alcune funzioni possono non funzionare per alcuni dischi o file anche contrassegnati con [] nella tabella.
2. Salvo il BDP-140.
3. Per alcuni dischi, la riproduzione normale riprende automaticamente quando il capitolo cambia.
4. Durante la scansione in avanti o allindietro non viene prodotto alcun suono.
5. Durante la scansione in avanti o allindietro viene prodotto del suono.
6. Durante la riproduzione al rallentatore non viene emesso alcun suono.
Non possibile cambiare la velocit durante la riproduzione al rallentatore inversa.
7. La riproduzione al rallentatore inversa non possibile.
8. La riproduzione a passi inversa non possibile.
9. Il simbolo di angolazione viene visualizzato per scene che contengono pi angolazioni se Angle Mark si trova su On (pagina 42).
10. I tipi di sottotitoli registrati dipendono dal disco e dal file.
In alcuni casi il sottotitolo pu cambiare o la schermata di scelta fornita dal disco potrebbe comparire immediatamente, senza che il
sottotitolo attuale o il numero totale di sottotitoli registrati sul disco vengano visualizzati.
11. I tipi di stream audio registrati dipendono dal disco e dal file.
12. I tipi di stream dellaudio secondario registrati dipendono dal disco e dal file.
In alcuni casi laudio secondario pu cambiare o la schermata di scelta fornita dal disco potrebbe comparire immediatamente, senza che
laudio secondario attuale o il numero totale di stream audio secondari registrati sul disco vengano visualizzati.
Il segno di audio secondario viene visualizzato per scene che possiedono un audio secondario se Secondary Audio Mark regolato su
On (pagina 42).
13. Alcuni dischi non possiedono audio secondario.
14. In alcuni casi il video secondario pu cambiare o la schermata di scelta fornita dal disco potrebbe comparire immediatamente, senza che
il video secondario attuale o il numero totale di piste video secondarie registrate sul disco vengano visualizzati.
Il segno di video secondario viene visualizzato per scene che possiedono un video secondario se PIP Mark regolato su On (pagina 42).
15. Alcuni dischi non possiedono video secondario.
31
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 32 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Riproduzione in ordine 04
casuale di una gamma
specifica di dischi, titoli o
capitoli (brani/file)
Sono utilizzabili due tipi di riproduzione casuale.
1 Scegliere Mode.
Usare / per scegliere, quindi premere ENTER.
2 Scegliere la modalit di riproduzione.
Usare / per scegliere, quindi premere ENTER.
Riproduzione casuale
La gamma specificata di dischi, titoli o capitoli (brani/file)
viene riprodotta in ordine casuale. Una stessa voce pu
venire riprodotta consecutivamente.
Riproduzione shuffle
La gamma specificata di dischi, titoli o capitoli (brani/file)
viene riprodotta in ordine casuale. Ciascuna voce viene
riprodotta solo una volta.
Continuazione della
riproduzione da una
posizione particolare
(Continued Viewing
Playback)
Questa funzione permette di riprendere la riproduzione
da una posizione precedentemente scelta, anche dopo
aver spento il lettore.
Impostazione
Premere il pulsante CONTINUED durante la
riproduzione nel punto da cui riprendere la
riproduzione.
Lo schermo del televisore visualizza il tempo trascorso
nella posizione specificata.
Riproduzione
1 Premere PLAY per riprodurre il titolo per cui si
impostata la ripresa della riproduzione.
La schermata FUNCTION appare automaticamente ad
indicare il punto (tempo) in cui si era premuto
CONTINUED.
La schermata di controllo Function pu anche essere
visualizzata premendo FUNCTION durante la
riproduzione.
2 Premere ENTER, poi scegliere il tempo di ripresa
della riproduzione.
La riproduzione inizia dal momento specificato.
Nota
Il tempo di ripresa della riproduzione viene cancellato
se si preme OPEN/CLOSE.
La ripresa della riproduzione video potrebbe non
funzionare correttamente con certi dischi. 33
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 34 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
05 Capitolo 5
Riproduzione con Home Media Gallery
Home Media Gallery permette la riproduzione dei
seguenti tipi di file:
Personal computer basati su Microsoft Windows
Vista o XP con Windows Media Player 11 installato
PC che usano Microsoft Windows 7 con Windows
Media Player 12 installato
Media server digitali DLNA compatibili (su
personal computer e altri componenti)
I file memorizzati in un PC o DMS (Digital Media
Server) come descritto sopra sono riproducibili con
Digital Media Player (DMP).
35
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 36 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Riproduzione in un
Riproduzione di dischi/
USB ordine desiderato
(Playlist)
1 Premere HOME MEDIA GALLERY per far
comparire Home Media Gallery. I dischi che permettono di aggiungere brani e file alla
Home Media Gallery appare anche scegliendo Home Playlist sono i seguenti.
Media Gallery dal Home Menu e premendo ENTER. DVD/CD/dispositivi di memoria di massa USB che
contengono file audio
2 Scegliere Disc o USB.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
Aggiunta di brani o file
3 Scegliere Photo/Music/Video/AVCHD.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER. Usare questa per aggiungere brani e file alla Playlist.
Questa fase non per dischi registrati col formato VR. 1 Premere HOME MEDIA GALLERY per far
comparire Home Media Gallery.
4 Scegliere il titolo/brano o file da riprodurre.
Home Media Gallery appare anche scegliendo Home
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
Media Gallery dal Home Menu e premendo ENTER.
La riproduzione inizia dal titolo/brano o file scelto.
2 Scegliere Disc o USB.
Se il file da riprodurre si trova in una cartella, per
Caricare un disco anticipatamente.
prima cosa scegliere tale cartella.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
3 Scegliere il brano/file da aggiungere.
Fare la selezione usando .
4 Premere POP UP MENU per far comparire la
schermata POP UP MENU.
5 Scegliere Add to Playlist per aggiungere elementi
alla Playlist.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
Il brano o file scelto nella fase 2 viene aggiunto alla
Playlist.
Per aggiungere altri brani o file, ripetere le fasi dalla 3
alla 5 .
36
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 37 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Cancellazione di brani/file da
Playlist
1 Scegliere il brano o file da cancellare e premere
POP UP MENU in modo da fare apparire il menu POP
UP MENU.
2 Usare / per scegliere Delete da Playlist, poi
premere ENTER.
37
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 38 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
06 Capitolo 6
Riproduzione di contenuti dal Web
Con questo lettore possibile riprodurre stream da
Internet. Riproduzione di voci
Contenuti dal Web
disponibili
YouTube (MPEG4 AVC H.264)
Picasa
Nota
A proposito di YouTube Attenzione
Sono riproducibili i video da YouTube delle seguenti Collegarsi prima di tutto a Internet. Vedere Collegamento
dimensioni. alla rete LAN via linterfaccia LAN a pagina 21 per i dettagli.
Qualit standard (400 x 226 pixel, 200 kbps)
1 Visualizzare la schermata di selezione.
Qualit media (480 x 360 pixel, 512 kbps) La schermata di selezione visualizzabile premendo
Qualit alta (854 x 480 pixel, 900 kbps) HOME MENU e quindi scegliendo Web Contents
HD (720p) (1280 x 720 pixel, 2 Mbps) Contenuto Web desiderato.
HD (1080p) (1920 x 1080 pixel, 4 Mbps) 2 Scegliere il tipo di contenuto Web.
Questo lettore supporta il servizio YouTube Leanback. Usare / per scegliere, quindi premere ENTER.
Youtube Leanback disponibile per il momento solo
in inglese. 3 Premere / per scegliere la voce da riprodurre
Per dettagli, consultare in proposito laiuto di YouTube e poi ENTER.
presso http://www.google.com/support/youtube/. Per fermare la riproduzione, premere EXIT. La
riproduzione video si ferma e la schermata Home Menu
I video di YouTube per telefoni portatili non sono riappare.
riproducibili.
Alcuni video di YouTube non sono riproducibili.
A proposito di Picasa
Picasa disponibile solo in inglese. Per dettagli in
proposito, consultare http://picasa.google.com/
support/.
Prima di fare uso di Picasa Web Albums, registrare
un nome utente e un password.
Quando si apre Picasa dal lettore per la prima volta,
scegliere una icona utente nuova e digitare il
proprio nome utente e password.
Capitolo 7 07
Impostazioni avanzate
Modifica delle Uso della schermata Initial
impostazioni Setup (Impostazione iniziale)
1 Far comparire la schermata Home Menu a
riproduzione ferma.
Premere HOME MENU.
2 Scegliere ed impostare Initial Setup.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
3 Scegliere una voce e modificarla.
Usare /// per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
Nota
Le voci selezionabili dipendono dallo stato operativo del lettore.
In Opzioni le impostazioni predefinite sono indicate in grassetto.
Impostazione Options Spiegazioni
Display Setting
TV Screen 16:9 Full Da scegliere per usare un televisore wide screen (16:9).
16:9 Normal Da scegliere per fare uso di un televisore wide screen (16:9). Eventuali immagini
4:3 vengono visualizzate con barre verticali sui lati.
4:3 Pan&Scan Da scegliere se si possiede un televisore 4:3 e si riproduce un video 16:9. Il video
viene riprodotto coi lati sinistro e destro tagliati per adattarlo allo schermo 4:3.
(Questa funzione utilizzabile se il disco etichettato 4:3PS.)
4:3 Letterbox Da scegliere se si possiede un televisore 4:3 e si riproduce un video 16:9. Il video
viene riprodotto con bande nere sopra e sotto.
Video Adjust La qualit delle immagini riprodotte regolabile a seconda del televisore usato (pagina 44).
Sharpness High Scegliere il livello di nitidezza.
(Salvo il BDP-LX55.) Middle
Low
Video Mode Standard Scegliere la modalit di uscita video.
(Salvo il BDP-LX55.) Vivid
Cinema
Custom
Noise Reduction 0 Scegliere il livello di riduzione del rumore.
(Salvo il BDP-LX55.) 1
2
3
39
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 40 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Digital Output Bitstream Da scegliere per emettere direttamente segnale audio digitale.
PCM Da scegliere per emettere segnale digitale audio convertito in segnali audio
PCM.
Re-encode Da scegliere per emettere segnale digitale audio convertito DTS Digital
Surround.
Off Da scegliere per emettere segnali audio che non siano digitali.
DTS Downmix (BDP-LX55) Stereo I segnali DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio o DTS Digital
Surround audio convertiti in segnali audio Linear PCM vengono a loro volta
convertiti in segnali audio a 2 canali (stereo) per poi essere emessi.
Lt/Rt I segnali DTS-HD Master Audio, quelli DTS-HD High Resolution Audio o DTS
Digital Surround audio convertiti in segnale audio Linear PCM audio vengono a
loro volta convertiti in segnali a 2 canali compatibili con il segnale Dolby
Surround in uscita (se il ricevitore o amplificatore AV ecc., compatibile con
Dolby Pro Logic, esso emette segnale audio Linear PCM come segnale audio
surround).
Downsampling 48k Da scegliere per riprodurre un disco registrato da una frequenza di
campionamento di 48 kHz.
96k Da scegliere per riprodurre un disco registrato da una frequenza di
campionamento di 96 kHz.
192k Da scegliere per riprodurre un disco registrato da una frequenza di
campionamento di 192 kHz.
DRC (Dynamic Range Off Da scegliere per emettere segnale audio senza usare la funzione DRC.
Control) On Da scegliere per regolare la gamma fra il suono pi forte e piu debole (gamma
* Sono supportati solo i dinamica) per la riproduzione a volume medio. Da usare se i dialoghi sono
segnali audio Dolby digitali difficili da sentire o si guardano film a notte fonda.
ed analogici.
Auto Da scegliere per attivare o disattivare limpostazione DRC a seconda del segnale
audio in ingresso dal disco.
40
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 41 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
HDMI Mode (BDP-LX55) Single Scegliere questo se un cavo HDMI collegato solo al terminale HDMI OUT (MAIN).
Separate Scegliere questo quando dei cavi HDMI sono collegati ad ambedue i terminali
HDMI OUT.
Pure Audio Scegliere questo per riprodurre solo musica con una qualit audio superiore quando dei
dispositivi sono collegati ad ambedue i terminali HDMI OUT. Con questa impostazione,
l'audio viene emesso dal solo terminale HDMI OUT (SUB), mentre il segnale video viene
emesso dal solo terminale HDMI OUT (MAIN) alla pressione di DISPLAY.
Consultare anche Impostazione della modalit HDMI Mode (solo BDP-LX55) a page 16.
Color Space RGB Da scegliere per emettere i segnali video sotto forma di segnali RGB. Usarlo se
i colori sembrano sbiaditi ed il nero troppo brillante.
YCbCr Da scegliere per emettere i segnali video sotto forma di segnali YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 422 Da scegliere per emettere i segnali video sotto forma di segnali YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB Da scegliere per emettere i segnali video sotto forma di segnali RGB. Usarlo se i
colori sembrano troppo saturi ed i toni scuri sono visualizzati con un nero uniforme.
Resolution Auto Da scegliere per determinare automaticamente la risoluzione dei segnali video
emessi dal terminale HDMI OUT.
480I/576I I segnali video vengono emessi dal terminale HDMI OUT con la risoluzione
scelta.
480P/576P
La risoluzione pu essere cambiata premendo HDMI, ma Auto non pu essere
720P scelto.
1080I
1080P
Con il BDP-LX55, nessun segnale video viene emesso dal terminale HDMI OUT (MAIN) se la risoluzione impostata 480I/576I.
HDMI Audio Out Bitstream Da scegliere per emettere direttamente segnale audio via HDMI.
PCM Da scegliere per emettere segnale audio HDMI convertito in segnali audio a 2 canali.
Re-encode Da scegliere per scegliere automaticamente il tipo di segnale audio.
Off Da scegliere se non si desidera emettere il segnale audio dal terminale di uscita HDMI.
Control On Da scegliere per controllare il lettore via il telecomando del dispositivo AV
collegato via cavo HDMI. Consultare anche pagina 16.
Off Da scegliere per non controllare il lettore via il telecomando del dispositivo AV
collegato via cavo HDMI.
Per fare uso di Sound Retriever Link, Stream Smoother Link e PQLS (pagine 16 e 17), Control deve trovarsi su On.
HDMI Deep color 30bits Da scegliere per emettere segnale video con colore a 30 bit.
36bits Da scegliere per emettere segnale video con colore a 36 bit.
Off Da scegliere per emettere segnale video con normale colore a 24 bit.
HDMI 1080P 24Hz On Da scegliere se Resolution regolato su Auto o 1080P e si mandano segnali
video 1080p/24 ad un televisore 1080p/24 compatibile.
Off Da scegliere se Resolution regolato su 1080P e si mandano segnali video
1080p/60 ad un televisore 1080p/60 compatibile.
HDMI 3D Auto Se un disco 3D, le immagini 3D vengono riprodotte.
Off Anche se un disco 3D, le immagini 3D vengono riprodotte.
3D notice Yes Questo determina se visualizzare o meno unavvertenza 3D durante la
riproduzione di immagini 3D.
No
Network
IP setting Da scegliere per impostare lindirizzo IP del lettore ed il server DNS (pagina 44).
Proxy Server Impostare il server proxy solo se questo viene richiesto dal provider dInternet (pagina 44).
Information Visualizza i valori dell'indirizzo MAC, indirizzo IP, subnet mask, default gateway, server DNS
(primario) e server DNS (secondario).
Connection test Da scegliere per testare la connessione di rete (pagina 45).
Internet Connection Enable Da scegliere per collegarsi ad Internet.
Disable Da scegliere per non collegarsi ad Internet.
BD-Live connection Permitted Tutti i dischi hanno il permesso di collegarsi a BD-LIVE.
Partial Permitted Solo i dischi la cui sicurezza stata confermata hanno il permesso di collegarsi
a BD-LIVE.
Prohibited Nessun disco ha il permesso di collegarsi a BD-LIVE.
DLNA Enable Da scegliere per collegarsi ad un server DLNA.
41
Disable Da scegliere per non collegarsi ad un server DLNA. It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 42 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
OSD lingue disponibili Scegliere per i messaggi sullo schermo una delle lingue elencate.
Audio lingue disponibili Scegliere una lingua fra quelle elencate per determinare la lingua audio
* Con alcuni dischi potrebbe predefinita di BD-ROM e DVD-Video.
non essere possibile
cambiare la lingua scelta.
Se si sceglie una lingua non presente sul BD/DVD, viene automaticamente scelta ed usata una delle lingue presenti.
Subtitle lingue disponibili Scegliere una lingua fra quelle elencate per determinare la lingua dei sottotitoli
* Con alcuni dischi potrebbe predefinita di BD-ROM e DVD-Video.
non essere possibile
cambiare la lingua scelta.
Se si sceglie una lingua non presente sul BD/DVD, viene automaticamente scelta ed usata una delle lingue presenti.
Menu lingue disponibili Scegliere una lingua fra quelle elencate per determinare la lingua dei menu
* Con alcuni dischi potrebbe predefinita di BD-ROM e DVD-Video.
non essere possibile
cambiare la lingua scelta.
Se si sceglie una lingua non presente sul BD/DVD, viene automaticamente scelta ed usata una delle lingue presenti.
Playback
Angle Mark On Da scegliere per visualizzare il simbolo di angolazione sullo schermo del
televisore (pagina 28). Questa limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-440/BDP-
140.
Off Da scegliere per non visualizzare il simbolo di angolazione sullo schermo del
televisore. Questa limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-LX55.
PIP Mark On Da scegliere per visualizzare il simbolo PIP sullo schermo del televisore. Questa
limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Da scegliere per non visualizzare il simbolo PIP sullo schermo del televisore.
Questa limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-LX55.
Secondary Audio Mark On Da scegliere per visualizzare il simbolo di audio secondario sullo schermo del
televisore (pagina 29). Questa limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-440/BDP-
140.
Off Da scegliere per no visualizzare il simbolo di audio secondario sullo schermo del
televisore. Questa limpostazione predefinita per i BDP-LX55.
DivX(R) VOD DRM Registration Code Visualizza il codice di registrazione del lettore richiesto per riprodurre file DivX
VOD (pagina 10).
DVD Playback DVD AUDIO Da scegliere per riprodurre la parte audio di dischi DVD-Audio.
* Questa impostazione per DVD VIDEO Da scegliere per riprodurre la parte video di dischi DVD-Audio.
la riproduzione di dischi
DVD-Audio. (Salvo il BDP-
140.)
Internet Setting Permitted I contenuti Web possono venire visti senza digitare un password.
Partial Permitted Il password deve venire digitato per poter vedere contenuti Web.
Prohibited La visione di contenuti Web proibita.
Disc Auto Playback On I dischi vengono riprodotti automaticamente dopo che sono stati caricati.
Off I dischi caricati non vengono riprodotti automaticamente.
Last Memory On Da scegliere per memorizzare il punto in cui lultima riproduzione stata
interrotta anche dopo lapertura del piatto portadischi o il passaggio alla
modalit di standby.
Off Da scegliere per usare solo Continue Viewing Play (pagina 33).
PBC (Play Back Control) On Da scegliere per riprodurre Video-CD (versione 2.0) compatibili con PBC usando
il menu del disco.
Off Da scegliere per riprodurre Video-CD (versione 2.0) compatibili con PBC senza
usare il menu del disco.
Setup Navigator Permette di fare le impostazioni con il menu Setup Navigator. Per dettagli, vedi pagina 23.
Security
Change Password Registrare (cambiare) il password per le impostazioni di controllo genitori o per sbloccare la
riproduzione di DVD-Video che possiedono il controllo genitori (pagina 45).
Parental Control Permette di cambiare il livello di controllo genitori del lettore (pagina 46).
Country Code Permette di cambiare il codice di paese/area (pagina 46).
42
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 43 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
43
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 44 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Nota
Nel caso del BDP-LX55, limpostazione Video Adjust
non influenza i segnali video dei terminali VIDEO
OUTPUT.
44
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 45 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
45
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 46 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
2 Digitare il password.
Premere i pulsanti numerici (da 0 a 9) per digitare il Attenzione
numero e premere ENTER per finalizzare loperazione. Non scollegare il cavo di alimentazione o togliere il
Usare / per spostare il cursore. dispositivo di memoria di massa USB/disco durante
laggiornamento. Altrimenti, laggiornamento viene
3 Modificare il livello. interrotto e il lettore si pu guastare.
Usare / per cambiare, poi premere ENTER per
Laggiornamento si divide un due parti, il download e
finalizzare loperazione.
laggiornamento vero e proprio. Ambedue richiedono
un certo tempo.
Nota Durante laggiornamento le altre funzioni non sono
Il livello pu venire cambiato in Off o Level1 e Level8. possibili. Laggiornamento inoltre non cancellabile.
Se si imposta Off, la visione non ha limitazioni. Per il BDP-LX55/BDP-440, se il display del pannello
anteriore spento, accenderlo con FL DIMMER. Se si
Modifica del codice di paese/area aggiorna il software del lettore con il display del
pannello anteriore spento, non scollegare il cavo di
1 Scegliere ed impostare Security Country Code alimentazione fino a che lunit si spegne.
Next Screen.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER. Aggiornamento via Internet
2 Digitare il password.
Premere i pulsanti numerici (da 0 a 9) per digitare il Nota
numero e premere ENTER per finalizzare loperazione.
A seconda del collegamento con Internet, il download
Usare / per spostare il cursore. pu richiedere molto tempo.
3 Permette di cambiare il codice di paese/area. Le fasi 1 e 5 sono eseguite dallutente (per scaricare il
Usare / per cambiare, poi premere ENTER per software da Internet).
finalizzare loperazione. Vedere pagina 48. Le fasi da 6 a 8 sono eseguite automaticamente dal
lettore (per aggiornare il software).
1 Collegarsi ad Internet.
2 Far comparire la schermata Home Menu a
riproduzione ferma.
Premere HOME MENU.
3 Scegliere ed impostare Initial Setup.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
4 Scegliere ed impostare Options Update
Network Start.
Usare / per scegliere, poi premere ENTER.
46
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 47 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
48
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 49 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Capitolo 8 08
Informazioni aggiuntive
Avvertenza INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms
except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright
del software
ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES form of a textual message at program startup or in
WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA documentation (online or textual) provided with the
OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, package.
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or
Le licenze del software open source OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR without modification, are permitted provided that the
usato da questo lettore appaiono di PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. following conditions are met:
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
seguito. Per motivi di precisione, qui holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
sono stati inclusi i testi originali (in promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software disclaimer.
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
inglese). above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
jpeg following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
curl This software is based in part on the work of the materials provided with the distribution.
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE independent JPEG Group. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
Copyright 1996 - 2007, Daniel Stenberg, this software must display the following
<[email protected]>. All rights reserved. openssl acknowledgement:
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the "This product includes cryptographic software written
software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby conditions of the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word
granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this license apply to the toolkit. 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the
permission notice appear in all copies. See below for the actual license texts. Actually both library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
THE SOF TWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" , WI THOUT licenses are BSD-style Open Source licenses. In case of any 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, license issues related to OpenSSL please contact openssl- derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF [email protected]. code) you must include an acknowledgement:
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL License "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights ([email protected])"
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR reserved. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS''
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN without modification, are permitted provided that the INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING following conditions are met: WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
SOFTWARE. disclaimer. LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. materials provided with the distribution. OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
expat this software must display the following IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software acknowledgment: NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
Center Ltd "This product includes software developed by the OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:/ THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
obtaining a copy of this software and associated /www.openssl.org/)" The licence and distribution terms for any publically
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" available version or derivative of this code cannot be
without restriction, including without limitation the rights must not be used to endorse or promote products changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, derived from this software without prior written under another distribution licence [including the GNU
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to permission. For written permission, please contact Public Licence.]
[email protected].
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the
following conditions: 5. Products derived from this software may not be called zlib
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names This software is based in part on zlib see http://www.zlib.net
be included in all copies or substantial portions of the without prior written permission of the OpenSSL for information.
Software. Project.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the GNU General Public License and
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, following acknowledgment: GNU Lesser General Public License
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF "This product includes software developed by the
This product includes the following software licensed for
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://
use under the terms of GNU General
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. www.openssl.org/)"
Public License v2, GNU Lesser General Public License v2.1.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL
linux kernel 2.6. Copyright (C) 1991 Linus Torvalds.
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED
Licensed under GPLv2.0
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
BusyBox v1.17.1 multi-call binary. Copyright (C) 1998-
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
2009 Erik Andersen, Rob Landley, Denys Vlasenko and
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
others. Licensed under GPLv2.0
USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL
SquashFS Copyright: (C) 2002-2009 Phillip Lougher
PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
freetype DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
Licensed under GPL v2.0
Das U-Boot Copyright: (C) 2000-2005 Wolfang Denk,
This software is based in part on freetype see http:// OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
DENX Software Engineering, [email protected]. Licensed
www.freetype.org for information. LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
under GPL v2.0
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
LIRC 0.8.5 Copyright (C) 1996 Ralph Metzler
International Components for BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
<[email protected]> Copyright (C) 1998-2008
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
Unicode STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
Christoph Bartelmus <[email protected]> Licensed
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later under GPL v2.0
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE glibc 2.9 Copyright (C) 1992-2006, 2007 Free Software
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
Copyright (c) 1995-2010 International Business Machines Foundation, Inc. Licensed under LGPL v2.1.
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Corporation and others You can get corresponding open source code from the
This product includes cryptographic software written by
All rights reserved. following URL.
Eric Young ([email protected]). This product includes
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person http://www.oss-pioneer.com/homeav/blu-ray
software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
obtaining a copy of this software and associated Please refer to the following URL for further information of
Original SSLeay License
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software GNU General Public License Version 2.
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected])
without restriction, including without limitation the rights http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl-2.0.html
All rights reserved.
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell Please refer to the following URL for further information of
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the GNU Library General Public License Version 2.1.
Young ([email protected]).
Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
The implementation was written so as to conform with
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all Netscapes SSL.
copies of the Software and that both the above copyright GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting Version 2, June 1991
as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
following conditions apply to all code found in this
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA 49
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 50 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim ordinary way, to print or display an announcement (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
08 copies of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
including an appropriate copyright notice and a
notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
Preamble you provide a warranty) and that users may cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your
The licenses for most software are designed to take away redistribute the program under these conditions, and obligations under this License and any other pertinent
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU telling the user how to view a copy of this License. obligations, then as a consequence you may not
General Public License is intended to guarantee your (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure does not normally print such an announcement, your license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of
the software is free for all its users. This General Public work based on the Program is not required to print an the Program by all those who receive copies directly or
License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's announcement.) indirectly through you, then the only way you could
software and to any other program whose authors commit These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the entirely from distribution of the Program.
is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License Program, and can be reasonably considered independent If any portion of this section is held invalid or
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. and separate works in themselves, then this License, and unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
When we speak of free software, we are referring to its terms, do not apply to those sections when you balance of the section is intended to apply and the
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute section as a whole is intended to apply in other
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based circumstances.
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get the terms of this License, whose permissions for other infringe any patents or other property right claims or to
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and contest validity of any such claims; this section has the
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you every part regardless of who wrote it. sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
can do these things. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or software distribution system, which is implemented by
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, public license practices. Many people have made
forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution generous contributions to the wide range of software
surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain of derivative or collective works based on the Program. distributed through that system in reliance on
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on consistent application of that system; it is up to the
software, or if you modify it. the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium distribute software through any other system and a
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all does not bring the other work under the scope of this licensee cannot impose that choice.
the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, License. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what
receive or can get the source code. And you must show 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
them these terms so they know their rights. based on it, under Section 2) in object code or License.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal above provided that you also do one of the following: restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to machine-readable source code, which must be who places the Program under this License may add an
make certain that everyone understands that there is no distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
warranty for this free software. If the software is modified on a medium customarily used for software those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to interchange; or, or among countries not thus excluded. In such case,
know that what they have is not the original, so that any b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least this License incorporates the limitation as if written in
problems introduced by others will not reflect on the three years, to give any third party, for a charge no the body of this License.
original authors' reputations. more than your cost of physically performing source 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of or new versions of the General Public License from time
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that the corresponding source code, to be distributed to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a present version, but may differ in detail to address new
patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. medium customarily used for software interchange; problems or concerns.
To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must or, Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. c) Accompany it with the information you received as to If the Program specifies a version number of this
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution the offer to distribute corresponding source code. License which applies to it and "any later version", you
and modification follow. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial have the option of following the terms and conditions
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE distribution and only if you received the program in either of that version or of any later version published by
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION object code or executable form with such an offer, in the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not
AND MODIFICATION accord with Subsection b above.) specify a version number of this License, you may
0. This License applies to any program or other work The source code for a work means the preferred form of the choose any version ever published by the Free Software
which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder work for making modifications to it. For an executable Foundation.
saying it may be distributed under the terms of this work, complete source code means all the source code for 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to all modules it contains, plus any associated interface other free programs whose distribution conditions are
any such program or work, and a "work based on the definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
Program" means either the Program or any derivative and installation of the executable. However, as a special software which is copyrighted by the Free Software
work under copyright law: that is to say, a work exception, the source code distributed need not include Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we
containing the Program or a portion of it, either anything that is normally distributed (in either source or sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included and so on) of the operating system on which the executable of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting
without limitation in the term "modification".) Each runs, unless that component itself accompanies the the sharing and reuse of software generally.
licensee is addressed as "you". executable. NO WARRANTY
Activities other than copying, distribution and If distribution of executable or object code is made by 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF
modification are not covered by this License; they are offering access to copy from a designated place, then CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
restricted, and the output from the Program is covered same place counts as distribution of the source code, even APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE
only if its contents constitute a work based on the though third parties are not compelled to copy the source STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
Program (independent of having been made by running along with the object code. OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
Program does. Program except as expressly provided under this EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Program's source code as you receive it, in any sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
medium, provided that you conspicuously and automatically terminate your rights under this License. PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate However, parties who have received copies, or rights, QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact from you under this License will not have their licenses WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
all the notices that refer to this License and to the terminated so long as such parties remain in full DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients compliance. NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
of the Program a copy of this License along with the 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
Program. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring permission to modify or distribute the Program or its COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM
protection in exchange for a fee. you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or or distributing the Program (or any work based on the DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that distributing or modifying the Program or works based PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS
you also meet all of these conditions: on it. OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent 6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES
notices stating that you changed the files and the based on the Program), the recipient automatically OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
date of any change. receives a license from the original licensor to copy, ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived and conditions. You may not impose any further POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
terms of this License. compliance by third parties to this License. If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the
50 c) If the modified program normally reads commands
interactively when run, you must cause it, when
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation
of patent infringement or for any other reason (not
greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve
this is to make it free software which everyone can
It started running for such interactive use in the most limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you redistribute and change under these terms.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 51 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we depends on what the Library does and what the
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most
effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file
copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license,
which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or
program that uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
08
should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to modify the library. Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any
where the full notice is found. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear medium, provided that you conspicuously and
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
of what it does.> library is modified by someone else and passed on, the copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> recipients should know that what they have is not the all the notices that refer to this License and to the
This program is free software; you can redistribute it original version, so that the original author's reputation will absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General not be affected by problems that might be introduced by License along with the Library.
Public License as published by the Free Software others. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty
option) any later version. existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that protection in exchange for a fee.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library,
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license and copy and distribute such modifications or work
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you
Public License for more details. the full freedom of use specified in this license. also meet all of these conditions:
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
Public License along with this program; if not, write to the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain notices stating that you changed the files and the
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary date of any change.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic General Public License. We use this license for certain c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed
and paper mail. libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non- at no charge to all third parties under the terms of
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice free programs. this License.
like this when it starts in an interactive mode: When a program is linked with a library, whether statically d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of or using a shared library, the combination of the two is or a table of data to be supplied by an application
author legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the program that uses the facility, other than as an
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO original library. The ordinary General Public License argument passed when the facility is invoked, then
WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. therefore permits such linking only if the entire you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in
This is free software, and you are welcome to combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General the event an application does not supply such
redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other function or table, the facility still operates, and
for details. code with the library. performs whatever part of its purpose remains
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License meaningful.
show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the (For example, a function in a library to compute
Of course, the commands you use may be called ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could software developers Less of an advantage over competing defined independent of the application. Therefore,
even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
program. use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. function or table used by this function must be
You should also get your employer (if you work as a However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain optional: if the application does not supply it, the
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright special circumstances. square root function must still compute square
disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special roots.)
alter the names: need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain These requirements apply to the modified work as a
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
the program this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) A more frequent case is that a free library does the same considered independent and separate works in
written by James Hacker. job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989 little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, apply to those sections when you distribute them as
Ty Coon, President of Vice so we use the Lesser General Public License. separate works. But when you distribute the same
This General Public License does not permit incorporating In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non- sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
your program into proprietary programs. If your program is free programs enables a greater number of people to use a Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the
a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to large body of free software. For example, permission to use terms of this License, whose permissions for other
permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each
this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Public License instead of this License. well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLICLICENSE protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
Version 2.1, February 1999 user of a program that is linked with the Library has the distribution of derivative or collective works based on
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a the Library.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA modified version of the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
copies of this license document, but changing it is not and modification follow. Pay close attention to the based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
allowed. difference between a "work based on the library" and a distribution medium does not bring the other work
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also "work that uses the library". The former contains code under the scope of this License.
counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, derived from the library, whereas the latter must be 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU
version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] combined with the library in order to run. General Public License instead of this License to a given
Preamble GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the
The licenses for most software are designed to take away TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU AND MODIFICATION ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure or other program which contains a notice placed by the the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared,
the software is free for all its users. copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may then you can specify that version instead if you wish.)
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Do not make any other change in these notices.
some specially designated software packages--typically Public License (also called "this License"). Each Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other licensee is addressed as "you". irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we A "library" means a collection of software functions and/ Public License applies to all subsequent copies and
suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with derivative works made from that copy.
or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy application programs (which use some of those This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations functions and data) to form executables. code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
below. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
When we speak of free software, we are referring to or work which has been distributed under these terms. derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are A "work based on the Library" means either the Library executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, above provided that you accompany it with the
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either complete corresponding machine-readable source
service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get verbatim or with modifications and/or translated code, which must be distributed under the terms of
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed translation is included without limitation in the term for software interchange.
that you can do these things. "modification".) If distribution of object code is made by offering access
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of to copy from a designated place, then offering
forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to the work for making modifications to it. For a library, equivalent access to copy the source code from the
surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to complete source code means all the source code for all same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the modules it contains, plus any associated interface source code, even though third parties are not
library or if you modify it. definition files, plus the scripts used to control compelled to copy the source along with the object
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether compilation and installation of the library. code.
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights Activities other than copying, distribution and 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of
that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, modification are not covered by this License; they are the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code outside its scope. The act of running a program using being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that
with the library, you must provide complete object files to the Library is not restricted, and output from such a uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library
after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And
program is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Library (independent of the use of the
derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside
the scope of this License.
51
you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 52 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the and explaining where to find the accompanying WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
08 Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the
Library (because it contains portions of the Library),
uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
rather than a "work that uses the library". The distribute the Library except as expressly provided IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
executable is therefore covered by this License. Section under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
6 states terms for distribution of such executables. modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from void, and will automatically terminate your rights under RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
a header file that is part of the Library, the object code this License. However, parties who have received THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even copies, or rights, from you under this License will not PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is have their licenses terminated so long as such parties NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
especially significant if the work can be linked without remain in full compliance. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, permission to modify or distribute the Library or its MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY
data structure layouts and accessors, and small derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, or distributing the Library (or any work based on the INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
(Executables containing this object code plus portions do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) distributing or modifying the Library or works based on DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you it. LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
may distribute the object code for the work under the 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that based on the Library), the recipient automatically OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are receives a license from the original licensor to copy, OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
linked directly with the Library itself. distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also these terms and conditions. You may not impose any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
Library to produce a work containing portions of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making
choice, provided that the terms permit modification of 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation it free software that everyone can redistribute and change.
the work for the customer's own use and reverse of patent infringement or for any other reason (not You can do so by permitting redistribution under these
engineering for debugging such modifications. limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that General Public License).
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library contradict the conditions of this License, they do not To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the
and its use are covered by this License. You must excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
supply a copy of this License. If the work during cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
execution displays copyright notices, you must include obligations under this License and any other pertinent each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well obligations, then as a consequence you may not pointer to where the full notice is found.
as a reference directing the user to the copy of this distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of
License. Also, you must do one of these things: license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of what it does.>
a) Accompany the work with the complete the Library by all those who receive copies directly or Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
corresponding machine-readable source code for the indirectly through you, then the only way you could This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/
Library including whatever changes were used in the satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 entirely from distribution of the Library. Public
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked If any portion of this section is held invalid or License as published by the Free Software Foundation;
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or balance of the section is intended to apply, and the later version.
source code, so that the user can modify the Library section as a whole is intended to apply in other This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
and then relink to produce a modified executable circumstances. useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
containing the modified Library. (It is understood It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS
that the user who changes the contents of definitions infringe any patents or other property right claims or to FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser
files in the Library will not necessarily be able to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the General Public License for more details.
recompile the application to use the modified sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
definitions.) software distribution system which is implemented by General Public License along with this library; if not,
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking public license practices. Many people have made write to the Free Software
with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) generous contributions to the wide range of software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston,
uses at run time a copy of the library already present distributed through that system in reliance on MA 02110-1301 USA
on the user's computer system, rather than copying consistent application of that system; it is up to the Also add information on how to contact you by electronic
library functions into the executable, and (2) will author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to and paper mail.
operate properly with a modified version of the library, distribute software through any other system and a You should also get your employer (if you work as a
if the user installs one, as long as the modified licensee cannot impose that choice. programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright
version is interface-compatible with the version that This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
the work was made with. is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this alter the names:
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in
least three years, to give the same user the materials 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted by James Random Hacker.
more than the cost of performing this distribution. interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access Library under this License may add an explicit Ty Coon, President of Vice
to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent geographical distribution limitation excluding those That's all there is to it!
access to copy the above specified materials from the countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
same place. among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of License incorporates the limitation as if written in the
these materials or that you have already sent this body of this License.
user a copy. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
For an executable, the required form of the "work that or new versions of the Lesser General Public License
uses the Library" must include any data and utility from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
programs needed for reproducing the executable from spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be address new problems or concerns.
distributed need not include anything that is normally Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the If the Library specifies a version number of this License
major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the which applies to it and "any later version", you have the
operating system on which the executable runs, unless option of following the terms and conditions either of
that component itself accompanies the executable. that version or of any later version published by the Free
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do license version number, you may choose any version
not normally accompany the operating system. Such a ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other
Library together in an executable that you distribute. free programs whose distribution conditions are
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
the Library side-by-side in a single library together with permission. For software which is copyrighted by the
other library facilities not covered by this License, and Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software
distribute such a combined library, provided that the Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
separate distribution of the work based on the Library Our decision will be guided by the two goals of
and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
and provided that you do these two things: software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the software generally.
same work based on the Library, uncombined with NO WARRANTY
any other library facilities. This must be distributed 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
52 under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of
CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
It the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 53 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
53
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 54 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Non incollare carta o adesivi sul disco, e non usare una Non usare benzina, diluente o altre sostanze chimiche
08 matita, una penna a sfera o un altro utensile appuntito volatili. Evitare inoltre gli spray per dischi analogici o
per scrivervi sopra. Essi possono danneggiare il disco. antistatici.
Per lo sporco tenace, applicare acqua ad un panno
morbido, strizzarlo bene, pulir via lo sporco ad asciugare
con un panno asciutto.
Diagnostica
Luso scorretto dellapparecchio viene spesso scambiato per un guasto. Se si ritiene che questo componente non
funzioni bene, controllare la sezione che segue. A volte il problema risiede in un altro componente. Controllare tutti i
componenti ed apparecchi elettronici usati. Se il problema non pu venire eliminato neppure dopo aver fatto i controlli
suggeriti, chiedere assistenza tecnica al pi vicino centro assistenza o rivenditore autorizzato Pioneer.
Riproduzione
Problema Controllare Rimedio
Il disco non viene Il disco riproducibile con Controllare se il disco riproducibile con questo lettore (pagina 7).
riprodotto. questo lettore?
Il piatto portadisco si apre Il file riproducibile con Controllare se il file riproducibile con questo lettore (pagina 10).
automaticamente. questo lettore? Controllare se il file danneggiato o meno.
Il disco graffiato? Pu non esser possibile riprodurre dischi graffiati.
Il disco sporco? Pulire il disco (sopra).
Al disco aderiscono etichette Il disco potrebbe essere deformato e non riproducibile.
o adesivi?
Il disco caricato Caricare il disco col lato stampato rivolto in alto.
correttamente nel piatto Caricare il disco correttamente nellincavo del piatto portadisco.
portadisco?
Il numero di regione Vedere pagina 9 per i numeri di regione dei dischi che possono essere
corretto? riprodotti con questo lettore.
54
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 55 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Funzione Control 08
Problema Controllare Rimedio
La funzione di controllo non Il cavo HDMI collegato Per usare la funzione di controllo, collegare un televisore flat screen ed
funziona. correttamente? il sistema AV (ricevitore o amplificatore AV, ecc.) al terminale HDMI
OUT (pagina 15).
Il cavo HDMI usato un High Usare un High Speed HDMI Cable. La funzione Control potrebbe non
Speed HDMI Cable? funzionare bene se il cavo non un High Speed HDMI Cable.
Si collegato il lettore al Se dei segnali video vengono emessi da un terminale diverso dal
televisore utilizzando un cavo terminale HDMI OUT, la funzione Control non funziona. Collegarsi al
HDMI per guardare il video? televisore usando un cavo HDMI (pagina 15).
Per il BDP-LX55: Se ambedue i terminali HDMI OUT (MAIN e SUB) sono in uso, la
HDMI Mode regolato funzione di controllo agisce solo su quello HDMI OUT (SUB)
correttamente? (pagina 16).
Control del lettore regolato Regolare Control del lettore su On (pagina 41).
su On?
Il dispositivo collegato La funzione Control non funziona con dispositivi di altre marche che
supporta la funzione Control? non la supportano, anche se si usa un cavo HDMI.
La funzione Control non funziona se dei dispositivi che non la
supportano vengono collegati fra dispositivi compatibili con Control ed
il lettore.
Vedere pagina 16.
Alcune funzioni possono non funzionare anche se si collegati ad un
prodotto Control compatibile.
Consultare anche le istruzioni per luso del dispositivo collegato.
La funzione Control del Regolare la funzione Control del dispositivo collegato su On. La
dispositivo collegato su On? funzione Control attivata quando Control viene attivato per tutti i
dispositivi collegati al terminale HDMI OUT.
Una volta che i collegamenti e le impostazioni di tutti i televisori sono
finiti, controllare che limmagine del lettore venga emessa dal TV Flat-
Screen. (Controllare anche dopo aver cambiato i dispositivi collegati ed
aver scollegato o collegato i cavi HDMI.) Se limmagine del lettore non
viene emessa dal TV flat screen, la funzione Control potrebbe non
funzionare correttamente.
Per maggiori dettagli, consultare anche le istruzioni per luso del
dispositivo collegato.
Avete collegati pi lettori? La funzione Control potrebbe non funzionare se tre lettori o pi,
compreso questo, vengono collegati via cavo HDMI.
Network
Problema Controllare Rimedio
La funzione BD-LIVE Eseguire loperazione Connection Test (pagina 45). Se appare
(collegamento ad Internet) Networks is OK., controllare le impostazioni del server proxy
non pu venire usata. (pagina 44). Potrebbe anche esserci un problema con il collegamento
Se si tenta laggiornamento a Internet. Entrare in contatto col proprio provider Internet.
del software, appare il
messaggio No valid id file
found!.
Laggiornamento del Il tempo richiesto per laggiornamento del software dipende dalla
software dura a lungo. velocit del collegamento a Internet ed altri fattori.
57
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 58 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Altri problemi
Problema Controllare Rimedio
Il lettore si spegne Auto Power Off regolato Se Auto Power Off regolato su 10 min/20 min/30 min,
automaticamente. su 10 min/20 min/30 min? lapparecchio si spegne automaticamente se nessuna operazione
viene eseguita per oltre 30 minuti (pagina 43).
Il lettore si accende Control regolato su On? Il lettore pu accendersi insieme al televisore collegato al terminale
automaticamente. HDMI OUT. Se non si desidera che il lettore si accenda insieme al
televisore, portare Control su Off (pagina 41).
Il lettore non controllabile Si usa il telecomando da un Usare il telecomando entro 7 m dal sensore di telecomando.
col telecomando. punto troppo lontano dal
lettore?
Le batterie sono scariche? Sostituire le batterie (pagina 5).
Lingresso del televisore e del Control regolato su On? Gli ingressi del televisore e del sistema AV (ricevitore o amplificatore
sistema AV collegati cambia AV, ecc.) collegati al terminale HDMI OUT potrebbero
automaticamente. automaticamente lasciare il posto a quello del lettore quando questo
inizia la riproduzione o la schermata del menu (Home Media Gallery o
altro) visualizzata. Se non si desidera che lingresso del televisore o
sistema AV (ricevitore o amplificatore AV, ecc.) AV venga sostituito
automaticamente da unaltro, portare Control su Off (pagina 41).
Le impostazioni che avevo Avete scollegato il cavo di Prima di scollegare il cavo di alimentazione, premere sempre
fatto sono state cancellate. alimentazione a lettore STANDBY/ON del pannello anteriore del lettore o STANDBY/ON
acceso? del telecomando e controllare che POWER OFF del pannello anteriore
C stata una caduta di del lettore sia spento. Fare attenzione in particolare quando il cavo di
tensione? alimentazione collegato ad una presa di corrente di un altro
componente, perch il lettore si accende e spegne insieme ad esso.
58
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 59 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Default Gateway
Angolazione (angolazioni multiple)
Un default gateway un dispositivo di comunicazione, ad
Un BD-ROM o DVD-Video pu contenere fino a 9 angolazioni
esempio un router, che mette in comunicazione reti differenti.
delle riprese, fra le quali potete scegliere quella voluta.
Viene usato per mandare dati a reti che non specificano un
gateway di destinazione particolare.
Audio interattivo
I segnali audio registrati nei titoli di un BD-ROM. Includono ad DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
esempio i suoni di interfaccia prodotti durante luso dei menu.
Protocol)
Audio secondario Questo protocollo fornisce parametri di configurazione (indirizzo
IP, ecc.) per computer ed altri dispositivi collegati alla rete.
Alcuni BD-ROM includono stream audio secondari insieme allo
stream audio principale. Questi stream audio secondari vengono
chiamati audio secondario. In certi dischi laudio secondario
DivX
laudio del video secondario. Vedere pagina 10.
BONUSVIEW 59
Vedere pagina 8. It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 60 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Linear PCM
Questo termine indica che i segnali audio non sono stati
compressi.
Numero di porta
Un indirizzo secondario fornito dopo lindirizzo IP per il
collegamento simultaneo di varie entit durante la
comunicazione via Internet.
60 Numero di regione
Vedere pagina 9.
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_IT.book Page 61 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:35 AM
Dati tecnici 08
Modello BDP-LX55
BDP-440
BDP-140
Tipo RIPRODUTTORE di Blu-ray 3D
Voltaggio nominale CA da 100 V a 240 V
Frequenza nominale 50 Hz/60 Hz
Consumo di corrente BDP-LX55: 25 W
BDP-440, BDP-140: 23 W
Consumo di corrente (in attesa) 0,3 W
Peso BDP-LX55: 3,5 kg
BDP-440: 2,6 kg
BDP-140: 2,1 kg
Dimensioni esterne (comprese proiezioni) BDP-LX55: 435 mm (L) x 93 mm (A) x 252 mm (P)
BDP-440: 435 mm (L) x 90 mm (A) x 252 mm (P)
BDP-140: 435 mm (L) x 58 mm (A) x 249 mm (P)
Temperature di funzionamento tollerabili Da +5 C a +35 C
Umidit di funzionamento tollerabile Da 5 % a 85 % (senza condensa)
Terminali di uscita
Nota
I dati tecnici ed il design di questo prodotto sono soggetti a modifiche senza preavviso.
2011 PIONEER CORPORATION. Tutti i diritti riservati.
61
It
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 2 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
+DUWHOLMNGDQNYRRUXZDDQNRRSYDQGLW3LRQHHUSURGXFW
/HHVGH]HJHEUXLNVDDQZLM]LQJDDQGDFKWLJGRRURPEHNHQGWHUDNHQPHWGHMXLVWHEHGLHQLQJYDQXZDSSDUDDW1DKHW
GRRUOH]HQYDQGHJHEUXLNVDDQZLM]LQJGLHQWXGH]HWHEHZDUHQRSHHQYHLOLJHSODDWVYRRUODWHUHQDVODJ
BELANGRIJK
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
2 verlichting).
D3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_Nl
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 3 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Indien u zich in een ander dan bovengenoemde landen bevindt kunt u contact
opnemen met de plaatselijke overheid voor meer informatie over de juiste verwijdering
Pb van het product.
K058a_A1_Nl
7AARSCHUWINGENBIJHETBEKIJKENVAN$
BEELDEN
p !LSUMOEWORDTOFZICHNIETGOEDVOELTBIJHETKIJKENNAAR$
BEELDENMOETUSTOPPENMETHETKIJKENNAAR$
BEELDEN
p +INDERENINHETBIJZONDERKLEINEKINDERENJONGERDANKUNNENGEVOELIGERZIJNVOORDEZEEFFECTENENDAAROMMOETENDE
VOORDEZEKINDERENVERANTWOORDELIJKEPERSONENGOEDLETTENOPTEKENENVANVERMOEIDHEIDOFONGEMAK
p .EEMREGELMATIGRUSTWANNEERUNAAR$
BEELDENKIJKT
,ANGDURIGKIJKENNAAR$
BEELDENZONDERRUSTPAUZESKANLEIDENTOTVERMOEIDHEIDOFONGEMAK
3
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 4 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Inhoud
01 Voordat u begint Gebruik van het FUNCTION menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Inhoud van de doos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Afspelen vanaf een specifiek tijdstip
Aanbrengen van de batterijen in de (Tijdzoekfunctie) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
afstandsbediening. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Afspelen van een bepaalde titel, hoofdstuk of
Software-update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 muziekstuk (Zoekfunctie) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Over de bediening van deze speler via mobiele Willekeurige weergave van een bepaald gedeelte
apparatuur (iPod, iPhone, iPad enz.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 van een disc, of bepaalde titels of hoofdstukken
Soorten discs/bestanden die kunnen worden (muziekstukken/bestanden). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
afgespeeld . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Hervatten van de weergave vanaf een bepaalde
Afspeelbare discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 positie (hervatten weergave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Afspeelbare bestanden. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 05 Afspelen via de Home Media Gallery
Namen van onderdelen en hun functies . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Over de Home Media Gallery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Afstandsbediening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Over afspelen via het netwerk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Voorpaneel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 DLNA Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Achterpaneel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Afspelen van disc/USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
02 Aansluitingen Weergeven van beeldbestanden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Aansluiten via een HDMI-kabel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Afspelen in de gewenste volgorde (Playlist) . . . . . . . . . 36
Over HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Toevoegen van muziekstukken/bestanden . . . . . . . . . 36
Over de HDMI-bedieningsfunctie . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Afspelen van de Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Een TV-toestel aansluiten . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Wissen van muziekstukken/bestanden uit de
Aansluiten van een AV-receiver of versterker . . . . . . . 18 Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Aansluiten van video- en audiokabels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 06 Afspelen van materiaal van het web
Aansluiten op een TV met een audio/video-kabel. . . . 20 geschikt materiaal van het web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Aansluiten op een AV-receiver of versterker via Afspelen van de gewenste onderdelen . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
een optisch digitale audiokabel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Aansluiten van apparatuur op de USB-poort . . . . . . . . 20
07 Geavanceerde instellingen
Wijzigen van de instellingen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Over USB-geheugenapparaten . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Bediening van het begin-instellingenscherm. . . . . . . 39
Aansluiten van het USB-geheugenapparaat . . . . . . . 21
Software bijwerken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Aansluiten op het netwerk via de LAN-interface. . . . . . 21
Alle instellingen terugstellen op de oorspronkelijke
Verbinden met een draadloos LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
fabrieksinstellingen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Aansluiten van het netsnoer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Taalcodetabel en land/gebiedscodetabel . . . . . . . . . . 48
03 Aan de slag 08 Aanvullende informatie
Instellingen via het Setup Navigator menu . . . . . . . . . . 23 Kennisgeving softwarelicentie . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Bediening van de TV met de afstandsbediening Voorzorgen bij het gebruik . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
van de speler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Verplaatsen van de speler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Lijst met TV voorkeuzecodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Geschikte opstelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
04 Afspelen Schakel de speler uit wanneer u het toestel niet
Afspelen van discs of bestanden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 gebruikt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Vooruit en terug zoeken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Condensatie. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Afspelen van bepaalde hoofdstukken of Reinigen van de speler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
muziekstukken. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Waarschuwing wanneer het toestel staat opgesteld
Delen van de inhoud overslaan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 in een audiorek met een glazen deurtje . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Vertraagde weergave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Reinigen van de lens. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Stapsgewijze vooruit en terug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Behandeling van de discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Meermalen afspelen van een bepaalde passage in Verhelpen van storingen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
een titel of muziekstuk (A-B herhalen) . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Afspelen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Meermalen afspelen (Herhaalde weergave) . . . . . . . . 27 HDMI-bedieningsfunctie . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Afspelen in de gewenste volgorde Netwerk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
(Programma-weergave) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Overige . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Bladwijzers maken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Woordenlijst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Zoom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Technische gegevens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Miniatuurweergaven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Omschakelen van de camerahoek . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Omschakelen van de ondertiteling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Disc-informatie weergeven. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Omschakelen van de primaire en secundaire
audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Overschakelen naar secundaire video . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Genieten van BONUSVIEW of BD-LIVE . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
4 Afspeelfuncties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 5 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Hoofdstuk 1 01
Voordat u begint
Inhoud van de doos WAARSCHUWING
Batterijen mogen niet in direct zonlicht of op een erg
Afstandsbediening x 1 warme plaats, zoals in de buurt van een verwarming
Audio/video-kabel (rode/witte/gele stekkers) x 1 of in een auto die in de zon staat, gebruikt of
opgeborgen worden. Dit kan namelijk resulteren in
AAA/R03 batterijen x 2 lekkage, oververhitting, exploderen of in brand vliegen
Garantiekaart van de batterijen. Bovendien kan dit de levensduur
Netsnoer van de batterijen of de prestaties ervan verminderen.
Handleiding (dit document)
Waarschuwing
Aanbrengen van de Gebruik geen andere dan de voorgeschreven
batterijen in de batterijen. Gebruik ook nooit oude en nieuwe
batterijen door elkaar.
afstandsbediening Leg de batterijen in de afstandsbediening in de juiste
richting, zoals aangegeven door de polariteitstekens
1 Open het achterdeksel. ( en ).
Probeer niet om de batterijen te verhitten, open te
maken, of in het vuur of in het water te gooien.
Batterijen kunnen verschillende spanning leveren,
ook als ze er hetzelfde uitzien. Gebruik geen
Druk dit punt licht in
en schuif het deksel verschillende soorten batterijen door elkaar.
in de richting van de Verwijder de batterijen als u de afstandsbediening
pijl.
langere tijd (een maand of langer) niet zult gebruiken,
om schade door eventuele batterijlekkage te
2 Doe de batterijen in het vak (AAA/R03 x 2). voorkomen. Als er batterijvloeistof is gelekt, veegt u
Volg bij het inleggen de /-markeringen binnenin het de binnenkant van het batterijvak dan zorgvuldig
batterijvak. schoon, voordat u nieuwe batterijen plaatst. Als een
batterij lek is en de vloeistof komt op uw huid, wast u
het er dan grondig af met volop water.
Bij het inleveren of terugbrengen van gebruikte
Leg het negatieve batterijen dient u altijd de landelijke milieuwetten en
() uiteinde eerst in. voorschriften van plaatselijke instanties op te volgen.
5
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 6 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
01 Software-update
Productinformatie over deze speler kunt u vinden op de
Pioneer website. Kijk op onze website voor informatie
over updates en serviceberichten betreffende uw Blu-ray
Disc Speler.
In Europa:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
In het V.K.:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer.co.uk/
In Rusland:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer-rus.ru/
In Hong Kong:
http://www.pioneerhongkong.com.hk/
In Singapore:
http://www.pioneer.com.sg/firmwaredownload
In Australi:
http://www.pioneer.com.au/
6
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 7 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Waarschuwing
Alleen correct afgesloten discs kunnen worden afgespeeld.
Geschikt formaat
Disc-type Beeldmerk DVD- DVD- CD-DA DATA-
BDMV BDAV DVD VR
Video Audio DTS-CD DISC1
BD-ROM
BD-R
BD2
BD-RE
DVD-ROM 3
DVD
DVD-R2,4,5 6 7
DVD-RW4,8 6 7
DVD+R2,4
DVD+RW4
CD-DA
(Audio CD)9
CD
CD-R4
CD-RW4
CD-ROM
1. Discs waarop video, afbeeldingen of audiobestanden zijn vastgelegd. Deze speler is niet geschikt voor multisessie-discs of multiborder-opnamen.
2. Inclusief dubbellaags discs.
3. Alleen voor de BDP-LX55 en BDP-440.
4. Deze moeten zijn afgesloten om ze in deze disc-speler te kunnen afspelen.
5. DVD-R Authoring-discs voor cursussen e.d. (3,95 of 4,7 GB) kunnen niet worden afgespeeld.
6. Inclusief het AVCHD-formaat.
7. Inclusief het AVCREC-formaat.
8. Versie 1.0 DVD-RW discs kunnen niet worden afgespeeld.
9. Inclusief Video CDs.
7
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 8 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Blu-ray Disc, Blu-ray en het Blu-ray Disc-logo zijn Afspelen van Blu-ray discs
01 handelsmerken van de Blu-ray Disc Association.
Blu-ray discs (BDMV) die geschikt zijn voor de
is een handelsmerk van DVD Format/Logo volgende formaten kunnen worden afgespeeld.
Namen van bedrijven en producten die hierin worden Blu-ray Disc Opneembaar (R) Formaat Versie 2
vermeld zijn handelsmerken of gedeponeerde Blu-ray Disc Herschrijfbaar (RE) Formaat Versie 3
handelsmerken van hun respectievelijke eigenaren.
Deze speler ondersteunt het BD-ROM Profiel 5.
Discs die niet kunnen worden
afgespeeld
HD DVDs
DVD-RAM discs
Het is mogelijk dat bepaalde andere discs dan de Blu-ray 3D en het Blu-ray 3D logo zijn
bovengenoemde ook niet kunnen worden afgespeeld. handelsmerken van de Blu-ray Disc Association.
Over audioformaten
Deze speler is geschikt voor de volgende audioformaten:
BONUSVIEW is een handelsmerk van de Blu-ray Disc
Dolby TrueHD Association.
Dolby Digital Plus
BD-LIVE functies, zoals het downloaden van
Dolby Digital
speelfilm-trailers, extra geluidssporen, ondertiteling
DTS-HD Master Audio in andere talen of het spelen van online-videospellen,
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio zijn mogelijk via het Internet. De gegevens die worden
DTS Digital Surround gebruikt voor de BD-LIVE functie (filmtrailers, enz.)
worden vastgelegd in het opslagmedium. Zie de
MPEG audio (AAC) handleiding van de disc voor nadere details over de
Lineaire PCM BD-LIVE functies.
Om te genieten van de surround-sound die wordt
geboden door Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD
Master Audio en DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, is het
aanbevolen de disc-speler met behulp van een HDMI-
kabel aan te sluiten op een AV-receiver of versterker die
geschikt is voor die audioformaten. Na het laden van een Het BD-LIVE beeldmerk is een handelsmerk van de
Blu-ray disc die een van de genoemde audioformaten Blu-ray Disc Association.
bevat, kiest u het formaat via het menuscherm.
Gefabriceerd onder licentie van Dolby Laboratories. Dolby
en het symbool double-D zijn handelsmerken van Dolby
Laboratories.
Geproduceerd in licentie onder VS patent nrs. 5,956,674;
5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,392,195; 7,272,567;
7,333,929; 7,212,872 & andere octrooien in de V.S. en
wereldwijd, verleend & aangevraagd. DTS-HD, het Symbool,
& DTS-HD en het Symbool samen zijn gedeponeerde
handelsmerken & DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential is een
handelsmerk van DTS, Inc. Product bevat software. DTS,
Inc. Alle rechten voorbehouden.
8
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 9 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
9
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 10 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
MKV
MKV-bestanden kunnen worden weergegeven.
Namen van 01
MKV is een bestandsformaat dat meerdere audio- onderdelen en hun
en videobestanden in een enkel bestand toestaat.
De volgende bestanden kunnen worden
functies
weergegeven:
Resolutie: Tot 1 280 x 720
Extensie: .mkv of .MKV
Afstandsbediening
Windows Media Video (WMV)
19
Windows Media Video (WMV) bestanden kunnen
1 20
worden weergegeven.
2
De volgende bestanden kunnen worden
weergegeven:
Resolutie: Tot 1 280 x 720
3 21
Extensie: wmv of WMV
Er wordt ondersteuning geboden aan bestanden
die gecodeerd zijn met de Windows Media
22
Encoder 9 serie.
4 23
Windows Media is een gedeponeerd handelsmerk
5 24
of een handelsmerk van Microsoft Corporation in
de Verenigde Staten en/of in andere landen. 6 25
Dit product bevat technologie die het eigendom is 7
van Microsoft Corporation en die niet gebruikt of 8 26
gedistribueerd mag worden zonder toestemming
van Microsoft Licensing, Inc.
9
Geschikte beeldbestandsformaten
10 27
JPEG
Progressieve JPEG
28
Bestandsformaat: JFIF versie 1.02/Exif versie 2.2
Resolutie: Tot 4 096 x 4 096 pixels 11 29
12
30
13
Geschikte audiobestandsformaten 14 31
Windows Media Audio 9 (WMA9) 32
Bitsnelheid: tot 192 kbps 15 33
Bemonsteringsfrequenties: 22,05 kHz, 32 kHz, 34
44,1 kHz en 48 kHz 35
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3) 16 36
Bitsnelheid: tot 320 kbps 17 37
Bemonsteringsfrequenties: 8 kHz, 11,025 kHz, 12 kHz, 18 38
16 kHz, 22,05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz en 48 kHz
Free Lossless Audio Codec (FLAC) (Alleen voor de
BDP-LX55)
Bemonsteringsfrequenties: 96 kHz tot 192 kHz
Kwantisering-bitrate: 16 bits, 24 bits
Kanalen: 2 kanalen 1 STANDBY/ON Druk hierop om de stroom in of
uit te schakelen.
Extensies van afspeelbare 2 CONTINUED Hiermee kunt u de weergave
bestanden voortzetten vanaf een bepaalde plek. (pagina 33)
Videobestanden 3 TV CONTROL (pagina 24)
.divx, .mkv, .wmv en .avi
Beeldbestanden 4 AUDIO (pagina 29)
.jpg en .jpeg
Audiobestanden
.wma en .mp3
.flac (alleen voor de BDP-LX55)
11
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 12 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
5 FL DIMMER 24 HDMI
01 BDP-LX55, BDP-440 Met elke druk op deze toets BDP-LX55 Hiermee kunt u de HDMI Mode
verandert de helderheid van het display op het omschakelen (paginas 16 en 41).
voorpaneel en/of de verlichting van de aanduidingen BDP-440/BDP-140 Hiermee kunt u de resolutie
op het voorpaneel zoals staat aangegeven in de tabel instellen van de videosignalen die worden geproduceerd
hieronder. door de HDMI OUT-aansluiting (pagina 41).
Indicators 25 EXIT (pagina 38)
Voorpaneel- Blu-ray PQLS FL OFF
display (Alleen voor 26 POP UP MENU/MENU Druk hierop om de BD-ROM
de BDP-LX55) of DVD-Video menus te openen.
Helder Gaat branden Gaat branden Uit
27 RETURN Druk op deze toets om naar het vorige
Midden Gaat branden Gaat branden Uit scherm terug te keren.
Donker Gaat branden Gaat branden Uit
28 Kleurtoetsen Gebruik deze toetsen om door de BD-
Uit Uit Uit Gaat branden ROM menus te navigeren.
BDP-140 Met elke druk op deze toets verandert de PROGRAM (pagina 28)
helderheid van het display op het voorpaneel (in 4 BOOK MARK (pagina 28)
stappen). ZOOM (pagina 28)
CD/SACD INDEX (pagina 28)
Druk voor hybride discs op deze toets om heen en
29 FWD (pagina 27)
weer te schakelen tussen de CD-laag en de SACD-
laag. 30 // (pagina 27)
6 TOP MENU Druk hierop om het hoofdmenu van de 31 STOP (pagina 26)
BD-ROM of DVD-Video te openen.
32 2nd VIDEO (pagina 30)
7 FUNCTION (pagina 32)
33 2nd AUDIO (pagina 29)
8 HOME MEDIA GALLERY (pagina 34)
34 A-B (pagina 27)
9 /// Hiermee kunt u onderdelen en
instellingen selecteren en wijzigen en de cursor 35 ENTER Druk hierop om de gekozen functie uit te
verplaatsen. voeren of een gewijzigde instelling e.d. vast te leggen.
ENTER Druk hierop om de gekozen functie uit te
36 REPEAT (pagina 27)
voeren of een gewijzigde instelling e.d. vast te leggen.
37 SKIP SEARCH Druk hierop om 30 seconden vooruit
10 HOME MENU (pagina 39) te springen wanneer er tijdens weergave op SKIP
SEARCH wordt gedrukt.
11 REV (pagina 27)
38 REPLAY Druk hierop om 10 seconden terug te
12 PLAY (pagina 26)
springen wanneer er tijdens weergave op REPLAY
13 // (pagina 27) wordt gedrukt.
Voorpaneel 01
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-140
1 3 4 6 8 9 10 11
13
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 14 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
01 Achterpaneel
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 5 6 8
BDP-140
3 4 2 1 5 6 8
Opmerking
Er kan geen videosignaal worden geproduceerd via de SUB-aansluiting. Verbind uw televisie daarom met de MAIN-
aansluiting.
14
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 15 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Hoofdstuk 2 02
Aansluitingen
Schakel altijd eerst de stroom uit en trek de stekker uit het Dit toestel is geschikt voor x.v.Color-producten die een
stopcontact voor u aansluitingen maakt of verbreekt. breed-spectrum kleurbereik bieden, volgens de xvYCC-
Na het aansluiten maakt u alle instellingen in het Setup specificaties.
Navigator- of Initial Setup-menu overeenkomstig het Bij weergave van videosignalen volgens de xvYCC-
type kabel dat u hebt aangesloten (pagina 23). normen met deze speler wanneer deze is aangesloten op
een x.v.Color-geschikt TV-toestel e.d. worden de
Zie tevens de handleiding van het apparaat dat u aansluit. mogelijkheden voor kleurweergave sterk uitgebreid,
hetgeen de natuurlijke kleurweergave ten goede komt.
Opmerking x.v.Color is de commercile naam voor de producten die
een breed-spectrum kleurbereik bieden, volgens
De gebruikte afbeeldingen geven hoofdzakelijk de
voorschriften van de internationale xvYCC-norm.
BDP-LX55 weer.
15
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 16 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
17
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 18 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Waarschuwing
Pak de stekker vast voor het aansluiten of losmaken
van de kabel.
Als er iets tegen de stekker aan drukt, kan dat een
verkrijgbaar)
(in de handel
HDMI-kabel
slecht contact veroorzaken, zodat er geen Houd de stekker in de
videosignalen doorkomen. juiste stand voor de
aansluitbus en steek
hem er recht in.
BDP-LX55 Naar de
HDMI-ingang Het is ook mogelijk om een AV-receiver
Verbind een televisie met de HDMI OUT (MAIN) of versterker e.d. aan te sluiten met een
HDMI-kabel (hieronder).
aansluiting.
Achterpaneel van de BDP-LX55
TV Richting van de signaalstroom
Waarschuwing
U moet een televisie verbinden met de HDMI OUT
(MAIN) aansluiting, videosignalen kunnen niet
worden geproduceerd via de HDMI OUT (SUB)
aansluiting.
Zet HDMI Mode op Single (pagina 41).
18
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 19 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
BDP-LX55
Waarschuwing 02
Achterpaneel van de BDP-LX55
U moet een televisie verbinden met de HDMI OUT
(MAIN) aansluiting, videosignalen kunnen niet
worden geproduceerd via de HDMI OUT (SUB)
aansluiting.
U moet HDMI Mode instellen op Separate
(pagina 41).
Als de AV-versterker die is verbonden met de HDMI
HDMI-kabel OUT (SUB) aansluiting ook is aangesloten op een
(in de handel
verkrijgbaar)
televisie, is het mogelijk dat het ingangskanaal van de
televisie automatisch wordt omgeschakeld. Als dit
ingang
Naar de HDMI-
HDMI-kabel
(in de handel
verkrijgbaar)
ingang
Naar de HDMI-
AV-receiver
Houd de stekker in of versterker
de juiste stand voor
de aansluitbus en
steek hem er recht
in.
TV
19
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 20 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Router
LAN
3 2 1 WAN
PC
USB-
geheugenapparaat
LAN-kabel
(los verkrijgbaar)
Achterpaneel van de BDP-LX55 Verbind de LAN-aansluiting van deze speler met de LAN-
aansluiting van uw router (met of zonder ingebouwde
DHCP-serverfunctie) met behulp van een straight LAN-
kabel (CAT 5 of hoger).
Schakel de DHCP-serverfunctie van de router in. Als de
router niet is uitgerust met een ingebouwde DHCP-
serverfunctie moet u de netwerkinstellingen handmatig
maken. Zie Instellen van het IP-adres op pagina 44 voor
details.
USB-
geheugenapparaat
Specificaties van de LAN-
aansluiting
Opmerking LAN-aansluiting: Ethernet-aansluiting (10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX)
Hat is mogelijk dat apparaten niet werken als ze zijn
aangesloten op de USB-poort via een Opmerking
geheugenkaartlezer of een USB-verdeelstekker (hub).
Raadpleeg de handleiding van de apparatuur die u
gebruikt voor uw verbinding en let erop dat de
aansluitmethode mede afhangt van uw
internetomgeving.
Wanneer u een breedband internetverbinding wilt
gebruiken, heeft u een overeenkomst met een
internet service provider nodig. Neem voor meer
informatie contact op met uw plaatselijke internet
service provider.
21
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 22 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Internet
Modem
LAN/USB-voedingskabel
(meegeleverd met de AS-WL300) Router
WAN
Draadloze LAN-adapter
(AS-WL300) DC 5V Ethernet WPS
22
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 23 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Hoofdstuk 3 03
Aan de slag
Instellingen via het 3 Start Setup Navigator.
Druk op ENTER.
Setup Navigator menu Setup Navigator zal nu opstarten.
4 Kies de taal voor de aanduidingen op het scherm.
U moet deze instellingen maken wanneer u de speler
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
gebruikt in de volgende situaties.
ENTER.
Wanneer u de speler voor het eerst gaat gebruiken.
Als u een Pioneer Flat Screen TV die geschikt is voor de
Na een Initial Setup formattering. HDMI-bedieningsfunctie hebt aangesloten op de HDMI
Na het updaten van de software van de speler. OUT-aansluiting van deze speler, zullen de
taalinstellingen worden overgenomen van de Pioneer Flat
Screen TV voordat het de Setup Navigator opstart.
Waarschuwing
Voor u de stroom inschakelt, moet u eerst controleren 5 Selecteer de juiste uitgangsresolutie voor de
of alle aansluitingen tussen de speler en de andere aangesloten TV.
apparatuur in orde zijn. Schakel ook eerst de stroom Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
in voor de apparaten die zijn aangesloten op de ENTER.
speler, voor u de speler zelf inschakelt. 6 Selecteer de juiste beeldverhouding voor de
Bij gebruik van een Pioneer Flat Screen TV of een aangesloten TV.
projectie-TV die geschikt is voor de Control-functie, Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
zet u op het aangesloten apparaat de Control-functie ENTER.
aan voor u de speler inschakelt.
7 Sluit het Setup Navigator menu.
Druk op ENTER.
Opmerking De Setup Navigator wordt afgesloten en de
Wanneer er een Pioneer Flat Screen TV of een instellingen worden opgeslagen.
projectie-TV die geschikt is voor de Control-functie is
Druk op RETURN als u terug wilt naar het vorige
aangesloten op de speler via een HDMI-kabel, wordt
de speler automatisch ingesteld op de optimale scherm.
beeldkwaliteit voor de aangesloten apparatuur.
23
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 24 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
24
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 25 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
PHILCO 32, 42
PHILIPS 31, 07, 34, 56, 68
SONOLOR 31, 35
SONTEC 07
03
PHOENIX 32 SONY 04
PHONOLA 07 SOUNDWAVE 07
PROFEX 42, 44 STANDARD 41, 44
PROTECH 07, 42, 44, 46, 49 STERN 31
QUELLE 31, 32, 07, 42, 45, 53 SUSUMU 41
R-LINE 07 SYSLINE 07
RADIOLA 07 TANDY 31, 41, 48
RADIOSHACK 10, 23, 21, 02 TASHIKO 34
RBM 53 TATUNG 07, 48
RCA 01, 10, 15, 16, 17, 18, 61, 62, TEC 42
09 TELEAVIA 36
REDIFFUSION 32, 42 TELEFUNKEN 36, 37, 52
REX 31, 46 TELETECH 44
ROADSTAR 41, 44, 46 TENSAI 40, 41
SABA 31, 36, 42, 51 THOMSON 36, 51, 52, 63
SAISHO 39, 44, 46 THORN 31, 07, 42, 45, 48
SALORA 31, 32, 42, 43 TOMASHI 18
SAMBERS 49 TOSHIBA 05, 02, 26, 21, 53
SAMSUNG 07, 38, 44, 46, 69, 70 TOWADA 42
SANYO 35, 45, 48, 21, 14, 91 ULTRAVOX 32, 42, 49
SBR 07, 34 UNIDEN 92
SCHAUB LORENZ 42 UNIVERSUM 31, 07, 38, 42, 45,
SCHNEIDER 07, 41, 47 46, 54
SEG 42, 46 VESTEL 07
SEI 32, 40, 49 VICTOR 13
SELECO 31, 42 VOXSON 31
SHARP 02, 19, 27, 67, 90 WALTHAM 43
SIAREM 32, 49 WATSON 07
SIEMENS 31 WATT RADIO 32, 42, 49
SINUDYNE 32, 39, 40, 49 WHITE WESTINGHOUSE 07
SKANTIC 43 YOKO 07, 42, 46
SOLAVOX 31 ZENITH 03, 20
SONOKO 07, 44
25
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 26 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
04 Hoofdstuk 4
Afspelen
Wanneer er een BD met door een BD-recorder
ingestelde gebruiksbeperkingen in het toestel wordt
gedaan, zal het invoerscherm voor de PIN-code
verschijnen. Voer in een dergelijk geval uw PIN-code in.
3 Druk op PLAY om het afspelen van de disc te
starten.
Om te pauzeren, drukt u tijdens het afspelen op
PAUSE.
Om te stoppen, drukt u tijdens het afspelen op
STOP.
Opmerking
Bij sommige discs zal het afspelen automatisch
beginnen zodra de disclade wordt gesloten.
DVD-Videodiscs zijn voorzien van kinderslotfuncties.
Om het kinderslot te ontgrendelen, voert u het
wachtwoord in dat in de instellingen van de speler is
vastgelegd. Zie pagina 46 voor verdere informatie.
26
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 27 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Delen van de inhoud overslaan Wanneer u gaat zoeken buiten de herhaalde passage.
Wanneer u een andere herhaalfunctie of
willekeurige weergave start.
Druk tijdens afspelen op of .
Wanneer u op drukt, springt de weergave direct
door naar het begin van de volgende hoofdstuk/
Meermalen afspelen
muziekstuk/bestand. (Herhaalde weergave)
Wanneer u op drukt terwijl er een video- of Ga als volgt te werk om de weergegeven disc, titel,
audiobestand wordt weergegeven, springt de hoofdstuk, muziekstuk of bestand meermalen af te spelen.
weergave terug naar het begin van de huidige
hoofdstuk/muziekstuk/bestand. Druk tweemaal om Druk tijdens het afspelen op REPEAT.
terug te keren naar het begin van de voorgaande Met elke druk op REPEAT zal het soort herhaalde
hoofdstuk/muziekstuk/bestand. weergave als volgt veranderen.
Wanneer u op drukt terwijl er een beeldbestand BD
wordt weergegeven, springt de weergave terug naar Huidige hoofdstuk Huidige titel
het vorige bestand. DVD
Huidige hoofdstuk Huidige titel Alle titels
Vertraagde weergave CD/Videobestand/Audiobestand/Beeldbestand
Huidige muziekstuk/bestand Alle titels
Houd terwijl het afspelen is gepauzeerd de /
of / toets ingedrukt. Uitschakelen van de herhaalde
De snelheid wordt omgeschakeld bij elke druk op de weergave
toets (de snelheid wordt op het TV-scherm getoond).
Druk tijdens herhaalde weergave een paar keer op
Terugkeren naar de normale REPEAT.
weergave
Opmerking
Druk op PLAY. De herhaalfunctie wordt uitgeschakeld in de
volgende gevallen:
Stapsgewijze vooruit en terug Wanneer u gaat zoeken buiten de herhaalde
passage.
Met het afspelen gepauzeerd, drukt u op / Wanneer u een andere herhaalfunctie of
of /. willekeurige weergave start.
Het beeld gaat dan een stapje vooruit of terug bij elke
druk op de toets.
28
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 29 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Opmerking
Waarschuwing
Afhankelijk van het bestand kunnen de externe
De ondertiteling kan niet worden omgeschakeld voor ondertitels niet altijd goed worden weergegeven.
discs die zijn opgenomen met een DVD- of Blu-ray
Disc-informatie weergeven
recorder. Zie tevens de handleiding van het apparaat
dat u gebruikt voor het opnemen.
Druk tijdens het afspelen op SUBTITLE.
De huidige ondertiteling en het totale aantal Druk op DISPLAY.
opgenomen ondertitels wordt getoond op het TV- De disc-informatie verschijnt op het TV-scherm. Druk nog
scherm. eens op DISPLAY om de weergave van de informatie weer
Om de ondertiteling om te schakelen, drukt u uit te schakelen.
nogmaals op SUBTITLE. De getoonde informatie verschilt tijdens afspelen en in de
De ondertiteling is ook om te schakelen door Subtitle stopstand.
te selecteren in het FUNCTION menu.
Als de ondertiteling niet wordt omgeschakeld Omschakelen van de
wanneer u op SUBTITLE drukt, kunt u proberen om te
schakelen via het menuscherm van de disc. primaire en secundaire audio
Uitschakelen van de ondertiteling Bij discs en bestanden waarvoor meerdere
audiosignalen/kanalen zijn opgenomen, kunt u tijdens
Druk een paar keer op SUBTITLE of selecteer het afspelen het audiosignaal/kanaal omschakelen. Ga
Subtitle van het FUNCTION menu om de instelling net zo te werk voor omschakelen naar de secundaire
Off (uit) te schakelen. audio bij BD-ROM-discs waarop secundaire audio is
opgenomen.
Over de weergave van externe Druk tijdens het afspelen op AUDIO/2nd AUDIO.
De huidige audio en het totale aantal opgenomen
ondertitelingsbestanden tijdens het audiosignalen/kanalen wordt getoond op het TV-
afspelen van DivX-mediabestanden scherm.
Naast de ondertitels die zijn opgenomen in DivX- Om de audio om te schakelen, drukt u nogmaals op
mediabestanden, kan deze speler ook externe AUDIO/2nd AUDIO.
ondertitelingsbestanden weergeven. Als een bestand Het primaire/secundaire audiosignaal is ook om te
dezelfde naam heeft als een DivX-mediabestand, afgezien schakelen door keuze van Audio of Secondary
van de extensie, en die extensie is er n uit de
onderstaande lijst, dan wordt dat bestand behandeld als Audio in het FUNCTION menu.
extern ondertitelingsbestand. Overigens moeten de DivX- Als het primaire/secundaire audiosignaal niet wordt
mediabestanden en de externe ondertitelingsbestanden omgeschakeld wanneer u op AUDIO/2nd AUDIO
zich wel in dezelfde map bevinden.
Er kan slechts n extern ondertitelingsbestand tegelijk drukt, schakelt u dan om via het menuscherm van de
worden weergegeven met deze speler. Gebruik een disc zelf.
computer o.i.d. om alle externe ondertitelingsbestanden
die u niet wilt laten weergeven van de disc te verwijderen. Uitschakelen van de secundaire
.srt, .sub, .txt, .smi, .ssa, .ass audio
Als er een taalcode is gekozen voor het externe
ondertitelingsbestand, worden de ondertitels weergegeven Druk een paar keer op 2nd AUDIO of selecteer
in het lettertype dat overeenkomt met de gekozen taalcode. Secondary Audio van het FUNCTION menu om de
Als er geen taalcode is gekozen, worden de ondertitels
weergegeven in het lettertype dat overeenkomt met de instelling Off (uit) te schakelen.
taalcode die is ingesteld bij Ondertiteltaal (pagina 42).
Hetzelfde lettertype wordt gebruikt voor alle talen in elk van
de onderstaande groepen.
Groep 1 Afrikaans(af/afr), Baskisch(eu/eus), Catalaans(ca/cat),
Deens(da/dan), Nederlands(nl/nld), Engels(en/eng),
Faerors(fo/fao), Fins(fi/fin), Frans(fr/fra), Galicisch(gl/
glg), Duits(de/deu), Guarani(gn/grn), IJslands(is/isl),
Iers(ga/gle), Italiaans(it/ita), Latijn(la/lat), Noors(no/nor),
Portugees(pt/por), Reto-Romaans(rm/roh), Schots-
Gaelisch(gd/gla), Spaans(es/spa), Swahili(sw/swa),
Zweeds(sv/swe), Zoeloe(zu/zul)
Groep 2 Albanees(sq/sqi), Kroatisch(hr/hrv), Tsjechisch(cs/ces),
Hongaars(hu/hun), Pools(pl/pol), Roemeens(ro/ron), 29
Slowaaks(sk/slk), Sloveens(sl/slv)
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 30 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Opmerking
Primaire audio/video Secundaire audio/video
De werking van USB-geheugenapparaten kan niet
De secundaire video kan ook worden omgeschakeld worden gegarandeerd.
door Secondary Video te selecteren in het
De weergave van BD-LIVE gegevens hangt mede af
FUNCTION-hulpmenu.
van de disc in kwestie. Raadpleeg voor details de
Als het secundaire videosignaal niet wordt documentatie bij de disc.
omgeschakeld wanneer u op 2nd VIDEO drukt, Om te kunnen profiteren van de BD-LIVE functie, zijn
schakelt u dan om via het menuscherm van de disc een netwerkverbinding en de juiste instellingen
zelf. vereist (paginas 21 en 44).
Uitschakelen van de secundaire BD-LIVE is een functie die verbinding met het internet
biedt. Discs met ondersteuning voor de BD-LIVE
video functie kunnen ID-codes versturen die deze speler en
de disc identificeren bij de provider van het over te
Druk een paar keer op 2nd VIDEO of selecteer
brengen materiaal.
Secondary Video van het FUNCTION menu om de
instelling Off (uit) te schakelen.
Afspeelfuncties 04
Welke afspeelfuncties u kunt gebruiken, hangt af van de afgespeelde disc of het bestand. In bepaalde gevallen zullen
sommige functies niet werken. Controleer welke functies beschikbaar zijn in de onderstaande tabel.
Disc/bestandstype
DVD-R
1
Functie BD- BD-R DVD- DVD- /-RW Video- Beeld- Audio- Audio-
AVCREC AVCHD
ROM /-RE Video Audio2 (VR- bestand bestand bestand CD
formaat)
Vooruit en terug
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5
zoeken3
Afspelen van
bepaalde titels,
hoofdstukken of
muziekstukken
Delen van de inhoud
overslaan
Vertraagde
7
weergave3,6
Stapsgewijs vooruit
8
en terug3
A-B herhalen3
Herhaalde weergave
Zoom
Camerastandpunt9
Ondertiteling10
Audio11
Secundaire audio12 13
Secundaire video14 15
Informatie over discs
1. Het is mogelijk dat sommige functies niet werken voor bepaalde discs of bestanden, ook al staat er wel een [] in de tabel.
2. Behalve de BDP-140.
3. Bij sommige discs wordt de normale weergave automatisch hervat wanneer er een ander hoofdstuk wordt bereikt.
4. Er klinkt geen geluid tijdens het vooruit of terug zoeken.
5. Er klinkt wel geluid tijdens het vooruit of terug zoeken.
6. Er is geen geluid tijdens vertraagde weergave.
Het is niet mogelijk om de snelheid te veranderen tijdens vertraagde weergave achteruit.
7. Vertraagde weergave achteruit is niet mogelijk.
8. Beeld-voor-beeld weergave achteruit is niet mogelijk.
9. Het teken voor het camerastandpunt Angle Mark verschijnt bij scnes die uit verschillende hoeken zijn opgenomen, mits On staat ingesteld
op (pagina 42).
10. Hoeveel en wat voor ondertitels er zijn opgenomen verschilt per disc en per bestand.
In sommige gevallen kan de ondertiteling direct worden omgeschakeld of kan het scherm voor omschakelen van het discmenu direct
verschijnen, zonder dat eerst de huidige ondertiteling of het totaal aantal ondertitels op de disc wordt aangegeven.
11. Hoeveel en wat voor audiosignaalstromen er zijn opgenomen verschilt per disc en per bestand.
12. Hoeveel en wat voor secundaire audiosignaalstromen er zijn opgenomen verschilt per disc en per bestand.
In sommige gevallen kan het secundaire geluidsspoor direct worden omgeschakeld of kan het scherm voor omschakelen via het discmenu
direct verschijnen, zonder dat eerst het huidige secundaire geluidsspoor of het totaal aantal secundaire geluidssporen op de disc wordt
aangegeven.
De secundaire geluidsspoormarkering verschijnt bij scnes waarvoor secundaire geluidssporen zijn opgenomen, mits Secondary Audio
Mark staat ingesteld op On (pagina 42).
13. Sommige discs bevatten geen secundaire geluidssporen.
14. In sommige gevallen kan het secundaire videobeeld direct worden omgeschakeld of kan het scherm voor omschakelen via het discmenu
direct verschijnen, zonder dat eerst het huidige secundaire videobeeld of het totaal aantal secundaire videostromen op de disc wordt
aangegeven.
De secundaire videomarkering verschijnt bij scnes waarvoor secundaire videosignalen zijn opgenomen, mits PIP Mark staat ingesteld op
On (pagina 42).
15. Sommige discs bevatten geen secundaire videosignalen.
31
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 32 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Willekeurige weergave
Het opgegeven gedeelte van de disc, of de opgegeven
titels of hoofdstukken (muziekstukken/bestanden)
worden in willekeurige volgorde weergegeven. Hetzelfde
stuk kan twee keer achter elkaar worden weergegeven.
Instelling
Druk tijdens het afspelen op CONTINUED op de
plek waar u later de weergave wilt hervatten.
De verstreken speeltijd op de opgegeven positie wordt
getoond op het TV-scherm.
Spelend
1 Druk op PLAY om de titel te laten weergaven
waarvoor u de hervattingsfunctie heeft ingesteld.
Het FUNCTION-menuscherm verschijnt automatisch om
de positie (tijd) aan te geven wanneer u op CONTINUED
drukt.
Het functiebedieningsscherm kan ook worden
geopend door tijdens het afspelen op FUNCTION te
drukken.
2 Druk op ENTER en kies dan het gespecificeerde
tijdstip voor de hervattingsfunctie.
De weergave begint vanaf de opgegeven positie.
33
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 34 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
05 Hoofdstuk 5
Afspelen via de Home Media Gallery
De volgende bestanden kunnen worden afgespeeld
via de Home Media Gallery:
PCs die onder Microsoft Windows Vista of XP
draaien met Windows Media Player 11
genstalleerd
PCs die onder Microsoft Windows 7 draaien met
Windows Media Player 12 genstalleerd
DLNA-compatibele digitale mediaservers (op PCs
of andere apparatuur)
Bestanden opgeslagen op een PC of DMS (Digitale
Media Server) zoals hierboven beschreven kunnen
alleen worden afgespeeld door een Digitale Media
34
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 35 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
35
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 36 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Afspelen in de
door een digitale auteursrechtelijke bescherming kan
niet worden afgespeeld via de LAN-aansluiting.
gewenste volgorde
Afspelen van disc/USB
(Playlist)
1 Druk op HOME MEDIA GALLERY om de Home
Media Gallery te openen. De discs waarvan u muziekstukken en bestanden aan de
U kunt de Home Media Gallery ook openen door Home Playlist kunt toevoegen, staan hieronder vermeld.
Media Gallery te kiezen in het Home Menu en dan op DVDs/CDs/USB-geheugenapparaten waarop
ENTER te drukken. audiobestanden zijn opgenomen
2 Kies Disc of USB.
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
Toevoegen van
ENTER. muziekstukken/bestanden
3 Selecteer Foto/Muziek/Video/AVCHD. Ga als volgt te werk om muziekstukken en bestanden toe
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op te voegen en zo een Playlist samen te stellen.
ENTER.
1 Druk op HOME MEDIA GALLERY om de Home
Deze stap geldt niet voor discs die zijn opgenomen in
Media Gallery te openen.
het VR-formaat.
U kunt de Home Media Gallery ook openen door Home
4 Selecteer de titel/het muziekstuk of het bestand Media Gallery te kiezen in het Home Menu en dan op
dat u wilt afspelen. ENTER te drukken.
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
2 Kies Disc of USB.
ENTER.
Plaats allereerst de betreffende disc.
De weergave begint vanaf de geselecteerde titel/
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
muziekstuk of bestand.
ENTER.
Als het bestand dat u wilt hebben niet in deze map
staat, moet u eerst de map met dat bestand 3 Selecteer het muziekstuk/bestand dat u wilt
selecteren. toevoegen.
Gebruik om uw keuze te maken.
4 Druk op POP UP MENU voor weergave van het
POP UP MENU menu.
36
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 37 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
37
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 38 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
06 Hoofdstuk 6
Afspelen van materiaal van het web
Met deze speler kunt u zogenaamd streaming materiaal Toegang tot informatie van derden vereist een high
van het web afspelen. speed internet verbinding, en vereist soms registratie
van de account of een betaalde inschrijving.
38
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 39 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Hoofdstuk 7 07
Geavanceerde instellingen
Wijzigen van de Bediening van het begin-
instellingen instellingenscherm
1 Zorg dat het afspelen gestopt is en laat het Home
Menu scherm verschijnen.
Druk op HOME MENU.
2 Kies de Initial Setup en stel deze in.
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
ENTER.
3 Selecteer een onderdeel en wijzig de instelling.
Gebruik /// om de instelling te kiezen en druk
dan op ENTER.
Opmerking
Welke onderdelen u kunt kiezen is afhankelijk van de werkingsstand van de speler.
Onder Opties worden de oorspronkelijke fabrieksinstellingen vetgedrukt aangegeven.
Instelling Opties Beschrijving
16:9 Full
Display Setting
TV Screen Kies deze stand wanneer het toestel is aangesloten op een (16:9) breedbeeld-TV.
16:9 Normal Kies deze stand wanneer het toestel is aangesloten op een (16:9) breedbeeld-TV. 4:3-
formaat beelden verschijnen met verticale zwarte balken aan weerszijden.
4:3 Pan&Scan Kies hiervoor wanneer u 16:9 (breedbeeld) video wilt laten weergeven op 4:3
(conventionele) TV. De video vult het 4:3 scherm, maar de linker- en rechterkanten
van het beeld vallen buiten het scherm. (Deze functie werkt als de disc bedoeld en
gelabeld is voor 4:3PS weergave.)
4:3 Letterbox Kies hiervoor wanneer u 16:9 (breedbeeld) video wilt laten weergeven op 4:3
(conventionele) TV. De video wordt volledig weergegeven op het scherm, met zwarte
balken boven en onder op het scherm.
Video Adjust De kwaliteit van de weergegeven beelden kan worden bijgeregeld, afhankelijk van wat voor televisie u
gebruikt (pagina 44).
Sharpness High Kies het gewenste scherpteniveau.
(Behalve de BDP-LX55) Middle
Low
Video Mode Standard Kies de gewenste video-uitgangsfunctie.
(Behalve de BDP-LX55) Vivid
Cinema
Custom
Noise Reduction 0 Kies het gewenste niveau voor de ruisonderdrukking.
(Behalve de BDP-LX55) 1
2
3
39
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 40 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
40
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 41 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
HDMI Mode (BDP-LX55) Single Kies hiervoor wanneer er alleen met de HDMI OUT (MAIN) aansluiting een HDMI-
kabel is verbonden.
Separate Kies hiervoor wanneer er met beide HDMI OUT aansluitingen HDMI-kabels verbonden zijn.
Pure Audio Kies hiervoor om alleen naar muziek te luisteren met een betere geluidskwaliteit wanneer er
apparatuur is verbonden met beide HDMI OUT aansluitingen. Bij deze instelling wordt er
alleen muziek geproduceerd via de HDMI OUT (SUB) aansluiting, en alleen videosignalen via
de HDMI OUT (MAIN) aansluiting wanneer er op DISPLAY wordt gedrukt.
Raadpleeg tevens Instellen van de HDMI Mode (Alleen voor de BDP-LX55) op pagina 16.
Color Space RGB Kies deze stand om de videosignalen weer te geven als RGB-signalen. Kies hiervoor
als de kleuren te bleek zijn en het zwart te licht.
YCbCr Kies deze stand om de videosignalen weer te geven als YCbCr 4:4:4 signalen.
YCbCr 422 Kies deze stand om de videosignalen weer te geven als YCbCr 4:2:2 signalen.
Full RGB Kies deze stand om de videosignalen weer te geven als RGB-signalen. Kies deze instelling
als de kleuren te intens lijken en donkere partijen dichtlopen in egaal zwarte vlakken.
Resolution Auto Kies deze instelling om de resolutie van de videosignalen die worden geproduceerd
via de HDMI OUT aansluiting automatisch te laten bepalen.
480I/576I Laat de videosignalen door de HDMI OUT aansluiting produceren met de
geselecteerde resolutie.
480P/576P
De resolutie kan worden gewijzigd door op HDMI te drukken, maar Auto kan niet
720P worden geselecteerd.
1080I
1080P
Op de BDP-LX55 worden er geen videosignalen geproduceerd via de HDMI OUT (MAIN) aansluiting wanneer de resolutie is
ingesteld op 480I/576I.
HDMI Audio Out Bitstream Kies hiervoor om HDMI-audiosignalen direct te produceren.
PCM Kies hiervoor om HDMI-audiosignalen om te zetten naar 2-kanaals audiosignalen.
Re-encode Kies hiervoor om het type audiosignalen automatisch te laten bepalen.
Off Kies hiervoor wanneer u niet wilt dat audiosignalen worden geproduceerd via de
HDMI-uitgangsaansluiting.
Control On Kies deze stand om de speler te bedienen met de afstandsbediening van een AV-
apparaat dat is aangesloten met een HDMI-kabel. Zie tevens pagina 16.
Off Kies deze stand als u de speler niet wilt bedienen met de afstandsbediening van een
AV-apparaat dat is aangesloten met een HDMI-kabel.
Om gebruik te kunnen maken van de Sound Retriever Link, Stream Smoother Link en PQLS functies (paginas 16 en 17), moet
Control zijn ingesteld op On.
HDMI Deep color 30bits Kies deze instelling wanneer u videosignalen met 30 bits kleurdiepte wilt laten produceren.
36bits Kies deze instelling wanneer u videosignalen met 36 bits kleurdiepte wilt laten produceren.
Off Kies deze instelling wanneer u videosignalen met 24 bits kleurdiepte wilt laten produceren.
HDMI 1080P 24Hz On Kies deze instelling wanneer Resolutie is ingesteld op Auto of 1080P en er 1080p/24
videosignalen worden gestuurd naar een TV die geschikt is voor 1080p/24 signalen.
Off Kies deze instelling wanneer Resolutie is ingesteld op 1080P en er 1080p/60
videosignalen worden gestuurd naar een TV die geschikt is voor 1080p/60 signalen.
HDMI 3D Auto Bij 3D-discs kan de disc worden afgespeeld met 3D-weergave.
Off Ook 3D-discs zullen worden afgespeeld met 2D-weergave.
3D notice Yes Hiermee stelt u in of de 3D-kennisgeving wel of niet moet worden getoond wanneer
er 3D-beelden worden weergegeven.
No
Network
IP setting Kies deze instelling om het IP-adres van de speler en de DNS-server in te stellen (pagina 44).
Proxy Server Stel alleen een proxy-server in als uw Internet-provider dat vereist (pagina 44).
Information Toont de ingestelde waarden voor het MAC-adres, IP-adres, subnet-masker, standaard gateway, DNS-
server (primair) en DNS-server (secundair).
Connection test Kies dit item om de netwerkverbinding te testen (pagina 45).
Internet Connection Enable Kies deze instelling wanneer u verbinding wilt maken met het internet.
Disable Kies deze instelling wanneer u geen verbinding wilt maken met het internet.
BD-Live connection Permitted Alle discs mogen verbinding maken met BD-LIVE.
Partial Permitted Alleen discs die gegarandeerd veilig zijn mogen verbinding maken met BD-LIVE.
Prohibited Geen enkele disc mag verbinding maken met BD-LIVE.
DLNA Enable Kies deze instelling wanneer u verbinding wilt maken met een DLNA-server.
41
Disable Kies deze instelling wanneer u geen verbinding wilt maken met een DLNA-server. Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 42 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
OSD beschikbare talen Hier kunt u uit de talenlijst de gewenste taal voor de beeldschermaanduidingen
kiezen.
Audio beschikbare talen Kies uit de talenlijst de gewenste taal om dialogen en commentaar in te horen voor
* Bij sommige discs is het zowel BD-ROM als DVD-Video-discs.
mogelijk dat er niet kan
worden overgeschakeld
naar de gekozen taal.
Als er een taal is gekozen die niet op de BD/DVD voorkomt, wordt er automatisch een van de wel aanwezige talen gekozen en weergegeven.
Subtitle beschikbare talen Kies uit de talenlijst de gewenste taal om de ondertiteling in weer te geven voor
* Bij sommige discs is het zowel BD-ROM als DVD-Video-discs.
mogelijk dat er niet kan
worden overgeschakeld
naar de gekozen taal.
Als er een taal is gekozen die niet op de BD/DVD voorkomt, wordt er automatisch een van de wel aanwezige talen gekozen en weergegeven.
Menu beschikbare talen Kies uit de talenlijst de gewenste taal om de menus in weer te geven voor zowel BD-
* Bij sommige discs is het ROM als DVD-Video-discs.
mogelijk dat er niet kan
worden overgeschakeld
naar de gekozen taal.
Als er een taal is gekozen die niet op de BD/DVD voorkomt, wordt er automatisch een van de wel aanwezige talen gekozen en weergegeven.
Playback
Angle Mark On Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er meerdere camerastandpunten
beschikbaar zijn weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm (pagina 28). Dit is de
fabrieksinstelling voor de BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er meerdere camerastandpunten
beschikbaar zijn niet weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm. Dit is de
fabrieksinstelling voor de BDP-LX55.
PIP Mark On Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er een inzetbeeld (PIP)
beschikbaar is weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm. Dit is de fabrieksinstelling
voor de BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er een inzetbeeld (PIP)
beschikbaar is niet weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm. Dit is de fabrieksinstelling
voor de BDP-LX55.
Secondary Audio Mark On Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er secundaire audiosignalen
beschikbaar zijn weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm (pagina 29). Dit is de
fabrieksinstelling voor de BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Kies deze instelling om het teken dat aangeeft dat er secundaire audiosignalen
beschikbaar zijn niet weer te laten geven op het TV-scherm. Dit is de
fabrieksinstelling voor de BDP-LX55.
DivX(R) VOD DRM Registration Code Toont de registratiecode van de speler die vereist is voor het afspelen van DivX VOD-
bestanden (pagina 10).
DVD Playback DVD AUDIO Kies deze instelling om alleen het audiogedeelte van de DVD-Audio af te spelen.
* Deze instelling is DVD VIDEO Kies deze instelling om alleen het videogedeelte van de DVD-Audio af te spelen.
bedoeld voor weergave
van DVD-Audio discs.
(Behalve de BDP-140)
Internet Setting Permitted Materiaal van het internet kan worden gebruikt zonder het wachtwoord in te voeren.
Partial Permitted Het wachtwoord moet worden ingevoerd voor materiaal van het web gebruikt kan
worden.
Prohibited Er kan geen materiaal van het web gebruikt worden.
Disc Auto Playback On Discs worden automatisch afgespeeld zodra ze in het toestel gedaan worden.
Off Een disc die in het toestel gedaan wordt, begint niet automatisch te spelen.
Last Memory On Kies deze instelling om het punt waar u het afspelen heeft gestopt op te slaan, ook
wanneer de disclade wordt geopend of het toestel uit (standby) wordt gezet.
Off Kies hiervoor wanneer u alleen de standaard hervattingsfunctie wilt gebruiken (pagina 33).
PBC (Play Back Control) On Kies deze instelling om Video-CDs (Ver. 2.0) met PBC af te spelen via het discmenu.
Off Kies hiervoor om Video-CDs (Ver. 2.0) met PBC niet af te spelen via het discmenu.
Setup Navigator Maak de instellingen via het Setup Navigator menu. Zie pagina 23 voor verdere informatie.
Security
Change Password Registreer (wijzig) het wachtwoord voor de kinderslot-instellingen of voor het ontgrendelen om een
kinderslot-beveiligde DVD-Video af te spelen (pagina 45).
Parental Control Wijzig het kinderslot-niveau van de speler (pagina 46).
42 Country Code Wijzig de land/gebiedscode (pagina 46).
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 43 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
30 min
Quick Start On Kies deze instelling om de tijd die nodig is om op te starten korter te maken.
Off Kies deze instelling om het toestel normaal op te laten starten.
Update Disc Kies de manier waarop de software bijgewerkt moet worden. (pagina 46)
USB Storage
Network
Load Default Laat de instellingen terugzetten op de fabrieksinstellingen.
System Information Controleer het systeemversienummer.
Disc Auto Update On Toont het software-updatescherm wanneer de disc met het updatebestand voor de
speler wordt geladen.
Off Het software-updatescherm moet met de hand worden geopend. (pagina 46)
BUDA BUDA Tonen en instellen van de BUDA-gegevens op het aangesloten USB-
Information geheugenapparaat.
BUDA Setup
43
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 44 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Opmerking
Voor de BDP-LX55 heeft de Video Adjust instelling
44 geen invloed op de videosignalen van de VIDEO
Nl OUTPUT aansluitingen.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 45 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Opmerking
Als er een taal is gekozen die niet op de BD/DVD
voorkomt, wordt er automatisch een van de wel
aanwezige talen gekozen en weergegeven. 45
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 46 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
46
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 47 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
5 Kies de Start en stel deze in. 4 Kies en maak de instelling voor Options
Druk op ENTER. Update Disc of USB Storage Start. 07
Gebruik / om de instelling te kiezen en druk dan op
6 Het downloaden van de software begint. ENTER.
De voortgang van het downloaden wordt op het scherm
getoond. 5 Kies de Yes en stel deze in.
Afhankelijk van uw Internetverbinding kan het Gebruik /// om Yes te selecteren en druk hierna
downloaden soms geruime tijd vergen. op ENTER.
07 Taalcodetabel en land/gebiedscodetabel
Taalcodetabel
Naam van de taal, taalcode, invoercode
Abkhazian, ab/abk, 0102 French, fr/fra, 0618 Malagasy, mg/mlg, 1307 Slovenian, sl/slv, 1912
Afar, aa/aar, 0101 Galician, gl/glg, 0712 Malay, ms/msa, 1319 Somali, so/som, 1915
Afrikaans, af/afr, 0106 Georgian, ka/kat, 1101 Malayalam, ml/mal, 1312 Sotho, Southern, st/sot, 1920
Albanian, sq/sqi, 1917 German, de/deu, 0405 Maltese, mt/mlt, 1320 Spanish, es/spa, 0519
Amharic, am/amh, 0113 Greek, el/ell, 0512 Maori, mi/mri, 1309 Sundanese, su/sun, 1921
Arabic, ar/ara, 0118 Guarani, gn/grn, 0714 Marathi, mr/mar, 1318 Swahili, sw/swa, 1923
Armenian, hy/hye, 0825 Gujarati, gu/guj, 0721 Mongolian, mn/mon, 1314 Swati, ss/ssw, 1919
Assamese, as/asm, 0119 Hausa, ha/hau, 0801 Moldavian, mo/mol, 1315 Swedish, sv/swe, 1922
Aymara, ay/aym, 0125 Hebrew, iw/heb, 0923 Nauru, na/nau, 1401 Tagalog, tl/tgl, 2012
Azerbaijani, az/aze, 0126 Hindi, hi/hin, 0809 Nepali, ne/nep, 1405 Tajik, tg/tgk, 2007
Bashkir, ba/bak, 0201 Hungarian, hu/hun, 0821 Norwegian, no/nor, 1415 Tamil, ta/tam, 2001
Basque, eu/eus, 0521 Icelandic, is/isl, 0919 Occitan, oc/oci, 1503 Tatar, tt/tat, 2020
Belarusian, be/bel, 0205 Indonesian, in/ind, 0914 Oriya, or/ori, 1518 Telugu, te/tel, 2005
Bengali, bn/ben, 0214 Interlingua, ia/ina, 0901 Oromo, om/orm, 1513 Thai, th/tha, 2008
Bihari, bh/bih, 0208 Interlingue, ie/ile, 0905 Panjabi, pa/pan, 1601 Tibetan, bo/bod, 0215
Bislama, bi/bis, 0209 Inupiaq, ik/ipk, 0911 Persian, fa/fas, 0601 Tigrinya, ti/tir, 2009
Breton, br/bre, 0218 Irish, ga/gle, 0701 Polish, pl/pol, 1612 Tonga (Tonga Islands), to/ton, 2015
Bulgarian, bg/bul, 0207 Italian, it/ita, 0920 Portuguese, pt/por, 1620 Tsonga, ts/tso, 2019
Burmese, my/mya, 1325 Japanese, ja/jpn, 1001 Pushto, ps/pus, 1619 Tswana, tn/tsn, 2014
Catalan, ca/cat, 0301 Javanese, jw/jav, 1023 Quechua, qu/que, 1721 Turkmen, tk/tuk, 2011
Central Khmer, km/khm, 1113 Kalaallisut, kl/kal, 1112 Romanian, ro/ron, 1815 Turkish, tr/tur, 2018
Chinese, zh/zho, 2608 Kannada, kn/kan, 1114 Romansch, rm/roh, 1813 Twi, tw/twi, 2023
Corsican, co/cos, 0315 Kashmiri, ks/kas, 1119 Rundi, rn/run, 1814 Ukrainian, uk/ukr, 2111
Croatian, hr/hrv, 0818 Kazakh, kk/kaz, 1111 Russian, ru/rus, 1821 Urdu, ur/urd, 2118
Czech, cs/ces, 0319 Kinyarwanda, rw/kin, 1823 Samoan, sm/smo, 1913 Uzbek, uz/uzb, 2126
Danish, da/dan, 0401 Kirghiz, ky/kir, 1125 Sango, sg/sag, 1907 Vietnamese, vi/vie, 2209
Dutch, nl/nld, 1412 Korean, ko/kor, 1115 Sanskrit, sa/san, 1901 Volapk, vo/vol, 2215
Dzongkha, dz/dzo, 0426 Kurdish, ku/kur, 1121 Scottish Gaelic, gd/gla, 0704 Welsh, cy/cym, 0325
English, en/eng, 0514 Lao, lo/lao, 1215 Serbian, sr/srp, 1918 Western Frisian, fy/fry, 0625
Esperanto, eo/epo, 0515 Latin, la/lat, 1201 Serbo-Croatian, sh/---, 1908 Wolof, wo/wol, 2315
Estonian, et/est, 0520 Latvian, lv/lav, 1222 Shona, sn/sna, 1914 Xhosa, xh/xho, 2408
Finnish, fi/fin, 0609 Lingala, ln/lin, 1214 Sindhi, sd/snd, 1904 Yiddish, ji/yid, 1009
Fijian, fj/fij, 0610 Lithuanian, lt/lit, 1220 Sinhalese, si/sin, 1909 Yoruba, yo/yor, 2515
Faroese, fo/fao, 0615 Macedonian, mk/mkd, 1311 Slovak, sk/slk, 1911 Zulu, zu/zul, 2621
Land/gebiedscodetabel
Naam land/gebied, land/gebiedscode, invoercode
Anguilla, ai, 0109 Estland, ee, 0505 Luxemburg, lu, 1221 Singapore, sg, 1907
Antigua en Barbuda, ag, 0107 Finland, fi, 0609 Macedoni, Voormalige Slowakije, sk, 1911
Argentini, ar, 0118 Frankrijk, fr, 0618 Joegoslavische Republiek, Sloveni, si, 1909
Armeni, am, 0113 Georgi, ge, 0705 mk, 1311 Spanje, es, 0519
Australi, au, 0121 Duitsland, de, 0405 Maleisi, my, 1325 Suriname, sr, 1918
Oostenrijk, at, 0120 Griekenland, gr, 0718 Malta, mt, 1320 Zweden, se, 1905
Azerbeidzjan, az, 0126 Groenland, gl, 0712 Mexico, mx, 1324 Zwitserland, ch, 0308
Bahamas, bs, 0219 Grenada, gd, 0704 Moldavi, Republiek, md, 1304 Taiwan, Provincie van China, tw,
Barbados, bb, 0202 Guyana, gy, 0725 Monaco, mc, 1303 2023
Wit-Rusland, by, 0225 Hati, ht, 0820 Montserrat, ms, 1319 Tadzjikistan, tj, 2010
Belgi, be, 0205 Hongkong, hk, 0811 Nederland, nl, 1412 Thailand, th, 2008
Belize, bz, 0226 Hongarije, hu, 0821 Nieuw-Zeeland, nz, 1426 Trinidad en Tobago, tt, 2020
Bermuda, bm, 0213 IJsland, is, 0919 Noorwegen, no, 1415 Tunesi, tn, 2014
Brazili, br, 0218 India, in, 0914 Pakistan, pk, 1611 Turkije, tr, 2018
Bulgarije, bg, 0207 Indonesi, id, 0904 Peru, pe, 1605 Turkmenistan, tm, 2013
Canada, ca, 0301 Ierland, ie, 0905 Filippijnen, ph, 1608 Turks- en Caicoseilanden, tc, 2003
Kaaimaneilanden, ky, 1125 Isral, il, 0912 Polen, pl, 1612 Oekrane, ua, 2101
Chili, cl, 0312 Itali, it, 0920 Portugal, pt, 1620 Groot-Brittanni, gb, 0702
China, cn, 0314 Jamaica, jm, 1013 Puerto Rico, pr, 1618 Verenigde Staten van Amerika,
Colombia, co, 0315 Japan, jp, 1016 Roemeni, ro, 1815 us, 2119
Kroati, hr, 0818 Kazachstan, kz, 1126 Russische Federatie, ru, 1821 Uruguay, uy, 2125
Cyprus, cy, 0325 Korea (Republiek), kr, 1118 Saint Kitts en Nevis, kn, 1114 Oezbekistan, uz, 2126
Tsjechische Republiek, cz, 0326 Kirgistan, kg, 1107 Saint Lucia, lc, 1203 Venezuela, ve, 2205
Denemarken, dk, 0411 Letland, lv, 1222 Saint Vincent en de Grenadines, Virgineilanden, Britse, vg, 2207
Dominica, dm, 0413 Liechtenstein, li, 1209 vc, 2203
Dominicaanse Republiek, do, 0415 Litouwen, lt, 1220 San Marino, sm, 1913
48
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 49 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Hoofdstuk 8 08
Aanvullende informatie
Kennisgeving MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms
except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim ordinary way, to print or display an announcement (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
08 copies of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
including an appropriate copyright notice and a
notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
Preamble you provide a warranty) and that users may cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your
The licenses for most software are designed to take away redistribute the program under these conditions, and obligations under this License and any other pertinent
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU telling the user how to view a copy of this License. obligations, then as a consequence you may not
General Public License is intended to guarantee your (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure does not normally print such an announcement, your license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of
the software is free for all its users. This General Public work based on the Program is not required to print an the Program by all those who receive copies directly or
License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's announcement.) indirectly through you, then the only way you could
software and to any other program whose authors commit These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the entirely from distribution of the Program.
is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License Program, and can be reasonably considered independent If any portion of this section is held invalid or
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. and separate works in themselves, then this License, and unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
When we speak of free software, we are referring to its terms, do not apply to those sections when you balance of the section is intended to apply and the
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute section as a whole is intended to apply in other
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based circumstances.
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get the terms of this License, whose permissions for other infringe any patents or other property right claims or to
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and contest validity of any such claims; this section has the
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you every part regardless of who wrote it. sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
can do these things. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or software distribution system, which is implemented by
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, public license practices. Many people have made
forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution generous contributions to the wide range of software
surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain of derivative or collective works based on the Program. distributed through that system in reliance on
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on consistent application of that system; it is up to the
software, or if you modify it. the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium distribute software through any other system and a
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all does not bring the other work under the scope of this licensee cannot impose that choice.
the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, License. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what
receive or can get the source code. And you must show 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
them these terms so they know their rights. based on it, under Section 2) in object code or License.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal above provided that you also do one of the following: restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to machine-readable source code, which must be who places the Program under this License may add an
make certain that everyone understands that there is no distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
warranty for this free software. If the software is modified on a medium customarily used for software those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to interchange; or, or among countries not thus excluded. In such case,
know that what they have is not the original, so that any b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least this License incorporates the limitation as if written in
problems introduced by others will not reflect on the three years, to give any third party, for a charge no the body of this License.
original authors' reputations. more than your cost of physically performing source 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of or new versions of the General Public License from time
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that the corresponding source code, to be distributed to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a present version, but may differ in detail to address new
patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. medium customarily used for software interchange; problems or concerns.
To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must or, Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. c) Accompany it with the information you received as to If the Program specifies a version number of this
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution the offer to distribute corresponding source code. License which applies to it and "any later version", you
and modification follow. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial have the option of following the terms and conditions
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE distribution and only if you received the program in either of that version or of any later version published by
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION object code or executable form with such an offer, in the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not
AND MODIFICATION accord with Subsection b above.) specify a version number of this License, you may
0. This License applies to any program or other work The source code for a work means the preferred form of the choose any version ever published by the Free Software
which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder work for making modifications to it. For an executable Foundation.
saying it may be distributed under the terms of this work, complete source code means all the source code for 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to all modules it contains, plus any associated interface other free programs whose distribution conditions are
any such program or work, and a "work based on the definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
Program" means either the Program or any derivative and installation of the executable. However, as a special software which is copyrighted by the Free Software
work under copyright law: that is to say, a work exception, the source code distributed need not include Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we
containing the Program or a portion of it, either anything that is normally distributed (in either source or sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included and so on) of the operating system on which the executable of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting
without limitation in the term "modification".) Each runs, unless that component itself accompanies the the sharing and reuse of software generally.
licensee is addressed as "you". executable. NO WARRANTY
Activities other than copying, distribution and If distribution of executable or object code is made by 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF
modification are not covered by this License; they are offering access to copy from a designated place, then CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
restricted, and the output from the Program is covered same place counts as distribution of the source code, even APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE
only if its contents constitute a work based on the though third parties are not compelled to copy the source STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
Program (independent of having been made by running along with the object code. OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
Program does. Program except as expressly provided under this EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Program's source code as you receive it, in any sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
medium, provided that you conspicuously and automatically terminate your rights under this License. PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate However, parties who have received copies, or rights, QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact from you under this License will not have their licenses WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
all the notices that refer to this License and to the terminated so long as such parties remain in full DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients compliance. NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
of the Program a copy of this License along with the 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
Program. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring permission to modify or distribute the Program or its COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM
protection in exchange for a fee. you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or or distributing the Program (or any work based on the DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that distributing or modifying the Program or works based PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS
you also meet all of these conditions: on it. OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent 6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES
notices stating that you changed the files and the based on the Program), the recipient automatically OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
date of any change. receives a license from the original licensor to copy, ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived and conditions. You may not impose any further POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
terms of this License. compliance by third parties to this License. If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the
50 c) If the modified program normally reads commands
interactively when run, you must cause it, when
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation
of patent infringement or for any other reason (not
greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve
this is to make it free software which everyone can
Nl started running for such interactive use in the most limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you redistribute and change under these terms.
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 51 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we depends on what the Library does and what the
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most
effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file
copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license,
which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or
program that uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
08
should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to modify the library. Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any
where the full notice is found. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear medium, provided that you conspicuously and
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
of what it does.> library is modified by someone else and passed on, the copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> recipients should know that what they have is not the all the notices that refer to this License and to the
This program is free software; you can redistribute it original version, so that the original author's reputation will absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General not be affected by problems that might be introduced by License along with the Library.
Public License as published by the Free Software others. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty
option) any later version. existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that protection in exchange for a fee.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library,
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license and copy and distribute such modifications or work
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you
Public License for more details. the full freedom of use specified in this license. also meet all of these conditions:
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
Public License along with this program; if not, write to the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain notices stating that you changed the files and the
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary date of any change.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic General Public License. We use this license for certain c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed
and paper mail. libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non- at no charge to all third parties under the terms of
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice free programs. this License.
like this when it starts in an interactive mode: When a program is linked with a library, whether statically d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of or using a shared library, the combination of the two is or a table of data to be supplied by an application
author legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the program that uses the facility, other than as an
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO original library. The ordinary General Public License argument passed when the facility is invoked, then
WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. therefore permits such linking only if the entire you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in
This is free software, and you are welcome to combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General the event an application does not supply such
redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other function or table, the facility still operates, and
for details. code with the library. performs whatever part of its purpose remains
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License meaningful.
show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the (For example, a function in a library to compute
Of course, the commands you use may be called ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could software developers Less of an advantage over competing defined independent of the application. Therefore,
even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
program. use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. function or table used by this function must be
You should also get your employer (if you work as a However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain optional: if the application does not supply it, the
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright special circumstances. square root function must still compute square
disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special roots.)
alter the names: need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain These requirements apply to the modified work as a
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
the program this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) A more frequent case is that a free library does the same considered independent and separate works in
written by James Hacker. job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989 little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, apply to those sections when you distribute them as
Ty Coon, President of Vice so we use the Lesser General Public License. separate works. But when you distribute the same
This General Public License does not permit incorporating In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non- sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
your program into proprietary programs. If your program is free programs enables a greater number of people to use a Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the
a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to large body of free software. For example, permission to use terms of this License, whose permissions for other
permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each
this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Public License instead of this License. well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLICLICENSE protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
Version 2.1, February 1999 user of a program that is linked with the Library has the distribution of derivative or collective works based on
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a the Library.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA modified version of the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
copies of this license document, but changing it is not and modification follow. Pay close attention to the based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
allowed. difference between a "work based on the library" and a distribution medium does not bring the other work
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also "work that uses the library". The former contains code under the scope of this License.
counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, derived from the library, whereas the latter must be 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU
version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] combined with the library in order to run. General Public License instead of this License to a given
Preamble GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the
The licenses for most software are designed to take away TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU AND MODIFICATION ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure or other program which contains a notice placed by the the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared,
the software is free for all its users. copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may then you can specify that version instead if you wish.)
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Do not make any other change in these notices.
some specially designated software packages--typically Public License (also called "this License"). Each Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other licensee is addressed as "you". irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we A "library" means a collection of software functions and/ Public License applies to all subsequent copies and
suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with derivative works made from that copy.
or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy application programs (which use some of those This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations functions and data) to form executables. code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
below. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
When we speak of free software, we are referring to or work which has been distributed under these terms. derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are A "work based on the Library" means either the Library executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, above provided that you accompany it with the
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either complete corresponding machine-readable source
service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get verbatim or with modifications and/or translated code, which must be distributed under the terms of
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed translation is included without limitation in the term for software interchange.
that you can do these things. "modification".) If distribution of object code is made by offering access
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of to copy from a designated place, then offering
forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to the work for making modifications to it. For a library, equivalent access to copy the source code from the
surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to complete source code means all the source code for all same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the modules it contains, plus any associated interface source code, even though third parties are not
library or if you modify it. definition files, plus the scripts used to control compelled to copy the source along with the object
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether compilation and installation of the library. code.
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights Activities other than copying, distribution and 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of
that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, modification are not covered by this License; they are the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code outside its scope. The act of running a program using being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that
with the library, you must provide complete object files to the Library is not restricted, and output from such a uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library
after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And
program is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Library (independent of the use of the
derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside
the scope of this License.
51
you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 52 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the and explaining where to find the accompanying WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
08 Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the
Library (because it contains portions of the Library),
uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
rather than a "work that uses the library". The distribute the Library except as expressly provided IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
executable is therefore covered by this License. Section under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
6 states terms for distribution of such executables. modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from void, and will automatically terminate your rights under RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
a header file that is part of the Library, the object code this License. However, parties who have received THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even copies, or rights, from you under this License will not PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is have their licenses terminated so long as such parties NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
especially significant if the work can be linked without remain in full compliance. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, permission to modify or distribute the Library or its MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY
data structure layouts and accessors, and small derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, or distributing the Library (or any work based on the INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
(Executables containing this object code plus portions do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) distributing or modifying the Library or works based on DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you it. LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
may distribute the object code for the work under the 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that based on the Library), the recipient automatically OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are receives a license from the original licensor to copy, OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
linked directly with the Library itself. distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also these terms and conditions. You may not impose any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
Library to produce a work containing portions of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making
choice, provided that the terms permit modification of 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation it free software that everyone can redistribute and change.
the work for the customer's own use and reverse of patent infringement or for any other reason (not You can do so by permitting redistribution under these
engineering for debugging such modifications. limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that General Public License).
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library contradict the conditions of this License, they do not To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the
and its use are covered by this License. You must excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
supply a copy of this License. If the work during cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
execution displays copyright notices, you must include obligations under this License and any other pertinent each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well obligations, then as a consequence you may not pointer to where the full notice is found.
as a reference directing the user to the copy of this distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of
License. Also, you must do one of these things: license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of what it does.>
a) Accompany the work with the complete the Library by all those who receive copies directly or Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
corresponding machine-readable source code for the indirectly through you, then the only way you could This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/
Library including whatever changes were used in the satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 entirely from distribution of the Library. Public
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked If any portion of this section is held invalid or License as published by the Free Software Foundation;
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or balance of the section is intended to apply, and the later version.
source code, so that the user can modify the Library section as a whole is intended to apply in other This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
and then relink to produce a modified executable circumstances. useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
containing the modified Library. (It is understood It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS
that the user who changes the contents of definitions infringe any patents or other property right claims or to FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser
files in the Library will not necessarily be able to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the General Public License for more details.
recompile the application to use the modified sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
definitions.) software distribution system which is implemented by General Public License along with this library; if not,
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking public license practices. Many people have made write to the Free Software
with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) generous contributions to the wide range of software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston,
uses at run time a copy of the library already present distributed through that system in reliance on MA 02110-1301 USA
on the user's computer system, rather than copying consistent application of that system; it is up to the Also add information on how to contact you by electronic
library functions into the executable, and (2) will author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to and paper mail.
operate properly with a modified version of the library, distribute software through any other system and a You should also get your employer (if you work as a
if the user installs one, as long as the modified licensee cannot impose that choice. programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright
version is interface-compatible with the version that This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
the work was made with. is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this alter the names:
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in
least three years, to give the same user the materials 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted by James Random Hacker.
more than the cost of performing this distribution. interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access Library under this License may add an explicit Ty Coon, President of Vice
to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent geographical distribution limitation excluding those That's all there is to it!
access to copy the above specified materials from the countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
same place. among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of License incorporates the limitation as if written in the
these materials or that you have already sent this body of this License.
user a copy. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
For an executable, the required form of the "work that or new versions of the Lesser General Public License
uses the Library" must include any data and utility from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
programs needed for reproducing the executable from spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be address new problems or concerns.
distributed need not include anything that is normally Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the If the Library specifies a version number of this License
major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the which applies to it and "any later version", you have the
operating system on which the executable runs, unless option of following the terms and conditions either of
that component itself accompanies the executable. that version or of any later version published by the Free
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do license version number, you may choose any version
not normally accompany the operating system. Such a ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other
Library together in an executable that you distribute. free programs whose distribution conditions are
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
the Library side-by-side in a single library together with permission. For software which is copyrighted by the
other library facilities not covered by this License, and Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software
distribute such a combined library, provided that the Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
separate distribution of the work based on the Library Our decision will be guided by the two goals of
and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
and provided that you do these two things: software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the software generally.
same work based on the Library, uncombined with NO WARRANTY
any other library facilities. This must be distributed 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
52 under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of
CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
Nl the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 53 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Plak geen etiketten of stickers op uw discs en schrijf er Gebruik geen benzeen, thinner of andere vluchtige
08 niet op met een balpen of ander puntig voorwerp. Dit kan stoffen voor het reinigen. Gebruik ook geen antistatische
namelijk resulteren in beschadiging van de disc. middelen of sprays.
Hardnekkig vuil poetst u weg met een zachte doek met
wat water, grondig uitgewrongen, en dan droogt u
zorgvuldig na met een zachte droge doek.
Afspelen
Probleem Controle Oplossing
De disc wordt niet Is de disc wel van een type Controleer of de disc van een type is dat in deze speler kan worden
afgespeeld. waarvoor deze speler afgespeeld (pagina 7).
De disclade gaat geschikt is?
automatisch open. Is het bestand van een type Controleer of het bestand van een type is dat in deze speler kan
waarvoor deze speler worden afgespeeld (pagina 10).
geschikt is? Controleer of het bestand niet beschadigd is.
Zijn er krassen op de disc? Discs met krassen kunnen niet altijd goed worden afgespeeld.
Is de disc vuil? Maak de disc schoon (hierboven).
Is er wellicht een etiket of Misschien is de disc krom en niet afspeelbaar.
sticker op de disc geplakt?
Is de disc goed in de lade Plaats de disc met de bedrukte label-kant boven.
gelegd? Leg de disc precies midden in de uitsparing van de disclade.
Is het regionummer wel juist? Zie pagina 9 voor de regionummers van discs die kunnen worden
afgespeeld in deze speler.
54
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 55 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
HDMI-bedieningsfunctie 08
Probleem Controle Oplossing
De HDMI-bedieningsfunctie Is de HDMI-kabel correct Voor gebruik van de HDMI-bedieningsfunctie sluit u uw Flat Screen TV
werkt niet. aangesloten? en AV-systeem (AV-receiver of versterker, e.d.) aan op de HDMI OUT-
aansluiting (pagina 15).
Is de HDMI-kabel die u Gebruik een High Speed HDMI Cable. De HDMI-bedieningsfunctie
gebruikt wel een High Speed werkt mogelijk niet naar behoren als er een ander soort HDMI-kabel
HDMI Cable? dan een High Speed HDMI Cable wordt gebruikt.
Is uw deze speler Als er videosignalen worden weergegeven via een andere aansluiting
aangesloten op de TV met dan de HDMI OUT-aansluiting, zullen de HDMI-bedieningsfuncties
een HDMI-kabel voor niet werken. Maakt de aansluiting op de TV met een HDMI-kabel
beeldweergave? (pagina 15).
Voor de BDP-LX55: Wanneer beide HDMI OUT aansluitingen (MAIN en SUB) worden
Is de HDMI Mode correct gebruikt, werkt de Control bedieningsfunctie alleen voor de HDMI OUT
ingesteld? (SUB) aansluiting (pagina 16).
Netwerk
Probleem Controle Oplossing
De functie BD-LIVE Verricht de Connection Test (pagina 45). Als nu de mededeling
(Internet-aansluiting) is niet Networks is OK. wordt aangegeven, controleert u de instellingen voor
te gebruiken. de proxy-server (pagina 44). Het kan ook zijn dat er een probleem is met
De mededeling No valid id uw Internetverbinding. Raadpleeg uw Internetprovider.
file found! verschijnt
wanneer u probeert de
software bij te werken.
Het bijwerken van de Afhankelijk van uw Internetverbinding en enkele andere factoren, kan
software verloopt erg traag. het bijwerken van de software wel enige tijd vergen.
57
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 58 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Overige
Probleem Controle Oplossing
De speler wordt automatisch Staat het onderdeel Auto Als Auto Power Off staat ingesteld op 10 min/20 min/30 min, zal de
uitgeschakeld. Power Off ingesteld op 10 speler automatisch worden uitgeschakeld wanneer er langer dan 30
min/20 min/30 min? minuten geen bedieningshandeling plaatsvindt (pagina 43).
De speler wordt automatisch Staat het onderdeel Control De speler kan tegelijk worden ingeschakeld met het TV-toestel dat is
ingeschakeld. ingesteld op On? aangesloten op de HDMI OUT-aansluiting. Als u niet wilt dat de speler
tegelijk met de aangesloten TV word ingeschakeld, stelt u Control in op
Off (pagina 41).
De speler reageert niet op de Gebruikt u de Gebruik de afstandsbediening binnen 7 meter van de
afstandsbediening. afstandsbediening niet op te afstandsbedieningssensor.
grote afstand van de speler?
Kunnen de batterijen leeg Vervang de batterijen (pagina 5).
zijn?
De ingestelde ingangen van Staat het onderdeel Control De ingangsbronnen van een TV-toestel, AV-systeem (AV-receiver of
de aangesloten Tv en het ingesteld op On? versterker e.d.) aangesloten op de HDMI OUT-aansluiting kunnen
aangesloten AV-systeem automatisch overschakelen naar deze speler wanneer het afspelen op
worden automatisch de speler begint of wanneer het menuscherm (Home Media Gallery,
omgeschakeld. enz.) verschijnt. Als u niet wilt dat de ingangsbron van een aangesloten
TV, AV-systeem (AV-receiver of versterker e.d.) automatisch wordt
omgeschakeld, stelt u Control in op Off (pagina 41).
De gemaakte instellingen zijn Hebt u wellicht de stekker Druk altijd eerst op STANDBY/ON op het voorpaneel van de speler
gewist. uit het stopcontact getrokken of op STANDBY/ON van de afstandsbediening en controleer of de
terwijl de speler nog aan aanduiding POWER OFF van het display op het voorpaneel van de
stond? speler is verdwenen, voordat u de stekker uit het stopcontact haalt. Let
Is er een ook vooral goed op als het netsnoer van de speler is aangesloten op de
stroomonderbreking netstroomuitgang van een ander apparaat, want de speler zal dan
geweest? tegelijk met het andere apparaat worden uitgeschakeld.
58
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 59 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Ethernet Regionummer
Een standaardtechniek voor plaatselijke netwerken (LANs) voor Zie pagina 9.
het verbinden van een aantal computers e.d. in een bepaalde
locatie. Deze disc-speler is geschikt voor 100BASE-TX. Secundaire audio
Sommige BD-ROM discs bevatten secundaire geluidsstromen
HDMI (Hoge-definitie multimedia- samen met het hoofdaudiosignaal. Deze subaudiostromen
interface) worden secundaire audio genoemd. Bij sommige discs is deze
secundaire audio opgenomen als het geluidsspoor voor de
Zie pagina 15.
secundaire video.
Interactieve audio
Secundaire video
De geluidssignalen die zijn opgenomen in de titels op BD-ROM
Sommige BD-ROM discs bevatten secundaire videobeelden die u
discs. Hieronder valt bijvoorbeeld het klikgeluid dat u hoort bij de
in het hoofdbeeld kunt laten verschijnen met de P-in-P
bediening van het menuscherm.
inzetbeeldfunctie. Deze subvideostromen worden secundaire
video genoemd.
Interlace-scanmethode
Bij deze methode wordt een enkel beeld weergegeven door het
Subnet-masker
tweemaal te scannen. De eerste keer worden de oneven lijnen
Dient dient om te herkennen welk deel van het IP-adres
weergegeven en de tweede keer de even lijnen, die dan samen
overeenkomt met het subnet (een afzonderlijk geregeld netwerk).
een enkel beeld (beeldje) vormen. De interlace-scanmethode
Het subnet-masker wordt uitgedrukt als 255.255.255.0.
wordt bij deze disc-speler en in de handleiding aangegeven door
een i na de resolutiewaarde (bijvoorbeeld 576i).
USB (Universele Serile Bus)
Inzetbeeld (P-in-P) USB is de industriestandaard voor het aansluiten van
randapparatuur op personal computers.
Met deze functie kunt u een kleiner bewegend inzetbeeld op de
gewenste plaats in het hoofdvideobeeld laten verschijnen.
Sommige BD-ROM discs bevatten secundaire video, die Vaste (default) gateway
overlappend met het hoofdvideobeeld kan worden weergegeven. Een zgn. default gateway is een communicatie-apparaat zoals
een router die zorgt voor de gegevensuitwisseling tussen
IP-adres netwerken. Dit dient voor het overbrengen van gegevens naar
netwerken waarbij de gateway van bestemming niet precies is
Een adres dat dient ter herkenning van een computer of ander
vermeld.
apparaat dat is aangesloten op Internet of een plaatselijk LAN-
netwerk. Het bestaat uit vier groepen cijfers.
VC-1
Kinderslot Een video-codec die is ontwikkeld door Microsoft en
gestandaardiseerd door de Society of Motion Picture and
Zie pagina 46.
Television Engineers (SMPTE). Sommige Blu-ray discs bevatten
videomateriaal dat is gecodeerd met deze codec.
Lineaire PCM
Dit is een coderingsvorm voor audiosignalen zonder compressie.
x.v.Color
Zie pagina 15.
MAC (Media Access Control) adres
Een apparaat-identificatienummer dat specifiek wordt
toegewezen aan een netwerk-apparaat (een LAN-kaart e.d.).
Poortnummer
Dit is een hulpadres onder het IP-adres om gelijktijdig verbinding
te kunnen maken met meerdere partijen tijdens de Internet-
60 communicatie.
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_NL.book Page 61 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:44 AM
Technische gegevens 08
Model BDP-LX55
BDP-440
BDP-140
Type Blu-ray 3DTM SPELER
Nominale spanning 100 V t/m 240 V wisselstroom
Nominale frequentie 50 Hz/60 Hz
Stroomverbruik BDP-LX55: 25 W
BDP-440, BDP-140: 23 W
Stroomverbruik (ruststand) 0,3 W
Gewicht BDP-LX55: 3,5 kg
BDP-440: 2,6 kg
BDP-140: 2,1 kg
Buitenafmetingen (inclusief uitstekende delen) BDP-LX55: 435 mm (b) x 93 mm (h) x 252 mm (d)
BDP-440: 435 mm (b) x 90 mm (h) x 252 mm (d)
BDP-140: 435 mm (b) x 58 mm (h) x 249 mm (d)
Toegestane bedrijfstemperatuur +5C tot +35C
Toegestane luchtvochtigheid 5% tot 85% (zonder condensatie)
Output Terminal
Opmerking
De technische gegevens en het ontwerp van dit product kunnen vanwege voortgaande verbetering zonder
voorafgaande kennisgeving worden gewijzigd.
2011 PIONEER CORPORATION. Alle rechten voorbehouden.
61
Nl
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 2 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
/HGDPRVODVJUDFLDVSRUODDGTXLVLFLyQGHHVWHSURGXFWR3LRQHHU
/HDDIRQGRHVWDVLQVWUXFFLRQHVGHXWLOL]DFLyQSDUDTXHDSUHQGDDXWLOL]DUFRUUHFWDPHQWHVXPRGHOR'HVSXpVGHKDEHU
WHUPLQDGRGHOHHUHVWDVLQVWUXFFLRQHVJXiUGHODVHQXQOXJDUVHJXURSDUDHQFDVRGHVHUQHFHVDULRFRQVXOWDUODVHQHO
IXWXUR
IMPORTANTE
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
La luz intermitente con el smbolo de punta ATENCIN: El punto exclamativo dentro un tringulo
de flecha dentro un tringulo equiltero. PARA PREVENIR EL PELIGRO DE CHOQUE equiltero convenido para avisar el usurio
Est convenido para avisar el usuario de la ELCTRICO NO REMOVER LA TAPA NI LAS de la presencia de importantes
presencia de voltaje peligrosa no aislada PARTES DENTRO NO UTILIZADAS, instrucciones sobre el funcionamiento y la
dentro el producto que podra constituir un LLAMAR UNA PERSONA CUALIFICADA. manutencin en la libreta que acompaa el
peligro de choque elctrico para las aparato.
personas.
D3-4-2-1-1_A1_Es
ADVERTENCIA
Para evitar el peligro de incendio, no ponga nada con
fuego encendido (como pueda ser una vela) encima del
aparato.
D3-4-2-1-7a_A1_Es
K058a_A1_Es
!DVERTENCIASPARALAVISIN$
p 3INOTACUALQUIERFATIGAOMALESTARMIENTRASESTVIENDOIMGENES$DEJEDEVERLAS
p ,OSNIOSPARTICULARMENTELOSMENORESDEAOSPUEDEQUESEANMSPROPENSOSALASENSIBILIDADASQUELAS
PERSONASQUELOSTENGANASUCARGODEBERNOBSERVARLOSPORSIMUESTRANCUALQUIERSEALDEFATIGAOMALESTAR
p #UANDOESTVIENDOIMGENES$DESCANSEPERIDICAMENTE
,AVISINPROLONGADADEIMGENES$SINNINGNDESCANSOPODRACAUSARFATIGAOMALESTAR
3
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 4 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Contenido
01 Antes de comenzar Utilizando el men FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Contenido de la caja . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Reproduccin desde un tiempo especfico
Colocacin de las pilas en el control remoto . . . . . . . . 5 (Bsqueda con tiempo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Actualizacin del software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Reproduccin de un ttulo, captulo o pista
Acerca de la operacin de este reproductor desde especfico (Bsqueda) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
un aparato mvil (iPod, iPhone, iPad, etc.) . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Reproduccin de la gama especificada de discos,
Tipos de discos/archivos que se pueden reproducir . . . 7 ttulos o captulos (pistas/archivos)
Discos que se pueden reproducir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 en orden aleatorio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Archivos que pueden reproducirse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Reproduccin continua desde una posicin
Nombres y funciones de los controles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 especfica (Reproduccin de visin continua) . . . . . . 33
Control remoto. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 05 Reproduccin desde Home Media Gallery
Panel frontal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Acerca de Home Media Gallery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Panel trasero . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Acerca de la reproduccin de la red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
02 Conexin DLNA Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Conexin usando un cable HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Reproduccin de disco/USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Acerca de HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Reproduccin de archivos de imgenes. . . . . . . . . . . 36
Acerca de la funcin de control con HDMI . . . . . . . . 16 Reproduccin en el orden deseado (Playlist) . . . . . . . . 36
Conexin de un TV. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Adicin de pistas/archivos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Conexin de un amplificador o receptor AV . . . . . . . . 18 Reproduccin del Playlist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Conexin de cables de vdeo y audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Eliminacin de pistas/archivos del Playlist. . . . . . . . . 37
Conexin de un TV usando un cable de 06 Reproduccin de contenido de Web
vdeo/audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Contenido de Web disponible. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Conexin de un amplificador o receptor AV usando Reproduccin de los elementos. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
un cable de audio digital ptico. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Conexin de componentes al puerto USB . . . . . . . . . . 20
07 Ajustes avanzados
Cambio de los ajustes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Acerca de los aparatos de memoria USB. . . . . . . . . . 20
Utilizacin de la pantalla Initial Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Conexin de un aparato de memoria USB . . . . . . . . . 21
Actualizacin del software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Conexin a la red mediante la interfaz LAN . . . . . . . . . 21
Restablecimiento de todos los ajustes a los
Conexin a una LAN inalmbrica . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
ajustes predeterminados en fbrica . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Conexin del cable de alimentacin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Tabla de cdigos de idioma y tabla de cdigos
03 Operaciones a realizar de pases/rea . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Ajustes utilizando el men Setup Navigator . . . . . . . . . 23
08 Informacin adicional
Control del TV con el mando a distancia del Aviso sobre las licencias de software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
reproductor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Cuidados para el uso. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Lista de cdigos de preajuste del TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Desplazamiento del reproductor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
04 Reproduccin Lugar de instalacin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Reproduccin de discos o archivos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Desconecte la alimentacin cuando no use
Exploracin hacia adelante o hacia atrs . . . . . . . . . . 27 el reproductor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Reproduccin de captulos o pistas especficos . . . . 27 Condensacin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Salto del contenido . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Limpieza del reproductor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Reproduccin a velocidad lenta . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Cuidados para cuando la unidad se instala
Paso adelante y paso hacia atrs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 en una estantera cerrada con puerta de cristal . . . . 53
Repeticin de reproduccin de una seccin Limpieza de la lente lectora . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
especfica dentro de un ttulo o pista Manejo de los discos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
(Repeticin A-B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Solucin de problemas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Reproduccin repetida (Repeticin de Reproduccin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
reproduccin) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Funcin de control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Reproduccin en el orden deseado Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
(Reproduccin programada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Otros. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Para hacer marcadores . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Glosario. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Zoom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Especificaciones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Visualizacin de imgenes miniatura . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Cambio de ngulos de cmara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Cambio de los subttulos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Visualizacin de informacin del disco. . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Cambio de audio y audio secundario . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Cambio del vdeo secundario. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Para disfrutar de BONUSVIEW o BD-LIVE . . . . . . . . . 30
Funciones de reproduccin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
4
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 5 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Captulo 1 01
Antes de comenzar
Contenido de la caja ADVERTENCIA
No utilice ni guarde las pilas a la luz solar directa ni
Control remoto x 1 en otros lugares de mucho calor como, por ejemplo,
Cable de vdeo/audio (clavijas amarilla/blanca/roja) dentro de un automvil o cerca de una calefaccin.
x1 Esto podra provocar que las pilas tuvieran prdidas,
se sobrecalentaran, explotaran o se prendieran.
Pilas AAA/R03 x 2 Tambin puede reducir la vida o rendimiento de las
Tarjeta de garanta mismas.
Cable de alimentacin
Manual de instrucciones (este manual) Aviso
No utilice otras pilas que no sean las especificadas.
Colocacin de las pilas en el Adems, no utilice una pila nueva junto con otra
control remoto usada.
Cuando cargue las pilas en el control remoto,
1 Abra la cubierta trasera. colquelas en el sentido apropiado, como se indica
mediante las polaridades ( y ).
No caliente las pilas, no las desarme ni tire al fuego o
al agua.
Las pilas, aunque parezcan similares, pueden tener
Presione tensiones diferentes. No use juntas pilas de clases
ligeramente esta diferentes.
parte y deslcela en el
sentido de la flecha. Para impedir la fuga del lquido de las pilas, retrelas
si no piensa usar el mando a distancia durante
mucho tiempo (1 mes o ms). Si escapa el lquido de
2 Introduzca las pilas (AAA/R03 x 2).
las pilas, limpie cuidadosamente el interior del
Introdzcalas en su compartimento como indican las
compartimiento e introduzca pilas nuevas. Si una pila
marcas /.
tuviera una fuga de electrlito y ste tocase su piel,
limpie la parte afectada con mucha agua.
Cuando tenga que deshacerse de las pilas usadas,
cumpla los reglamentos gubernamentales o a las
Introduzca primero el
lado negativo (). disposiciones en materia ambiental en vigor en su
pas o rea.
5
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 6 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
01 Actualizacin del
software
En el sitio Web de Pioneer se ofrece informacin de este
reproductor. Visite este sitio Web para actualizar y
obtener informacin de servicio de su reproductor de Blu-
ray Disc.
En Europa:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
En R.U.:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer.co.uk/
En Rusia:
http://www.pioneer.eu/
http://www.pioneer-rus.ru/
En Hong Kong:
http://www.pioneerhongkong.com.hk/
En Singapur:
http://www.pioneer.com.sg/firmwaredownload
En Australia
http://www.pioneer.com.au/
Acerca de la operacin
de este reproductor
desde un aparato
mvil (iPod, iPhone,
iPad, etc.)
El reproductor se puede controlar desde un aparato mvil
instalando una aplicacin especial en el aparato mvil.
Para conocer detalles, consulte la informacin del
producto en el sitio Web de Pioneer.
Esta aplicacin especial puede cambiar o cancelarse sin
previo aviso.
6
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 7 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Aviso
Slo se pueden reproducir los discos que han sido finalizados.
Formato de aplicacin
Tipo de disco Logotipo DVD- DVD- CD-DA DATA-
BDMV BDAV DVD VR
Vdeo Audio DTS-CD DISC1
BD-ROM
BD-R
BD2
BD-RE
DVD-ROM 3
DVD
DVD-R2,4,5 6 7
DVD-RW4,8 6 7
DVD+R2.4
DVD+RW4
CD-DA
(Audio CD)9
CD
CD-R4
CD-RW4
CD-ROM
1. Discos con archivos de vdeo, imagen o audio grabados. Este reproductor no soporta discos ni grabaciones tipo multisesin.
2. Incluyendo discos de dos capas.
3. BDP-LX55 y BDP-440 solamente.
4. Finalcelos antes de reproducirlos en este reproductor.
5. Los DVD-R para discos de autora (3,95 y 4,7 GB) no se pueden reproducir.
6. Incluyendo el formato AVCHD.
7. Incluyendo el formato AVCREC.
8. Los discos DVD-RW Version 1.0 no se pueden reproducir.
9. Incluyendo Video CD.
7
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 8 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Los nombres de corporaciones y productos Blu-ray Disc Recordable (R) Format Version 2
mencionados aqu son marcas de fbrica o marcas Blu-ray Disc Rewritable (RE) Format Version 3
registradas de sus corporaciones respectivas.
Este reproductor soporta BD-ROM Profile 5.
Discos que no se pueden reproducir
HD DVD
Discos DVD-RAM
Es posible que algunos discos distintos de los
enumerados ms arriba tampoco se puedan reproducir. Los logotipos Blu-ray 3D y Blu-ray 3D son marcas
de fbrica de Blu-ray Disc Association.
Nota Se pueden usar las funciones BONUSVIEW de
Algunos discos no podrn reproducirse, aunque se reproduccin de vdeo secundario (imagen en
indique uno de los logotipos de la pgina anterior. imagen) y de audio secundario. Los datos usados con
Para reproducir discos de 8 cm, ponga esos discos en las funciones BONUSVIEW (datos de vdeo
el hueco del centro de la bandeja de discos. No es secundario (imagen en imagen) y de audio
necesario usar un adaptador. Los discos BD-ROM de secundario) pueden guardarse en la memoria. Para
8 cm no se pueden reproducir. conocer detalles de la reproduccin de vdeo y audio
secundarios, consulte las instrucciones del disco.
Acerca de los formatos de audio
Este reproductor soporta los formatos de audio
siguientes: BONUSVIEW es una marca de fbrica de Blu-ray Disc
Dolby TrueHD Association.
Dolby Digital Plus Las funciones BD-LIVE, como la descarga de avances
Dolby Digital de pelculas o audio e idiomas de subttulos
DTS-HD Master Audio adicionales y la reproduccin de juegos en lnea, se
pueden disfrutar por Internet. Los datos descargados
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio con la funcin BD-LIVE (avances, etc.) se guardan en
DTS Digital Surround la memoria. Consulte las instrucciones del disco para
Audio MPEG (AAC) conocer detalles de las funciones BD-LIVE.
Linear PCM
Para disfrutar del sonido envolvente de Dolby TrueHD,
Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio y DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio se recomienda conectar el reproductor
a un amplificador o receptor AV compatible con estos
El logotipo BD-LIVE es una marca de fbrica de Blu-
formatos de audio usando un cable HDMI. Despus de
ray Disc Association.
introducir un BD con sonido de estos formatos de audio,
seleccione el formato de audio en la pantalla del men.
Fabricado bajo licencia de Dolby Laboratories. Dolby y el
smbolo de la doble D son marcas comerciales de Dolby
Laboratories.
Fabricado bajo licencia con patentes de los EE.UU.
nmeros: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535;
7,392,195; 7,272,567; 7,333,929; 7,212,872 y otras patentes
de los EE.UU. y el resto del mundo emitidas y pendientes.
DTS-HD, el smbolo y DTS-HD y el smbolo juntos son
marcas registradas y DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential es
una marca de fbrica de DTS, Inc. El producto incluye
software. DTS, Inc. Todos los derechos reservados.
8
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 9 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Con BD-ROM es posible usar las aplicaciones BD-J Acerca de los nmeros de regin
(Java) para crear ttulos altamente interactivos, 01
El Reproductor de Blu-ray Disc y los discos BD-ROM o
incluyendo juegos, por ejemplo.
DVD-Video tienen asignados nmeros de regin segn la
regin en que se venden.
Los nmeros de regin de este reproductor son:
BD-ROM: B
DVD-Vdeo: 2
Los discos que no incluyen estos nmeros no se pueden
reproducir. Abajo se muestran los discos que se pueden
reproducir en este reproductor.
BD: B (incluyendo B) y ALL
DVD: 2 (incluyendo 2) y ALL
Oracle y Java son marcas registradas de Oracle y/o sus
afiliadas. Otros nombres pueden ser marcas de fbrica Reproduccin de CD
de sus propietarios respectivos. Acerca de los CD protegidos contra la copia: Este
Se pueden reproducir discos BD (BDAV) compatibles reproductor ha sido diseado para cumplir con las
con los formatos de abajo. especificaciones del formato Audio CD. Este reproductor
Blu-ray Disc Recordable (R) Format Version 1 no soporta la reproduccin ni las funciones de los discos
que no satisfacen estas especificaciones.
Blu-ray Disc Rewritable (RE) Format Version 2
Reproduccin de DualDisc
Reproduccin de DVD
Un DualDisc es un disco de dos caras: una con contenido
DVD vdeo, audio, etc. y la otra sin contenido DVD
como, por ejemplo, grabaciones de audio digital.
En este reproductor se puede reproducir el lado DVD de
Esta etiqueta indica la compatibilidad de reproduccin con los discos DualDisc.
los discos DVD-RW grabados en el formato VR (formato de El lado de audio del disco que no es DVD no es
grabacin de vdeo). Sin embargo, para los discos grabados compatible con este reproductor.
con un programa encriptado de una sola grabacin, la Existe la posibilidad de que cuando se introduzca o
reproduccin slo se podr hacer usando un aparato expulse un DualDisc, la cara opuesta a la de
compatible con CPRM. reproduccin se raye. Los discos rayados no se pueden
El AVCHD es un formato de videocmara digital de alta reproducir.
definicin (HD) que permite grabar con alta definicin en
Para obtener ms informacin sobre la especificacin
ciertos medios usando tecnologas de codificacin y
DualDisc, consulte con el fabricante o el representante
decodificacin de alta eficacia.
del producto.
9
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 10 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3
001.jpg/001.mp3
DivX, DivX Certified, DivX PlusTM HD y los logotipos
asociados son marcas de fbrica de DivX, Inc. y se usan
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3 *
bajo licencia.
Carpeta XX 001.jpg/001.mp3 *
xxx.jpg/xxx.mp3 Nota
* El nmero de carpetas y archivos dentro de una sola carpeta Este aparato DivX homologado deber registrarse
(incluyendo el directorio raz) se limita a un mximo de 256. para reproducir contenido DivX sobre demanda
Mantenga el nmero de capas de carpetas en un mximo de 5. (VOD). Genere primero el cdigo de registro DivX
VOD para su aparato y presntelo durante el proceso
Nota de registro. Importante: El contenido DivX VOD est
protegido por un sistema DivX DRM (administracin
Los nombres de archivos y carpetas visualizados en de derechos digitales) que limita la reproduccin a
este reproductor pueden ser diferentes de los los aparatos DivX homologados registrados. Si
visualizados en un ordenador. intenta reproducir contenido DivX VOD no autorizado
para su aparato, se visualizar el mensaje
Archivos que pueden Authorization Error y su contenido no se
reproducirse reproducir. Obtenga ms informacin en
www.divx.com/vod.
Los archivos de vdeo, imagen y audio grabados en DVD El cdigo de registro DivX VOD de este reproductor
y CD se pueden reproducir. se puede verificar en HOME MENU Initial
Setup Playback DivX(R) VOD DRM
Aviso Registration Code (pgina 42).
En los DVD slo se pueden reproducir los grabados El nmero de vistas est limitado para algunos
con el sistema de archivos ISO 9660. archivos DivX VOD. Cuando se reproducen tales
Algunos archivos no se pueden reproducir. archivos en este reproductor se visualiza el nmero
de vistas restante. Los archivos cuyo nmero
Con algunos archivos tal vez no se puedan usar restante de vistas ha alcanzado 0 no se pueden
ciertas funciones durante la reproduccin. reproducir (se visualiza This DivX rental has
Puede que no sea posible reproducir algunos expired). Los archivos cuyo nmero de vistas no
archivos, aunque stos tengan la extensin de esta limitado se pueden reproducir tantas veces
archivo que puede reproducirse en este reproductor. como se quiera (el nmero restante de vistas no se
Los archivos protegidos por DRM (Digital Rights visualiza).
10 Management) no se pueden reproducir (sin incluir
archivos DivX VOD).
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 11 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
MKV
Se pueden reproducir archivos MKV.
Nombres y funciones 01
MKV es un formato de archivo que permite tener de los controles
mltiples archivos de audio y vdeo en un solo
archivo.
Los archivos que se pueden reproducir son los Control remoto
siguientes:
Resolucin: Hasta 1 280 x 720 19
Extensin: .mkv o .MKV 1 20
Vdeo Windows Media (WMV) 2
Se pueden reproducir archivos de vdeo Windows
Media (WMV).
Los archivos que se pueden reproducir son los 3 21
siguientes:
Resolucin: Hasta 1 280 x 720
Extensin: wmv o WMV 22
Archivos codificados con Windows Media Las 4 23
series 9 de codificador son compatibles. 5 24
Windows Media es una marca registrada o una 6 25
marca de fbrica de Microsoft Corporation en los 7
Estados Unidos y/u otros pases.
8 26
Este producto incluye tecnologa propiedad de
Microsoft Corporation, y no se puede usar ni
9
distribuir sin una licencia de Microsoft Licensing,
Inc.
10 27
Formatos de archivos de imagen
soportados 28
JPEG 11 29
12
JPEG progresivo 30
13
Formato de archivo: JFIF Ver. 1.02/Exif Ver. 2.2 14 31
Resolucin: Hasta 4 096 x 4 096 pxeles 32
15 33
Formatos de archivos de audio 34
soportados 35
16 36
Windows Media Audio 9 (WMA9)
Velocidad de bits: Hasta 192 kbps 17 37
Frecuencias de muestreo: 22,05 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz 18 38
y 48 kHz
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3)
Velocidad de bits: Hasta 320 kbps
Frecuencias de muestreo: 8 kHz, 11,025 kHz, 12 kHz,
16 kHz, 22,05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44,1 kHz y 48 kHz
1 STANDBY/ON Pulse para conectar y
Codificador/decodificador libre de compresin de desconectar la alimentacin.
audio sin prdida (FLAC) (Slo para el BDP-LX55)
Frecuencias de muestreo: 96 kHz a 192 kHz 2 CONTINUED Se usa para continuar la reproduccin
Velocidad de bits de cuantificacin: 16 bits, 24 bits desde una posicin especfica. (pgina 33)
Canales: 2 canales 3 TV CONTROL (pgina 24)
Extensiones de archivos que pueden 4 AUDIO (pgina 29)
reproducirse
Archivos de vdeo
.divx, .mkv, .wmv y .avi
Archivos de imagen
.jpg y .jpeg
Archivos de audio
.wma y .mp3
.flac (BDP-LX55 solamente)
11
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 12 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Panel frontal 01
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 6 7 8 9 10 11
BDP-140
1 3 4 6 8 9 10 11
13
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 14 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
01 Panel trasero
BDP-LX55
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BDP-440
1 2 3 4 5 6 8
BDP-140
3 4 2 1 5 6 8
1 Terminal(es) HDMI OUT (ms abajo y pgina 15) 5 Terminal LAN (10/100) (pgina 21)
2 Terminales VIDEO OUTPUT (pgina 20) 6 Puerto USB (pgina 20)
3 Terminal DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL) (pgina 20) 7 Terminal RS-232C (BDP-LX55 solamente) Este
terminal no se usa.
4 Terminales AUDIO OUTPUT (pgina 20)
8 AC IN (pgina 22)
Nota
No se puede dar salida a la seal de vdeo a travs del terminal SUB. Asegrese de conectar su TV al terminal
MAIN.
14
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 15 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Captulo 2 02
Conexin
Asegrese de desconectar la alimentacin y desenchufar Este producto es compatible con x.v.Color, el cual tiene
el cable de alimentacin de la toma de corriente siempre la capacidad de lograr un espacio cromtico de amplia
que haga o cambie conexiones. gama basado en las especificaciones xvYCC.
Despus de conectar, haga los ajustes en el men Setup Reproducir seales de vdeo que cumplen con las
Navigator o Initial Setup segn el tipo del cable normas xvYCC en este reproductor, estando ste
conectado (pgina 23). conectado a un TV compatible con x.v.Color, etc.,
expande la capacidad de reproducir color, y permite
Consulte tambin el manual de instrucciones del aparato reproducir los colores naturales fielmente.
que est siendo conectado. x.v.Color es nombre de promocin dado a los productos
que pueden lograr un espacio cromtico de amplia gama
Nota basado en especificaciones de normas internacionales
definidas como xvYCC.
Las ilustraciones que se usan aqu son
principalmente para el BDP-LX55.
Conexin usando un
cable HDMI
x.v.Color y son marcas de fbrica de
Las seales de audio y vdeo se pueden transferir a Sony Corporation.
aparatos compatibles con HDMI como seales digitales
sin prdida de calidad de audio o vdeo. Seales de audio reproducibles por
el terminal HDMI OUT
Nota
Dolby TrueHD
Para el BDP-LX55, haga el ajuste del HDMI Mode en Dolby Digital Plus
el men Initial Setup de acuerdo con la conexin de
los aparatos al reproductor (pginas 16 y 41). Dolby Digital
DTS-HD Master Audio
Haga los ajustes en el men Setup Navigator segn
el aparato compatible con HDMI que est conectado DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
(pgina 23). DTS Digital Surround
Dependiendo del cable HDMI que est siendo usado MPEG-2 AAC
puede que no salgan las seales de vdeo de 1080p. Linear PCM
Acerca de HDMI Pueden salir las seales de audio Linear PCM que
cumplan las condiciones siguientes:
Este reproductor incorpora la tecnologa High-Definition Frecuencia de muestreo: 32 kHz a 192 kHz
Multimedia Interface (HDMI). Nmero de canales: Hasta 8 (hasta 6 para una
frecuencia de muestreo de 192 kHz)
15
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 16 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
17
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 18 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
02 Conexin de un TV BDP-440/BDP-140
Panel posterior del BDP-440
Vea Conexin de un amplificador o receptor AV en la
columna de la derecha para conectar un amplificador o
receptor AV con un cable HDMI.
Aviso
Sujete la clavija cuando conecte y desconecte el
cable.
Aplicar una carga a la clavija puede causar un
comercio)
(de venta en el
Cable HDMI
contacto defectuoso y evitar que salgan seales de
Introduzca la clavija en
vdeo. el terminal sin torcerla.
Al terminal
BDP-LX55 de entrada
HDMI Tambin es posible conectar a un
Conecte un TV al terminal HDMI OUT (MAIN). amplificador o receptor AV usando un
cable HDMI (ms abajo).
Panel posterior del BDP-LX55
Conexin de un amplificador
o receptor AV
Conecte a un amplificador o receptor AV para disfrutar
del sonido envolvente de Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital
comercio)
(de venta en el
Cable HDMI
Aviso
Asegrese de conectar un TV al terminal HDMI OUT
(MAIN), las seales de vdeo no pueden salir por el
terminal HDMI OUT (SUB).
Asegrese de poner HDMI Mode en Single
(pgina 41).
18
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 19 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
BDP-LX55
Aviso 02
Panel posterior del BDP-LX55
Asegrese de conectar un TV al terminal HDMI OUT
(MAIN), las seales de vdeo no pueden salir por el
terminal HDMI OUT (SUB).
Asegrese de poner HDMI Mode en Separate
(pgina 41).
Si el amplificador AV conectado al terminal HDMI
OUT (SUB) tambin est conectado a un TV, la
Cable HDMI entrada del TV puede que cambie automticamente.
(de venta en el Si pasa esto, desactive la funcin de control con
comercio)
HDMI en el TV.
entrada HDMI
Al terminal de
Amplificador
Introduzca la
clavija en el
o receptor AV BDP-440/BDP-140
terminal sin Panel posterior del BDP-440
torcerla.
Amplificador
o receptor AV
Introduzca la
clavija en el
Sentido del flujo de seales terminal sin
Al terminal de torcerla.
Televisor entrada HDMI
Amplificador
Para obtener una mejor calidad de vdeo y de audio o receptor AV
Cuando conecte un TV (o proyector) y un amplificador AV
comercio)
(de venta en el
Cable HDMI
Cable HDMI
(de venta en el
comercio)
entrada HDMI
Al terminal de
AV receiver
Introduzca la or amplifier
clavija en el
terminal sin
torcerla.
Televisor
19
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 20 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
venta en el
Aviso comercio) Tambin se puede
Al terminal de conectar audio
Conecte directamente la salida de vdeo del entrada de audio analgico de 2 canales.
reproductor a su TV. digital ptico A los terminales de entrada de audio
Este reproductor soporta la tecnologa de proteccin Amplificador o
de copia analgica. Por lo tanto, la imagen puede que receptor AV Sentido del flujo de seales
no se visualice correctamente si este reproductor se
conecta a un TV a travs de una grabadora/platina de Nota
vdeo DVD o cuando se reproduce el material de
salida del reproductor que ha sido grabado en una Para cambiar el vdeo del amplificador o receptor AV,
grabadora/platina de vdeo DVD. Adems, la imagen conecte tambin los terminales de salida de vdeo.
puede que no se visualice correctamente debido a la
proteccin contra copia cuando el reproductor se
conecta a un TV con platina de vdeo incorporada.
Conexin de
Para conocer detalles, pngase en contacto con el componentes al puerto
USB
fabricante de su TV.
Panel posterior del BDP-LX55
20
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 21 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Enrutador
LAN
3 2 1 WAN
PC
Aparato de memoria
USB
Cable LAN
(de venta en el comercio)
Panel posterior del BDP-LX55 Conecte el terminal LAN de este receptor al terminal LAN
de su enrutador (con o sin la funcin del servidor DHCP
incorporada) con un cable LAN recto (CAT 5 o mejor).
Active la funcin del servidor DHCP en su enrutador. En
el caso de que su enrutador no tenga la funcin del
servidor DHCP incorporada, ser necesario preparar
manualmente la red. Para conocer detalles, consulte
Puesta de la direccin IP en la pgina 44.
Aparato de memoria
USB Especificaciones del terminal LAN
Terminal LAN : Conector Ethernet (10BASE-T/100BASE-
TX)
Nota Nota
Los aparatos pueden no funcionar si se conectan al Consulte el manual de instrucciones de su equipo
puerto USB a travs de un lector de tarjetas de porque el equipo conectado y el mtodo de conexin
memoria o un concentrador USB. pueden cambiar dependiendo de su entorno de
Internet.
Cuando use una conexin de Internet de banda
ancha necesitar firmar un contrato con un
proveedor de servicios de Internet. Para conocer ms
detalles, contacte al proveedor de servicios de
Internet ms cercano.
21
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 22 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Internet
Cable de alimentacin
(incluido) A una toma de
corriente
Mdem
WAN
Convertidor de LAN
inalmbrica
(AS-WL300) DC 5V Ethernet WPS
22
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 23 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Captulo 3 03
Operaciones a realizar
Ajustes utilizando el 3 Empiece Setup Navigator.
Pulse ENTER.
men Setup Navigator Setup Navigator empieza.
4 Seleccione el idioma de la OSD.
Asegrese de hacer estos ajustes cuando use el
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
reproductor en las situaciones siguientes.
Cuando un TV de pantalla plana Pioneer compatible con
Cuando use el reproductor por primera vez.
la funcin de control se conecte al terminal HDMI OUT
Despus de formatear Initial Setup. de este reproductor, los ajustes de idiomas se importarn
Despus de actualizar el software del reproductor. del TV de pantalla plana Pioneer antes de empezar Setup
Navigator.
Aviso 5 Seleccione la resolucin de salida apropiada para
Antes de conectar la alimentacin, verifique que las el TV conectado.
conexiones entre el reproductor y otros aparatos Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
estn bien hechas. Adems, conecte la alimentacin 6 Seleccione el aspecto apropiado para el TV
de los aparatos conectados al reproductor antes de conectado.
conectar la alimentacin del reproductor. Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
Cuando use un TV de pantalla plana o un proyector
7 Cierre el men Setup Navigator.
frontal Pioneer compatibles con la funcin de control,
Pulse ENTER.
active el control en el aparato conectado antes de
encender el reproductor. Setup Navigator termina y se guarda el ajuste.
Pulse RETURN para volver a la pantalla anterior.
Nota
Cuando un TV de pantalla plana o proyector frontal
Pioneer compatible con la funcin de control se
conecte al reproductor con un cable HDMI, el
reproductor se pondr automticamente en el modo
de calidad de imagen ptima para el aparato
conectado.
23
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 24 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
PHILCO 32, 42
PHILIPS 31, 07, 34, 56, 68
SONOLOR 31, 35
SONTEC 07
03
PHOENIX 32 SONY 04
PHONOLA 07 SOUNDWAVE 07
PROFEX 42, 44 STANDARD 41, 44
PROTECH 07, 42, 44, 46, 49 STERN 31
QUELLE 31, 32, 07, 42, 45, 53 SUSUMU 41
R-LINE 07 SYSLINE 07
RADIOLA 07 TANDY 31, 41, 48
RADIOSHACK 10, 23, 21, 02 TASHIKO 34
RBM 53 TATUNG 07, 48
RCA 01, 10, 15, 16, 17, 18, 61, 62, TEC 42
09 TELEAVIA 36
REDIFFUSION 32, 42 TELEFUNKEN 36, 37, 52
REX 31, 46 TELETECH 44
ROADSTAR 41, 44, 46 TENSAI 40, 41
SABA 31, 36, 42, 51 THOMSON 36, 51, 52, 63
SAISHO 39, 44, 46 THORN 31, 07, 42, 45, 48
SALORA 31, 32, 42, 43 TOMASHI 18
SAMBERS 49 TOSHIBA 05, 02, 26, 21, 53
SAMSUNG 07, 38, 44, 46, 69, 70 TOWADA 42
SANYO 35, 45, 48, 21, 14, 91 ULTRAVOX 32, 42, 49
SBR 07, 34 UNIDEN 92
SCHAUB LORENZ 42 UNIVERSUM 31, 07, 38, 42, 45,
SCHNEIDER 07, 41, 47 46, 54
SEG 42, 46 VESTEL 07
SEI 32, 40, 49 VICTOR 13
SELECO 31, 42 VOXSON 31
SHARP 02, 19, 27, 67, 90 WALTHAM 43
SIAREM 32, 49 WATSON 07
SIEMENS 31 WATT RADIO 32, 42, 49
SINUDYNE 32, 39, 40, 49 WHITE WESTINGHOUSE 07
SKANTIC 43 YOKO 07, 42, 46
SOLAVOX 31 ZENITH 03, 20
SONOKO 07, 44
25
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 26 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
04 Captulo 4
Reproduccin
La pantalla de introduccin del cdigo PIN aparece
cuando se carga un BD con restricciones de uso
establecidas por el grabador BD. En este caso,
introduzca su cdigo PIN.
3 Pulse PLAY para reproducir el disco.
Para hacer una pausa, pulse PAUSE durante la
reproduccin.
Para parar, pulse STOP durante la reproduccin.
Nota
Algunos discos empiezan a reproducirse
automticamente cuando se cierra la bandeja del
disco.
Los discos DVD-Video tienen funciones de bloqueo de
los padres. Introduzca la contrasea registrada en los
ajustes del reproductor para desbloquear el bloqueo
de los padres. Para conocer detalles, consulte
pgina 46.
Reanudacin de la reproduccin
desde donde fue detenida (funcin de
reanudacin de reproduccin)
Cuando se pulsa STOP durante la reproduccin, el
punto donde se para el disco se almacena en la
memoria. Cuando se pulsa PLAY despus de eso,
Reproduccin de
la reproduccin se reanuda desde ese punto.
Para cancelar la funcin de reanudacin, pulse
discos o archivos STOP mientras la reproduccin est parada.
26
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 27 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
28
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 29 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
04 Cambio del vdeo secundario Si se usa un aparato de memoria USB que contiene
otros datos (grabados previamente), puede que el
Use el procedimiento de abajo para cambiar el vdeo audio y el vdeo no se reproduzcan bien.
secundario (imagen en imagen) grabado en el BD-ROM. No desconecte el aparato de memoria USB durante
Durante la reproduccin, pulse 2nd VIDEO. la reproduccin.
El vdeo secundario actual y el nmero total de series Para cargar (leer/escribir) los datos se necesita algo
de vdeo secundario grabadas se visualizan en la de tiempo.
pantalla del TV.
Para cambiar el vdeo secundario, pulse de nuevo Aviso
2nd VIDEO.
Si no hay suficiente espacio en el aparato de memoria
USB puede que no sea posible usar las funciones
BONUSVIEW y BD-LIVE. En este caso, consulte
Borrado de datos que han sido aadidos a BD y datos
de aplicacin en la pgina 45 para borrar los datos de
Virtual Package y los datos de BD-LIVE del aparato de
memoria USB.
El vdeo secundario tambin se puede cambiar El funcionamiento de los aparatos de memoria USB
seleccionando Secondary Video desde el men no est garantizado.
FUNCTION. La reproduccin de los datos de la funcin BD-LIVE
Si el vdeo secundario no cambia cuando se pulsa cambia segn el disco usado. Para conocer detalles,
2nd VIDEO, cmbielo desde la pantalla del men del consulte las instrucciones del usuario suministradas
disco. con el disco.
Para disfrutar de la funcin BD-LIVE se necesita
Apagado del vdeo secundario conectar a la red y hacer ajustes (pginas 21 y 44).
BD-LIVE es una funcin que proporciona conexin a
Pulse 2nd VIDEO varias veces o seleccione Internet. Los discos compatibles con la funcin BD-
Secondary Video desde el men FUNCTION para LIVE puede que enven cdigos ID con los que el
cambiar el ajuste a Off. proveedor de contenido a travs de Internet
identifique este reproductor y el disco.
Para disfrutar de
BONUSVIEW o BD-LIVE
Este reproductor es compatible con BD-Video
BONUSVIEW y BD-LIVE.
Cuando se usan discos BD-Video compatibles con
BONUSVIEW se puede disfrutar de funciones como vdeo
secundario (imagen en imagen) (ms arriba) y audio
secundario (pgina 29). Con discos BD-Video
compatibles con BD-LIVE se pueden descargar de
Internet imgenes de vdeo especiales y otros datos.
Los datos grabados en vdeo BD y descargados de BD-
LIVE se guardan en el aparato de memoria USB (memoria
externa). Para disfrutar de estas funciones, conecte al
puerto USB un aparato de memoria USB (capacidad
mnima de 1 GB, se recomiendan 2 GB o ms) compatible
con USB 2.0 High Speed (480 Mbit/s).
Cuando inserte o desconecte un aparato de memoria
USB, asegrese de apagar el reproductor.
Para recuperar datos guardados en el aparato de
memoria USB, inserte primero el disco que fue usado
para descargar los datos (si se carga un disco
diferente, los datos guardados en el aparato de
memoria USB no se podrn reproducir).
30
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 31 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Funciones de reproduccin 04
Las funciones que pueden usarse cambian segn el tipo de disco y el archivo. En algunos casos no se pueden usar
algunas de las funciones. Verifique en la tabla de abajo las funciones que pueden usarse.
Tipo de disco/archivo
DVD-R
Funcin 1
DVD- Archivo Archivo Archivo
BD- BD-R DVD- /-RW Audio
AVCREC AVCHD de de de
ROM /-RE Vdeo Audio2 (Formato vdeo imgenes audio
CD
VR)
Exploracin hacia
adelante o hacia 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5
atrs3
Reproduccin de
ttulos, captulos o
pistas especficos
Salto del contenido
Reproduccin
7
lenta3,6
Paso adelante y paso
8
hacia atrs3
Repeticin de
reproduccin A-B3
Repeticin de
reproduccin
Zoom
ngulo9
Subttulos10
Audio11
Audio secundario12 13
Vdeo secundario14 15
Informacin del
disco
1. Algunas funciones pueden no activarse para algunos discos o archivos, aunque se indique [] en la tabla.
2. Excepto el BDP-140.
3. Para algunos discos, la reproduccin normal se reanuda automticamente cuando se cambian captulos.
4. Durante la exploracin en avance o retroceso no se produce sonido.
5. Durante la exploracin en avance o retroceso se produce sonido.
6. Durante la reproduccin a velocidad lenta no sale sonido.
Durante la reproduccin a velocidad lenta en retroceso no se puede cambiar la velocidad.
7. La reproduccin a velocidad lenta en retroceso no es posible.
8. La reproduccin a pasos en retroceso no es posible.
9. La marca de ngulo se visualiza para las escenas grabadas desde mltiples ngulos si Angle Mark se pone en On (pgina 42).
10. Los tipos de subttulos grabados dependen del disco y el archivo.
En algunos casos, los subttulos pueden cambiar o la pantalla de cambio provista en el disco puede visualizarse inmediatamente, sin que
se visualicen los subttulos actuales o el nmero total de subttulos grabados en el disco.
11. Los tipos de series de audio grabadas dependen del disco y el archivo.
12. Los tipos de series de audio secundario grabadas dependen del disco y el archivo.
En algunos casos, el audio secundario puede cambiar o la pantalla de cambio provista en el disco puede visualizarse inmediatamente, sin
que se visualice el audio secundario actual o el nmero total de series de audio secundario grabadas en el disco.
La marca de audio secundario se visualiza para las escenas grabadas con audio secundario si Secondary Audio Mark se pone en On
(pgina 42).
13. Algunos discos no incluyen audio secundario.
14. En algunos casos, el vdeo secundario puede cambiar o la pantalla de cambio provista en el disco puede visualizarse inmediatamente, sin
que se visualice el vdeo secundario actual o el nmero total de series de vdeo secundario grabadas en el disco.
La marca de vdeo secundario se visualiza para las escenas grabadas con vdeo secundario si PIP Mark se pone en On (pgina 42).
15. Algunos discos no incluyen vdeo secundario.
31
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 32 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Se pueden recuperar varias funciones segn el estado de Replay Salto de 10 segundos hacia atrs.
funcionamiento del reproductor. Slide Show Cambie la velocidad de reproduccin
mientras reproduce diaporamas.
1 Visualice el men FUNCTION.
Pulse FUNCTION durante la reproduccin. Transition Cambie el estilo de los diaporamas
mientras los reproduce.
2 Seleccione y establezca el elemento.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER. * Los elementos mostrados en el men FUNCTION
dependen del tipo del disco.
Nota
Nota
Los elementos que no se pueden cambiar se
visualizan en gris. Los elementos que pueden Los elementos que se pueden seleccionar dependen
seleccionarse dependen del estado del reproductor. del tipo de disco.
Reproduccin de la gama 04
especificada de discos,
ttulos o captulos (pistas/
archivos) en orden aleatorio
Puede seleccionar entre 2 tipos de reproduccin
aleatoria.
1 Seleccione Mode.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
2 Seleccione el modo de reproduccin.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
Reproduccin aleatoria
La gama especificada de discos, ttulos o captulos
(pistas/archivos) se reproduce en orden aleatorio. El
mismo elemento se puede reproducir consecutivamente.
Reproduccin reordenada
La gama especificada de discos, ttulos o captulos
(pistas/archivos) se reproduce en orden aleatorio. Cada
elemento se reproduce una vez.
Reproduccin continua
desde una posicin
especfica (Reproduccin de
visin continua)
Esta funcin le permite continuar la reproduccin desde
una posicin especificada por usted para reproducir la
prxima vez, aunque haya apagado el aparato.
Configuracin
Durante la reproduccin, pulse CONTINUED en la
posicin desde la que quiera iniciar la reproduccin
de visin continua.
El tiempo de reproduccin transcurrido en la posicin
especificada se visualiza en la pantalla del TV.
Reproduccin
1 Pulse PLAY para reproducir el ttulo para el que
ha establecido la reproduccin de visin continua.
La pantalla del men FUNCTION aparece
automticamente para mostrar el punto (tiempo) cuando
usted puls CONTINUED.
La pantalla del control de funcin tambin se puede
visualizar pulsando FUNCTION durante la
reproduccin.
2 Pulse ENTER, y luego seleccione el tiempo de
reproduccin de visin contina especificado.
La reproduccin empieza desde la posicin especificada.
Nota
El ajuste de reproduccin de visin continua se
cancela cuando se pulsa OPEN/CLOSE.
La reproduccin de visin continua puede que no
funcione bien con algunos discos. 33
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 34 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
05 Captulo 5
Reproduccin desde Home Media
Gallery
Desde Home Media Gallery se pueden reproducir los
archivos siguientes:
PC que ejecutan Microsoft Windows Vista o XP con
Windows Media Player 11 instalado
PC que ejecutan Microsoft Windows 7 con
Windows Media Player 12 instalado
Servidores de medios digitales compatibles con
DLNA (en PCs o en otros componentes)
Los archivos guardados en un PC o DMS (servidor
de medios digitales) como se describe ms arriba
se pueden reproducir mediante un reproductor de
medios digitales (DMP).
35
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 36 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
36
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 37 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Eliminacin de pistas/
archivos del Playlist
1 Seleccione la pista/archivo que va a eliminar y
luego pulse POP UP MENU para visualizar el men
POP UP MENU.
2 Use / para seleccionar Delete from Playlist y
luego pulse ENTER.
37
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 38 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
06 Captulo 6
Reproduccin de contenido de Web
Con el reproductor puede disfrutar de algn contenido de Acceso a los contenidos proporcionados por terceros
streaming en Internet. requiere una conexin de Internet de alta velocidad y
tambin puede ser requerido una cuenta registrada y
38
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 39 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Captulo 7 07
Ajustes avanzados
Cambio de los ajustes Utilizacin de la pantalla
Initial Setup
1 Visualice la pantalla Home Menu cuando pare la
reproduccin.
Pulse HOME MENU.
2 Seleccione y establezca Initial Setup.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
3 Seleccione el elemento y cambie el ajuste.
Use /// para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
Nota
Los elementos que pueden seleccionarse dependen del estado del reproductor.
En Opciones, los ajustes predeterminados en fbrica se indican en negrita.
Configuracin Opciones Explicacin
16:9 Full
Display Setting
39
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 40 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Digial Output Bitstream Seleccione esto para dar salida directamente a seales de audio digital.
PCM Seleccione esto para dar salida a seales de audio digital convertidas en seales de
audio PCM.
Re-encode Seleccione esto para dar salida a seales de audio digital convertidas en DTS Digital
Surround.
Off Seleccione esto para dar salida a otras seales de audio que no sean de audio digital.
DTS Downmix (BDP- Stereo Las seales DTS-HD Master Audio, las seales DTS-HD High Resolution Audio o las
LX55) seales de audio DTS Digital Surround convertidas en seales de audio PCM lineal
se convierten a su vez en seales de 2 canales (estreo) para su salida.
Lt/Rt Las seales DTS-HD Master Audio, las seales DTS-HD High Resolution Audio o las
seales de audio DTS Digital Surround convertidas en seales de audio PCM lineal
se convierten a su vez en seales de 2 canales compatibles con Dolby Surround para
su salida (cuando el amplificador o receptor AV conectado, etc. es compatible con
Dolby Pro Logic, el amplificador o receptor AV da salida a las seales de audio PCM
lineal como seales de audio de sonido envolvente).
Downsampling 48k Seleccione esto cuando reproduzca un disco grabado con una frecuencia de
muestreo de 48 kHz.
96k Seleccione esto cuando reproduzca un disco grabado con una frecuencia de
muestreo de 96 kHz.
192k Seleccione esto cuando reproduzca un disco grabado con una frecuencia de
muestreo de 192 kHz.
DRC (Control de gama Off Seleccione esto para dar salida a seales de audio sin usar la funcin DRC.
dinmica) On Seleccione esto para ajustar la gama entre los sonidos ms altos y ms bajos (gama
* Slo son compatibles dinmica) para reproducir con un volumen de promedio. Use esto cuando sea difcil
las seales de audio or los dilogos o cuando vea programas a medianoche.
analgico y digital Dolby.
Auto Seleccione esto para cambiar automticamente la activacin/desactivacin del
ajuste DRC segn la seal de audio de entrada procedente del disco.
40
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 41 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
IP setting Seleccione esto para poner la direccin IP del reproductor y del servidor DNS (pgina 44).
Proxy Server Establezca solamente el servidor representante si as se lo indica el proveedor de servicios de Internet
(pgina 44).
Information Visualiza los valores de la direccin MAC, de la direccin IP, de la mscara de subred, de la puerta de
enlace predeterminada, del servidor DNS (primario) y del servidor DNS (secundario).
Connection test Seleccione esto para probar la conexin de la red (pgina 45).
Internet Connection Enable Seleccione esto cuando conecte a Internet.
Disable Seleccione esto cuando no conecte a Internet.
BD-Live connection Permitted Todos los discos se pueden conectar a BD-LIVE.
Partial Slo los discos cuya seguridad ha sido confirmada se pueden conectar a BD-LIVE.
Permitted
Prohibited Ningn disco se puede conectar a BD-LIVE.
DLNA Enable Seleccione esto cuando conecte a un servidor DLNA. 41
Disable Seleccione esto cuando no conecte a un servidor DLNA. Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 42 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
OSD idiomas Elija un idioma para las visualizaciones en pantalla de entre los idiomas listados.
disponibles
Audio idiomas Elija un idioma de entre los listados para establecer el idioma de audio
* Con algunos discos disponibles predeterminado para la reproduccin de discos BD-ROM y DVD-Vdeo.
puede que no sea
posible cambiar al
idioma seleccionado.
Si se establece un idioma no grabado en el BD/DVD, se establece y reproduce automticamente uno de los idiomas grabados.
Subtitle idiomas Elija un idioma de entre los listados para establecer el idioma de subttulos
* Con algunos discos disponibles predeterminado para la reproduccin de discos BD-ROM y DVD-Vdeo.
puede que no sea
posible cambiar al
idioma seleccionado.
Si se establece un idioma no grabado en el BD/DVD, se establece y reproduce automticamente uno de los idiomas grabados.
Menu idiomas Elija un idioma de entre los listados para establecer el idioma predeterminado para
* Con algunos discos disponibles los mens de discos BD-ROM y DVD-Vdeo.
puede que no sea
posible cambiar al
idioma seleccionado.
Si se establece un idioma no grabado en el BD/DVD, se establece y reproduce automticamente uno de los idiomas grabados.
Playback
Angle Mark On Seleccione esto para visualizar la marca de ngulo en la pantalla del TV (pgina 28).
ste es el ajuste predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Seleccione esto si no quiere visualizar la marca de ngulo en la pantalla del TV. ste
es el ajuste predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-LX55.
PIP Mark On Seleccione esto para visualizar la marca PIP en la pantalla del TV. ste es el ajuste
predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Seleccione esto si no quiere visualizar la marca PIP en la pantalla del TV. ste es el
ajuste predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-LX55.
Secondary Audio Mark On Seleccione esto para visualizar la marca de audio secundario en la pantalla del TV
(pgina 29). ste es el ajuste predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-440/BDP-140.
Off Seleccione esto si no quiere visualizar la marca de audio secundario en la pantalla
del TV. ste es el ajuste predeterminado de fbrica para el BDP-LX55.
DivX(R) VOD DRM Registration Visualiza el cdigo de registro del reproductor requerido para reproducir archivos
Code DivX VOD (pgina 10).
DVD Playback DVD AUDIO Seleccione esto para reproducir slo la parte de audio del disco DVD-Audio.
* Este ajuste es para la DVD VIDEO Seleccione esto para reproducir slo la parte de vdeo del disco DVD-Audio.
reproduccin de discos
DVD-Audio. (Excepto el
BDP-140)
Internet Setting Permitted El contenido de Web se puede ver sin introducir contrasea.
Partioal Para ver el contenido de Web se tiene que introducir la contrasea.
Parmitted
Prohibited No se puede ver contenido de Web.
Disc Auto Playback On Los discos se reproducen automticamente despus de cargarlos.
Off Los discos cargados no empiezan a reproducirse automticamente.
Last Memory On Seleccione esto para guardar el punto en el que par la reproduccin por ltima vez,
incluso despus de abrir la bandeja del disco o cambiar al modo de espera.
Off Seleccione esto cuando slo quiera usar la reproduccin de visin continua (pgina 33).
PBC (Control de On Seleccione esto para reproducir Video-CD (versin 2.0) compatible con PBC usando
reproduccin) el men del disco.
Off Seleccione esto para reproducir Video-CD (versin 2.0) compatible con PBC sin usar
el men del disco.
Setup Navigator Empiece a hacer los ajustes usando el men Setup Navigator. Para conocer detalles, consulte pgina 23.
Security
Change Password Registre (cambie) la contrasea para los ajustes del bloqueo de los padres o para desbloquear y
reproducir DVD-Video con el bloqueo de los padres (pgina 45).
Parent Control Cambie el nivel del bloqueo de los padres fijado en el reproductor (pgina 46).
Country Code Cambie el cdigo de pas/rea (pgina 46).
42
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 43 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
3 min
Auto Power Off Off Seleccione esto si no quiere que la alimentacin se desconecte automticamente.
10 min La alimentacin se desconectar automticamente si no se ha realizado ninguna
20 min operacin durante ms de 10, 20 o 30 minutos.
30 min
Quick Start On Seleccione esto para reducir el tiempo necesario para el inicio.
Off Seleccione esto para realizar el inicio normal.
Update Disc Seleccione el mtodo de actualizar el software. (pgina 46)
USB Storage
Network
Load Default Restablecimiento de los ajustes a los ajustes predeterminados en fbrica.
System Information Verifique el nmero de versin del sistema.
Disc Auto Update On Visualiza la pantalla de actualizacin de software cuando se carga un disco con
archivo de actualizacin del reproductor.
Off La pantalla de actualizacin del software debe visualizarse manualmente. (pgina 46)
BUDA BUDA Visualice y establezca los datos de BUDA en el aparato de memoria USB conectado.
Information
BUDA Setup
43
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 44 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
44
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 45 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
45
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 46 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
2 Introduzca la contrasea.
Use los botones de nmeros (0 a 9) para introducir el Aviso
nmero y luego pulse ENTER para establecerlo. No desenchufe el cable de alimentacin ni retire el
Use / para mover el cursor. aparato de memoria USB/disco durante la
actualizacin del software. De lo contrario, la
3 Cambie el nivel. actualizacin se abortar y el reproductor podra
Use / para cambiar y luego pulse ENTER para funcionar mal.
establecerlo.
Hay dos procesos para actualizar el software:
descarga y actualizacin. Ambos procesos pueden
Nota tardar cierto periodo de tiempo.
El nivel puede establecerse en Off o entre Level1 y Durante la actualizacin del software se anulan otras
Level8. Cuando se establece en Off no hay operaciones. Adems, el proceso de actualizacin no
restricciones. se puede cancelar.
En el BDP-LX55/BDP-440, cuando la pantalla del
Cambio del cdigo de pas/rea panel frontal est apagada, encindala con FL
DIMMER. Cuando actualice el software del
1 Seleccione y establezca Security Country Code reproductor con la pantalla del panel frontal apagada,
Next Screen. no desenchufe el cable de alimentacin hasta que se
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER. apague la unidad.
2 Introduzca la contrasea.
Actualizacin de la conexin a
Use los botones de nmeros (0 a 9) para introducir el
nmero y luego pulse ENTER para establecerlo. Internet
Use / para mover el cursor.
3 Cambie el cdigo de pas/rea. Nota
Use / para cambiar y luego pulse ENTER para Dependiendo de las condiciones de la conexin de
establecerlo. Consulte la pgina 48. Internet, la descarga puede tardar mucho tiempo.
Los pasos 1 y 5 son las operaciones realizadas por el
usuario (su finalidad es la de descargar el software de
Internet).
Los pasos 6 a 8 son las operaciones realizadas
(automticamente) por el reproductor (su finalidad es
la de actualizar el software).
1 Conecte a Internet.
2 Visualice la pantalla Home Menu cuando pare la
reproduccin.
Pulse HOME MENU.
3 Seleccione y establezca Initial Setup.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
4 Seleccione y establezca Options Update
Network Start.
Use / para seleccionar y luego pulse ENTER.
46
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 47 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
48
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 49 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Captulo 8 08
Informacin adicional
Aviso sobre las THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not
just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms
software
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is
OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as
ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES form of a textual message at program startup or in
WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA documentation (online or textual) provided with the
Las licencias para el software de OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, package.
fuente abierta usado en este NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR without modification, are permitted provided that the
reproductor se muestran abajo. Con el PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. following conditions are met:
fin de alcanzar la mayor exactitud Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
posible, aqu hemos incluido el texto promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software disclaimer.
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
original (en ingls). above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
jpeg
curl This software is based in part on the work of the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE independent JPEG Group. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
Copyright 1996 - 2007, Daniel Stenberg, this software must display the following
<[email protected]>. All rights reserved. openssl acknowledgement:
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the "This product includes cryptographic software written
software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby conditions of the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word
granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this license apply to the toolkit. 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the
permission notice appear in all copies. See below for the actual license texts. Actually both library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
THE SOF TWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" , WI THOUT licenses are BSD-style Open Source licenses. In case of any 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, license issues related to OpenSSL please contact openssl- derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF [email protected]. code) you must include an acknowledgement:
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR OpenSSL License "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights ([email protected])"
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR reserved. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS''
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN without modification, are permitted provided that the INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING following conditions are met: WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
SOFTWARE. disclaimer. LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. materials provided with the distribution. OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
expat 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of
this software must display the following IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software acknowledgment: NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
Center Ltd "This product includes software developed by the OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http:/ THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
obtaining a copy of this software and associated /www.openssl.org/)" The licence and distribution terms for any publically
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" available version or derivative of this code cannot be
without restriction, including without limitation the rights must not be used to endorse or promote products changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, derived from this software without prior written under another distribution licence [including the GNU
and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to permission. For written permission, please contact Public Licence.]
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the [email protected].
following conditions: 5. Products derived from this software may not be called zlib
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names This software is based in part on zlib see http://www.zlib.net
be included in all copies or substantial portions of the without prior written permission of the OpenSSL for information.
Software. Project.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the GNU General Public License and
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
following acknowledgment: GNU Lesser General Public License
"This product includes software developed by the
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR This product includes the following software licensed for
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. use under the terms of GNU General
www.openssl.org/)"
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT Public License v2, GNU Lesser General Public License v2.1.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR linux kernel 2.6. Copyright (C) 1991 Linus Torvalds.
PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF Licensed under GPLv2.0
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT BusyBox v1.17.1 multi-call binary. Copyright (C) 1998-
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE 2009 Erik Andersen, Rob Landley, Denys Vlasenko and
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. others. Licensed under GPLv2.0
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL
SquashFS Copyright: (C) 2002-2009 Phillip Lougher
freetype PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
Licensed under GPL v2.0
This software is based in part on freetype see http:// Das U-Boot Copyright: (C) 2000-2005 Wolfang Denk,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
www.freetype.org for information. DENX Software Engineering, [email protected]. Licensed
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
under GPL v2.0
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
International Components for BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
LIRC 0.8.5 Copyright (C) 1996 Ralph Metzler
<[email protected]> Copyright (C) 1998-2008
Unicode ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
Christoph Bartelmus <[email protected]> Licensed
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
under GPL v2.0
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
glibc 2.9 Copyright (C) 1992-2006, 2007 Free Software
Copyright (c) 1995-2010 International Business Machines THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
Foundation, Inc. Licensed under LGPL v2.1.
Corporation and others OF SUCH DAMAGE.
You can get corresponding open source code from the
All rights reserved. This product includes cryptographic software written by
following URL.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person Eric Young ([email protected]). This product includes
http://www.oss-pioneer.com/homeav/blu-ray
obtaining a copy of this software and associated software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Please refer to the following URL for further information of
documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software Original SSLeay License
GNU General Public License Version 2.
without restriction, including without limitation the rights Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected])
http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl-2.0.html
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell All rights reserved.
Please refer to the following URL for further information of
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric
GNU Library General Public License Version 2.1.
Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above Young ([email protected]).
http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all The implementation was written so as to conform with
copies of the Software and that both the above copyright Netscapes SSL.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use
as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The
Version 2, June 1991 49
documentation. Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
following conditions apply to all code found in this Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 50 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA started running for such interactive use in the most limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
08 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim
copies of this license document, but changing it is not
ordinary way, to print or display an announcement
including an appropriate copyright notice and a
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that
contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
allowed. notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
Preamble you provide a warranty) and that users may cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your
The licenses for most software are designed to take away redistribute the program under these conditions, and obligations under this License and any other pertinent
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU telling the user how to view a copy of this License. obligations, then as a consequence you may not
General Public License is intended to guarantee your (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure does not normally print such an announcement, your license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of
the software is free for all its users. This General Public work based on the Program is not required to print an the Program by all those who receive copies directly or
License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's announcement.) indirectly through you, then the only way you could
software and to any other program whose authors commit These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the entirely from distribution of the Program.
is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License Program, and can be reasonably considered independent If any portion of this section is held invalid or
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. and separate works in themselves, then this License, and unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the
When we speak of free software, we are referring to its terms, do not apply to those sections when you balance of the section is intended to apply and the
freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute section as a whole is intended to apply in other
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based circumstances.
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to
service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get the terms of this License, whose permissions for other infringe any patents or other property right claims or to
it if you want it, that you can change the software or use licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and contest validity of any such claims; this section has the
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you every part regardless of who wrote it. sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free
can do these things. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or software distribution system, which is implemented by
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, public license practices. Many people have made
forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution generous contributions to the wide range of software
surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain of derivative or collective works based on the Program. distributed through that system in reliance on
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on consistent application of that system; it is up to the
software, or if you modify it. the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium distribute software through any other system and a
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all does not bring the other work under the scope of this licensee cannot impose that choice.
the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, License. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what
receive or can get the source code. And you must show 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this
them these terms so they know their rights. based on it, under Section 2) in object code or License.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal above provided that you also do one of the following: restricted in certain countries either by patents or by
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to machine-readable source code, which must be who places the Program under this License may add an
make certain that everyone understands that there is no distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
warranty for this free software. If the software is modified on a medium customarily used for software those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to interchange; or, or among countries not thus excluded. In such case,
know that what they have is not the original, so that any b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least this License incorporates the limitation as if written in
problems introduced by others will not reflect on the three years, to give any third party, for a charge no the body of this License.
original authors' reputations. more than your cost of physically performing source 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of or new versions of the General Public License from time
software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that the corresponding source code, to be distributed to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the
redistributors of a free program will individually obtain under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a present version, but may differ in detail to address new
patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. medium customarily used for software interchange; problems or concerns.
To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must or, Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. c) Accompany it with the information you received as to If the Program specifies a version number of this
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution the offer to distribute corresponding source code. License which applies to it and "any later version", you
and modification follow. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial have the option of following the terms and conditions
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE distribution and only if you received the program in either of that version or of any later version published by
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION object code or executable form with such an offer, in the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not
AND MODIFICATION accord with Subsection b above.) specify a version number of this License, you may
0. This License applies to any program or other work The source code for a work means the preferred form of the choose any version ever published by the Free Software
which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder work for making modifications to it. For an executable Foundation.
saying it may be distributed under the terms of this work, complete source code means all the source code for 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to all modules it contains, plus any associated interface other free programs whose distribution conditions are
any such program or work, and a "work based on the definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
Program" means either the Program or any derivative and installation of the executable. However, as a special software which is copyrighted by the Free Software
work under copyright law: that is to say, a work exception, the source code distributed need not include Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we
containing the Program or a portion of it, either anything that is normally distributed (in either source or sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included and so on) of the operating system on which the executable of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting
without limitation in the term "modification".) Each runs, unless that component itself accompanies the the sharing and reuse of software generally.
licensee is addressed as "you". executable. NO WARRANTY
Activities other than copying, distribution and If distribution of executable or object code is made by 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF
modification are not covered by this License; they are offering access to copy from a designated place, then CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
restricted, and the output from the Program is covered same place counts as distribution of the source code, even APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE
only if its contents constitute a work based on the though third parties are not compelled to copy the source STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
Program (independent of having been made by running along with the object code. OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
Program does. Program except as expressly provided under this EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
Program's source code as you receive it, in any sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
medium, provided that you conspicuously and automatically terminate your rights under this License. PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate However, parties who have received copies, or rights, QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact from you under this License will not have their licenses WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
all the notices that refer to this License and to the terminated so long as such parties remain in full DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients compliance. NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
of the Program a copy of this License along with the 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
Program. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring permission to modify or distribute the Program or its COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM
protection in exchange for a fee. you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or or distributing the Program (or any work based on the DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that distributing or modifying the Program or works based PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS
you also meet all of these conditions: on it. OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent 6 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES
notices stating that you changed the files and the based on the Program), the recipient automatically OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
date of any change. receives a license from the original licensor to copy, ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived and conditions. You may not impose any further POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
50 terms of this License.
c) If the modified program normally reads commands
compliance by third parties to this License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the
greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve
Es interactively when run, you must cause it, when of patent infringement or for any other reason (not
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 51 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
this is to make it free software which everyone can after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And based on the Library (independent of the use of the
redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is
you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we
Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true
depends on what the Library does and what the
08
safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license, program that uses the Library does.
effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the
should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to modify the library. Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any
where the full notice is found. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear medium, provided that you conspicuously and
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
of what it does.> library is modified by someone else and passed on, the copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> recipients should know that what they have is not the all the notices that refer to this License and to the
This program is free software; you can redistribute it original version, so that the original author's reputation will absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this
and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General not be affected by problems that might be introduced by License along with the Library.
Public License as published by the Free Software others. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty
option) any later version. existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that protection in exchange for a fee.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any
useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library,
the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license and copy and distribute such modifications or work
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you
Public License for more details. the full freedom of use specified in this license. also meet all of these conditions:
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
Public License along with this program; if not, write to the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain notices stating that you changed the files and the
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary date of any change.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic General Public License. We use this license for certain c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed
and paper mail. libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non- at no charge to all third parties under the terms of
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice free programs. this License.
like this when it starts in an interactive mode: When a program is linked with a library, whether statically d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of or using a shared library, the combination of the two is or a table of data to be supplied by an application
author legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the program that uses the facility, other than as an
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO original library. The ordinary General Public License argument passed when the facility is invoked, then
WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. therefore permits such linking only if the entire you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in
This is free software, and you are welcome to combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General the event an application does not supply such
redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other function or table, the facility still operates, and
for details. code with the library. performs whatever part of its purpose remains
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License meaningful.
show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the (For example, a function in a library to compute
Of course, the commands you use may be called ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-
something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could software developers Less of an advantage over competing defined independent of the application. Therefore,
even be mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied
program. use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. function or table used by this function must be
You should also get your employer (if you work as a However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain optional: if the application does not supply it, the
programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright special circumstances. square root function must still compute square
disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special roots.)
alter the names: need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain These requirements apply to the modified work as a
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not
the program this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. derived from the Library, and can be reasonably
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) A more frequent case is that a free library does the same considered independent and separate works in
written by James Hacker. job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989 little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, apply to those sections when you distribute them as
Ty Coon, President of Vice so we use the Lesser General Public License. separate works. But when you distribute the same
This General Public License does not permit incorporating In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non- sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the
your program into proprietary programs. If your program is free programs enables a greater number of people to use a Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the
a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to large body of free software. For example, permission to use terms of this License, whose permissions for other
permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each
this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Public License instead of this License. well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less contest your rights to work written entirely by you;
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLICLICENSE protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
Version 2.1, February 1999 user of a program that is linked with the Library has the distribution of derivative or collective works based on
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a the Library.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA modified version of the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution based on the Library with the Library (or with a work
copies of this license document, but changing it is not and modification follow. Pay close attention to the based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or
allowed. difference between a "work based on the library" and a distribution medium does not bring the other work
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also "work that uses the library". The former contains code under the scope of this License.
counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, derived from the library, whereas the latter must be 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU
version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] combined with the library in order to run. General Public License instead of this License to a given
Preamble GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the
The licenses for most software are designed to take away TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the
your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU AND MODIFICATION ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure or other program which contains a notice placed by the the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared,
the software is free for all its users. copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may then you can specify that version instead if you wish.)
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Do not make any other change in these notices.
some specially designated software packages--typically Public License (also called "this License"). Each Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other licensee is addressed as "you". irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we A "library" means a collection of software functions and/ Public License applies to all subsequent copies and
suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with derivative works made from that copy.
or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy application programs (which use some of those This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations functions and data) to form executables. code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
below. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
When we speak of free software, we are referring to or work which has been distributed under these terms. derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or
freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are A "work based on the Library" means either the Library executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
designed to make sure that you have the freedom to or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, above provided that you accompany it with the
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either complete corresponding machine-readable source
service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get verbatim or with modifications and/or translated code, which must be distributed under the terms of
it if you want it; that you can change the software and use straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used
pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed translation is included without limitation in the term for software interchange.
that you can do these things. "modification".) If distribution of object code is made by offering access
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of to copy from a designated place, then offering
forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to the work for making modifications to it. For a library, equivalent access to copy the source code from the
surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to complete source code means all the source code for all same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the modules it contains, plus any associated interface source code, even though third parties are not
library or if you modify it. definition files, plus the scripts used to control compelled to copy the source along with the object
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether compilation and installation of the library. code.
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights Activities other than copying, distribution and 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of
that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, modification are not covered by this License; they are the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code
with the library, you must provide complete object files to
outside its scope. The act of running a program using
the Library is not restricted, and output from such a
being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that
uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a
51
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library program is covered only if its contents constitute a work Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 52 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE
08 the scope of this License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the
the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library,
and explaining where to find the accompanying
LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN
WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the uncombined form of the same work. PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
Library (because it contains portions of the Library), 8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
rather than a "work that uses the library". The distribute the Library except as expressly provided IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
executable is therefore covered by this License. Section under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
6 states terms for distribution of such executables. modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from void, and will automatically terminate your rights under RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
a header file that is part of the Library, the object code this License. However, parties who have received THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even copies, or rights, from you under this License will not PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is have their licenses terminated so long as such parties NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
especially significant if the work can be linked without remain in full compliance. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE
the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY
for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, permission to modify or distribute the Library or its MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY
data structure layouts and accessors, and small derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, or distributing the Library (or any work based on the INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
(Executables containing this object code plus portions do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) distributing or modifying the Library or works based on DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you it. LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
may distribute the object code for the work under the 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY
terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that based on the Library), the recipient automatically OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are receives a license from the original licensor to copy, OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
linked directly with the Library itself. distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also these terms and conditions. You may not impose any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
Library to produce a work containing portions of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making
choice, provided that the terms permit modification of 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation it free software that everyone can redistribute and change.
the work for the customer's own use and reverse of patent infringement or for any other reason (not You can do so by permitting redistribution under these
engineering for debugging such modifications. limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that General Public License).
work that the Library is used in it and that the Library contradict the conditions of this License, they do not To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the
and its use are covered by this License. You must excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source
supply a copy of this License. If the work during cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
execution displays copyright notices, you must include obligations under this License and any other pertinent each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well obligations, then as a consequence you may not pointer to where the full notice is found.
as a reference directing the user to the copy of this distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of
License. Also, you must do one of these things: license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of what it does.>
a) Accompany the work with the complete the Library by all those who receive copies directly or Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
corresponding machine-readable source code for the indirectly through you, then the only way you could This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/
Library including whatever changes were used in the satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 entirely from distribution of the Library. Public
and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked If any portion of this section is held invalid or License as published by the Free Software Foundation;
with the Library, with the complete machine-readable unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any
"work that uses the Library", as object code and/or balance of the section is intended to apply, and the later version.
source code, so that the user can modify the Library section as a whole is intended to apply in other This library is distributed in the hope that it will be
and then relink to produce a modified executable circumstances. useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even
containing the modified Library. (It is understood It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS
that the user who changes the contents of definitions infringe any patents or other property right claims or to FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser
files in the Library will not necessarily be able to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the General Public License for more details.
recompile the application to use the modified sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser
definitions.) software distribution system which is implemented by General Public License along with this library; if not,
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking public license practices. Many people have made write to the Free Software
with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) generous contributions to the wide range of software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston,
uses at run time a copy of the library already present distributed through that system in reliance on MA 02110-1301 USA
on the user's computer system, rather than copying consistent application of that system; it is up to the Also add information on how to contact you by electronic
library functions into the executable, and (2) will author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to and paper mail.
operate properly with a modified version of the library, distribute software through any other system and a You should also get your employer (if you work as a
if the user installs one, as long as the modified licensee cannot impose that choice. programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright
version is interface-compatible with the version that This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
the work was made with. is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this alter the names:
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in
least three years, to give the same user the materials 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written
specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted by James Random Hacker.
more than the cost of performing this distribution. interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access Library under this License may add an explicit Ty Coon, President of Vice
to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent geographical distribution limitation excluding those That's all there is to it!
access to copy the above specified materials from the countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
same place. among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of License incorporates the limitation as if written in the
these materials or that you have already sent this body of this License.
user a copy. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/
For an executable, the required form of the "work that or new versions of the Lesser General Public License
uses the Library" must include any data and utility from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
programs needed for reproducing the executable from spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be address new problems or concerns.
distributed need not include anything that is normally Each version is given a distinguishing version number.
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the If the Library specifies a version number of this License
major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the which applies to it and "any later version", you have the
operating system on which the executable runs, unless option of following the terms and conditions either of
that component itself accompanies the executable. that version or of any later version published by the Free
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do license version number, you may choose any version
not normally accompany the operating system. Such a ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other
Library together in an executable that you distribute. free programs whose distribution conditions are
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
the Library side-by-side in a single library together with permission. For software which is copyrighted by the
other library facilities not covered by this License, and Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software
distribute such a combined library, provided that the Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
separate distribution of the work based on the Library Our decision will be guided by the two goals of
and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
and provided that you do these two things: software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the software generally.
52 same work based on the Library, uncombined with
any other library facilities. This must be distributed 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
NO WARRANTY
Es under the terms of the Sections above. CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 53 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
No pegue papel ni ponga pegatinas en los discos, ni No use bencina, diluyente u otros productos qumicos
08 utilice un lapicero, bolgrafo u otro instrumento de voltiles. No use tampoco aerosoles de discos de vinilo ni
escritura de punta fina. stos podran daar los discos. productos antiestticos.
Para la suciedad difcil de quitar, ponga un poco de agua
en un pao blando, escrralo bien, pselo por el
reproductor para limpiarlo y finalmente pase un pao
seco para quitar la humedad.
Limpieza de discos
Puede que no sea posible reproducir el disco si ste tiene
huellas dactilares o est sucio. En este caso, use un pao
de limpieza, etc., para pasarlo suavemente por el disco, Condensacin en los discos
desde el centro hasta el borde exterior. No use un pao
Si el disco se traslada repentinamente de un lugar fro a
de limpieza sucio.
una habitacin caliente (en invierno, por ejemplo) puede
que se formen gotas de agua (condensacin) en la
superficie del disco. Los discos no se reproducirn bien
si tienen condensacin. Limpie cuidadosamente las
gotas de agua de la superficie del disco antes de usar el
disco.
Solucin de problemas
La operacin incorrecta se confunde a menudo con un problema o un fallo de funcionamiento. Si piensa que algo
funciona mal con este componente, compruebe los puntos de abajo. Algunas veces, el problema puede estar en otro
componente. Inspeccione los otros componentes y los aparatos elctricos que est utilizando. Si no se puede corregir
el problema despus de comprobar los puntos de abajo, pida al servicio de Pioneer autorizado ms cercano o a su
concesionario que realice el trabajo de reparacin.
Reproduccin
Problema Verificacin Remedio
El disco no se reproduce. Se puede reproducir el disco Verifique si el disco se puede reproducir en este reproductor
La bandeja del disco se en este reproductor? (pgina 7).
abre automticamente. Se puede reproducir el Verifique si el archivo se puede reproducir en este reproductor
archivo en este reproductor? (pgina 10).
Verifique que el archivo no est daado.
Est rayado el disco? Puede que no sea posible reproducir bien los discos rayados.
Est sucio el disco? Limpie el disco (ms arriba).
Hay una pieza de papel o El disco puede estar deformado y no se puede reproducir.
pegatina adherida al disco?
Est bien colocado el disco Meta el disco con la cara impresa hacia arriba.
en su bandeja? Ponga correctamente el disco en el hueco de su bandeja.
Es correcto el nmero de Vea pgina 9 para conocer los nmeros de regiones de los discos que
regin? se pueden reproducir en este reproductor.
54
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 55 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Funcin de control 08
Problema Verificacin Remedio
La funcin de control no Est bien conectado el cable Para usar la funcin de control, conecte el TV de pantalla plana y el
funciona. HDMI? sistema AV (amplificador o receptor AV, etc.) al terminal HDMI OUT
(pgina 15).
Es el cable HDMI que usted Use un Cable HDMI de alta velocidad. La funcin de control puede no
est usando un Cable HDMI funcionar bien si se usa un cable HDMI que no es un Cable HDMI de
de alta velocidad? alta velocidad.
Est conectado este Si las seales de vdeo estn saliendo por un terminal que no es el
reproductor al TV con un terminal HDMI OUT, la funcin de control no se activar. Conecte al TV
cable HDMI para ver la usando un cable HDMI (pgina 15).
imagen?
Para el BDP-LX55: Cuando se usen ambos terminales HDMI OUT (MAIN y SUB), la
Est el HDMI Mode bien funcin de control slo se activar para el terminal HDMI OUT (SUB)
ajustado? (pgina 16).
Red
Problema Verificacin Remedio
La funcin BD-LIVE Haga la prueba Connection Test (pgina 45). Si se visualiza Networks
(conexin a Internet) no se is OK. verifique los ajustes del servidor representante (pgina 44).
puede usar. Tambin puede haber un problema con la conexin a Internet.
No valid id file found! se Pngase en contacto con su proveedor de servicios de Internet.
visualiza cuando intento
actualizar el software.
La actualizacin del software Dependiendo de la conexin de Internet y otras condiciones, alguna
es lenta. vez puede ser necesario actualizar el software.
57
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 58 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Otros
Problema Verificacin Remedio
La alimentacin del Est Auto Power Off en 10 Si Auto Power Off se pone en 10 min/20 min/30 min, la alimentacin
reproductor se desconecta min/20 min/30 min? del reproductor se desconectar automticamente si no se realiza
automticamente. ninguna operacin durante ms de 30 minutos (pgina 43).
La alimentacin del Est Control en On? La alimentacin del reproductor puede conectarse junto con la
reproductor se conecta alimentacin del TV conectado al terminal HDMI OUT. Si no quiere que
automticamente. la alimentacin del reproductor se conecte cuando se conecta la
alimentacin del TV, ponga Control en Off (pgina 41).
El reproductor no se puede Utiliza el mando a distancia Utilcelo a menos de 7 m del sensor del mando a distancia.
controlar con el mando a demasiado lejos del
distancia. reproductor?
Estn agotadas las pilas? Sustituya las pilas (pgina 5).
La entrada del TV y del Est Control en On? La entrada del TV y del sistema AV (amplificador o receptor AV, etc.)
sistema AV conectados conectados al terminal HDMI OUT puede cambiar automticamente
cambia automticamente. al reproductor cuando empieza la reproduccin en el reproductor o
cuando se visualiza la pantalla de mens (Home Media Gallery, etc.). Si
no quiere que las entradas del TV y del sistema AV (amplificador o
receptor AV, etc.) conectados cambien automticamente, ponga
Control en Off (pgina 41).
Los ajustes que yo he hecho Ha desconectado el cable Pulse siempre STANDBY/ON en el panel delantero del reproductor
han sido borrados. de alimentacin mientras la o STANDBY/ON en el mando a distancia, y verifique que POWER
alimentacin del reproductor OFF se haya apagado en el visualizador del panel delantero del
estaba activada? reproductor antes de desconectar el cable de alimentacin. Tenga
Se ha producido un fallo mucho cuidado cuando desconecte el cable de alimentacin de otro
de alimentacin? aparato de la toma de CA porque el reproductor podr apagarse junto
con el aparato.
58
Es
BDP-140_VXCN5_IBD_ES.book Page 59 Wednesday, September 28, 2011 10:14 AM
Glosario BDMV
En cuanto al formato BD, las especificaciones del formato
audiovisual designado para el contenido de pelculas de alta
definicin (HD) preempaquetado se conoce como BDMV en este
ngulo (Mltiples ngulos) reproductor y en este manual de instrucciones.
En los discos BD-ROM o DVD-Video se pueden grabar
simultneamente hasta 9 ngulos de cmara, lo que le permite Bloqueo de los padres
ver la misma escena desde ngulos diferentes.
Vase pgina 46.
Audio interactivo BONUSVIEW
Las seales de audio grabadas en los ttulos de los BD-ROM.
Vase pgina 8.
stas incluyen, por ejemplo, el sonido clic hecho cuando se
utiliza la pantalla de mens.
Cuadros y campos
Audio secundario Un cuadro es la unidad de una imagen fija que compone las
imgenes en movimiento. Un cuadro consiste en una imagen de
Algunos BD-ROM incluyen series de audio secundario mezclado
lneas impares y en una imagen de lneas pares llamadas
con series de audio principal. Estas series de audio secundario
campos en seal de vdeo con mtodo de exploracin
se llaman audio secundario. En algunos discos, este audio
entrelazado (576i, 1080i, etc.).
secundario se graba como audio para vdeo secundario.
Deep Color
AVCHD (Advanced Video Codec High
Vase pgina 15.
Definition)
Vase pgina 9. DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol)
AVCREC
Este protocolo provee parmetros de configuracin (direccin IP,
Vase pgina 9.
etc.) para ordenadores y otros aparatos conectados a la red.
BDAV Direccin IP
En cuanto al formato BD, las especificaciones del formato
Una direccin que identifica un ordenador u otro aparato
audiovisual para la grabacin de emisiones digitales HD se
conectado a Internet o a una red de rea local. Esto representa
conoce como BDAV en este reproductor y en este manual de
un nmero en cuatro secciones.
instrucciones.
Direccin MAC (Media Access Control)
BD-J
Un nmero de identificacin de hardware asignado
Vase pgina 9.
especficamente a un aparato de red (tarjeta LAN, etc.).
BD-LIVE DivX
Vase pgina 8.
Vase pgina 10.
Exploracin progresiva
Con este mtodo, una imagen consiste en una sola imagen, sin
dividirla en dos imgenes. La exploracin progresiva provee
imgenes claras sin parpadeo, en particular para imgenes fijas
que contienen mucho texto, grficos y lneas horizontales. La
exploracin progresiva se indica en este reproductor y en el
manual de instrucciones mediante una p tras el valor de la
resolucin (por ejemplo, 576p).
Especificaciones 08
Modelo BDP-LX55
BDP-440
BDP-140
Tipo REPRODUCTOR de Blu-ray 3D
Tensin nominal CA 100 V a 240 V
Frecuencia nominal 50 Hz/60 Hz
Consumo de energa BDP-LX55: 25 W
BDP-440, BDP-140: 23 W
Consumo de energa (modo de espera) 0,3 W
Peso BDP-LX55: 3,5 kg
BDP-440: 2,6 kg
BDP-140: 2,1 kg
Dimensiones externas (incluyendo partes sobresalientes) BDP-LX55: 435 mm (An) x 93 mm (Al) x 252 mm (Pr)
BDP-440: 435 mm (An) x 90 mm (Al) x 252 mm (Pr)
BDP-140: 435 mm (An) x 58 mm (Al) x 249 mm (Pr)
Temperatura de funcionamiento tolerable +5 C a +35 C
Humedad de funcionamiento tolerable 5 % a 85 % (sin condensacin)
Terminales de salida
Nota
Las especificaciones y diseo de este producto estn sujetos a cambios sin previo aviso.
2011 PIONEER CORPORATION. Todos los derechos reservados.
61
Es
72-DPLX55-YX0B1